1023 Commits

Author SHA1 Message Date
Sergey Poznyakoff
9077de9fa9 Remove Makefile.in 2009-03-07 16:32:06 +02:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ac6caa71bc Migrate to Git 2009-03-07 16:30:44 +02:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1ffb4377a4 Update 2009-03-05 07:26:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a00f276fe9 Version 1.22 2009-03-05 07:25:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5fa60b8d43 Version 1.22 2009-03-05 07:22:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29887e47d3 Update 2009-03-04 17:24:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a6318ea0ef v.1.21.90 2009-03-04 16:53:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c10830a35b Add xz support.
* src/buffer.c, src/suffix.c: Add support for xz compression.
* src/tar.c: New option --xz, for compression/decompression using xz.
Re-assign -J as a short equivalent of --xz.
* doc/tar.texi, NEWS: Document --xz
2009-03-04 16:50:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7a968d67c8 Minor fix 2009-01-19 10:53:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7b68ef3d91 Fix testsuite and bootstrap. Implement -I.
* bootstrap.conf: Include size_max.
* gnulib.modules: Remove memset, rmdir. Replace strdup with
strdup-posix. Patch by Eric Blake.
* src/tar.c: Implement -I as a shorthand for --use-compress-program.
* doc/tar.texi: Document -I.
* tests/pipe.at, tests/shortrec.at: Account for eventual 'Record
size' output.
* tests/testsuite.at (AT_TAR_CHECK_HOOK): New define
(AT_TAR_WITH_HOOK, TAR_IGNREC_HOOK): New macros.
2008-12-29 09:27:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
970f999818 Version 1.21 2008-12-27 11:40:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cd39b5a1b7 * src/xheader.c: Remove duplicate inclusion of fnmatch.h. Reported
by Jim Meyering.
2008-11-30 12:33:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7f6e6e6a3e Do not try to drain the input pipe before closing the archive.
* src/buffer.c (close_archive): Remove call to
sys_drain_input_pipe. Pass hit_eof as the second
argument to sys_wait_for_child.
* src/common.h (sys_drain_input_pipe): Remove
(sys_wait_for_child): Declare second argument.
* src/system.c (sys_drain_input_pipe): Remove.
(sys_wait_for_child): Take two arguments. The second one helps to
decide whether to tolerate child termination on SIGPIPE.
2008-11-25 12:33:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
99e3a2604f * src/buffer.c (_write_volume_label): Fix typo, which prevented
`-V label -M' from working.
2008-11-03 19:15:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b4ec8aedf9 * NEWS, configure.ac: Version 1.20.91
* doc/tar.texi: Document transformation scope flags.
* src/common.h (transform_symlinks_option): Remove in favor of
transformation scope flags.
(XFORM_REGFILE, XFORM_LINK, XFORM_SYMLINK, XFORM_ALL): New macros.
(transform_name, transform_member_name, transform_name_fp): Take
an additional argument, specifying scope flags.
* src/create.c: Reflect changes to transform_name.
* src/extract.c (extract_link, extract_symlink): Remove calls to
transform_member_name. It is done in read_header.
* src/list.c (decode_xform): Reflect change in data type of 2nd
argument.
(transform_member_name): 2nd arg is int.
(decode_header): Transform file name and link target names.
* src/tar.c: Remove --transform-symlinks.
* src/transform.c (struct transform): New member `flags'.
(transform_flags): New variable.
(parse_transform_expr): Parse transformation scope flags. Allow to
set global flags using `flags=' syntax.
(_transform_name_to_obstack, transform_name_fp)
(transform_name): Take an additional argument, specifying scope
flags.
2008-10-30 14:13:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5354888e40 * src/buffer.c (short_read): Remove !read_full_records condition,
which was always false on a first record and thus disabled record
size autodetection.  Thanks Ed Leaver for the patch.
(_gnu_flush_read): Handle blocking_factor == 1.
* tests/sparsemv.at: Reflect changes to buffer.c.
* tests/sparsemvp.at: Likewise.
* tests/volsize.at: Likewise.
* NEWS: Update.
* THANKS: Add Ed Leaver.
2008-10-22 20:55:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
57bfbbde90 * src/common.h (transform_symlinks_option): New global.
* src/create.c (dump_file0): Transform symlink targets only if
explicitly required.  Thanks Cyril Strejc for reporting the
problem.
* src/tar.c (parse_opt): New options --transform-symlinks and
--no-transform-symlinks. New alias --xform to the --transform
option.
* doc/tar.texi: Document --transform-symlinks
* NEWS: Update.
* THANKS: Update.

* src/names.c (name_gather): Use xzalloc.
* src/buffer.c (short_read): Move record size detection before
the loop.
2008-10-16 11:07:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7b69ee5a24 Update 2008-10-07 07:19:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1428b7f176 (options): Add --lzop option. 2008-10-07 07:19:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6901594ac4 Bugfix.
* src/checkpoint.c (checkpoint_compile_action): Add missing
`else'.
2008-10-05 09:09:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c78356feda Implement --no-null option.
* NEWS: Update.
* doc/tar.texi: Update.
* src/tar.c: New option --no-null.
2008-09-24 10:58:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
60c00c18b5 Update 2008-09-23 17:07:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c1b55e02b1 ChangeLog 2008-09-23 17:06:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
15abf5c4d9 Update 2008-09-18 09:46:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1353511226 Remove incorrect example. 2008-09-18 09:46:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85c7909497 Bugfixes.
* src/incremen.c (dumpdir_create0): Eliminate gcc warning.
(attach_directory): Bugfix - add missing return statement.
* THANKS: Add Enric Hernandez
2008-09-07 08:49:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
db83069aea Update 2008-07-31 07:13:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dbbffde583 Fix incremental archiving of renamed directories.
* src/incremen.c (struct directory): New member `next'.  Change
type of `name'.
(dirhead, dirtail): New statics.
(make_directory): Reflect changes to struct directory.
(free_directory, attach_directory): New functions.
(dirlist_replace_prefix): New function.
(note_directory): Use attach_directory, instead of make_directory,
(find_directory, find_directory_meta): Use free_directory.
(procdir): Replace directory prefixes in directory list to avoid
marking subdirectories as renamed after renaming their parent
directory.
(append_incremental_renames): Iterate over directory list, not
hash table, to preserve logical ordering of renames.
* tests/rename04.at, tests/rename05.at: New test cases.
* tests/Makefile.am, tests/testsuite.at: Add rename04.at and
rename05.at.
* tests/atlocal.in (decho): New function.
* tests/multiv06.at: Use decho instead of echo2.
* tests/incremental.at: Raise wait interval to 2 seconds.
2008-07-31 07:12:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1d79c6734c Untabify 2008-07-24 18:16:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3af9cc0f15 Fix multivolume archive creation when volume length=record size.
* src/tar.c (decode_options): Do not allow volume length less
than record size.
* src/buffer.c (_gnu_flush_write): Compensate for the effect
of eventual flush_archive occurring in the middle of buffer
move.
Increment records_written only if _flush_write was able to write
something.
* tests/multiv06.at: New testcase.
* tests/Makefile.am, test/testsuite.at: Add tests/multiv06.at
2008-07-24 18:16:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9a7297a8a * configure.ac, NEWS: Version 1.20.90
* doc/tar.texi: Document -J, --no-auto-compress, etc.
* src/buffer.c (ct_tar): New constant.
(magic): Add lzop support.  Proposed by Kevin Day
<thekevinday@gmail.com>.
(check_compressed_archive): Do not use autodetect if the
compression program was specified explicitly.
Fall back to analyzing archive name, if the autodetection fails.
* src/suffix.c: Add .lzo
* src/tar.c: New options --lzop and --no-auto-compress.
New short option -J (alias for --lzma).
2008-06-26 10:19:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
985637ab5a Bugfixes.
* src/buffer.c (try_new_volume): Print more information with error
diagnostics.
(_gnu_flush_write): Improve error checking.  Adjust
real_s_sizeleft before calling new_volume to avoid creating
malformed multivolume headers.
* tests/delete05.at, tests/gzip.at, tests/ignfail.at,
tests/longv7.at, tests/lustar01.at, tests/lustar02.at,
tests/shortfile.at: Update to match new diagnostic wording
(see 2008-05-06).

* NEWS: Update.
2008-06-26 06:32:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1024343a2b Update 2008-06-14 10:17:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1efa1f3b43 Remove a TZ dependency.Remove a TZ dependency. 2008-06-14 10:17:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5f1a4f9f12 Fix typos. 2008-06-14 10:17:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
969d2b986b Update 2008-06-14 10:16:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d5f2066cac (exclude): Document support for new VCS. 2008-06-14 10:16:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
79ce0e6789 (exclude_vcs_files): Support for Bazaar, Mercurial and Darcs. 2008-06-14 10:15:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6a052fd5a3 Update 2008-05-05 21:33:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8aa729b90e (main): Reword the "delayed error" message. New wording proposed by Karl Berry. 2008-05-05 21:33:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
057dd26a60 Update 2008-05-05 21:31:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b94eed6d03 Version 1.20.
* configure.ac: Raise version number to 1.20
* src/compare.c (diff_dumpdir): const.
* src/common.h (dumpdir_t,dumpdir_iter_t): New data types.
(dumpdir_create0,dumpdir_create,dumpdir_free,dumpdir_locate)
(dumpdir_first,dumpdir_next): New functions.
* src/incremen.c (dumpdir_create0,dumpdir_create,dumpdir_free)
(dumpdir_first,dumpdir_next): New functions.
(dumpdir_locate): Rewrite using binary search.
(struct directory): Change members char *contents, *icontents to
struct dumpdir *dump, *idump. All references updated.
(note_directory): Last arg is const.
* src/names.c (add_hierarchy_to_namelist): buffer is const.
* tests/incr03.at, tests/incr04.at, tests/rename02.at,
tests/rename03.at: Insert calls to sleep between creation of files
and adding them to the archive.
2008-05-05 21:30:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
192860abb8 Update 2008-03-31 08:03:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c2d2e806a1 (dump_file0): Count links only for actually dumped files 2008-03-31 08:02:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2a89f7a0a8 * NEWS: Document --no-check-device and --check-device.
* doc/rendition.texi: Change the way FIXME-*refs are handled in
!PROOF.
* doc/intern.texi, doc/tar.texi: Update.
* doc/untabify.el: New file.
* doc/Makefile.am (EXTRA_DIST): Add untabify.el
(untabify, final, check-format, check-refs, check-fixmes)
(check-unrevised, all-check-docs, check-docs): New rules.
2008-03-27 10:11:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
71d2a66f42 * src/common.h (check_device_option): New global.
* src/incremen.c (procdir): Use boolean and instead of bitwise
one. Patch by Jean-Louis Martineau.
Compare device numbers only if check_device_option is set.
* src/tar.c: New command line options --no-check-device and
--check-device. Proposed by Jean-Louis Martineau.
(parse_opt): Hanlde new options.
(decode_options): Initialize check_device_option to true.
2008-03-27 08:56:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e496c1b529 * bootstrap: Use rsync to get translations.
* doc/tar.texi: Minor change.
* lib/.cvsignore: Update
* po/.cvsignore: Update
* src/system.c: Remove include setenv.h.
* tests/atlocal.in (STAR_DATA_URL): Update.
* tests/star/README: Update URL.
2008-03-06 08:17:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6667fa7fb8 Update 2008-02-09 10:36:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a16ad3112e Fix a typo 2008-02-09 10:35:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7efe3850f6 * NEWS: Update.
* configure.ac: Version 1.19.90
* po/POTFILES.in: Add missing files.
* src/compare.c (verify_volume): Honor --ignore-zeros.
Proposed by Jan-Benedict Glaw.
* tests/shortfile.at (AT_KEYWORDS): Add shortfile0.
2008-02-08 14:12:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d0694ee604 Update the description 2008-02-08 10:32:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
37f0faf1c0 (dump_file0): Apply transform_name to symlink targets. 2008-02-07 15:46:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b893aee6d2 Update 2008-02-07 15:46:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f60d655908 Update 2008-02-04 10:39:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
549481a0a7 Update 2008-02-04 10:38:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e08afc2002 Document changes to the --transform option. 2008-02-04 10:38:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
338591a486 Support multiple --transform options. Support semicolon-separated lists of replace expressions. 2008-02-04 10:35:20 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c0e0d06e69 * doc/tar.texi: Update Back-Cover text to reflect new GNU wording.
2007-12-17  Paul Eggert  <eggert@cs.ucla.edu>

Exit with nonzero status if a close fails on an archive.
Problem (and initial trivial fix)
* src/buffer.c (close_archive, new_volume): close_error, not close_warn.
2008-01-31 00:50:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6e85425618 Update 2007-12-05 09:48:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
336519aa4f Add shortupd.at. 2007-12-05 09:45:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5f4d99491d (check_compressed_archive): Do not bail out if the
file is too short, set boolean flag, passed as an argument
instead.  This fixes a bug introduced on 2007-08-24. See also
tests/shortupd.at.
2007-12-05 09:45:22 +00:00
Paul Eggert
48d83be336 Don't read from name[-1].
* src/incremen.c (make_directory): Handle namelen == 0, since
find_directory_meta calls make_directory ("").
2007-11-13 07:01:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
60d351cc5a Update 2007-11-07 08:48:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e33be3d0a1 Add fseeko and snprintf. 2007-11-07 08:48:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
32562b9412 (checkout): Use URL of the gnulib CVS mirror. 2007-11-07 08:48:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dfd87ba1d0 (magic): Fix lzma option 2007-10-31 13:10:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5d4a682a55 Update 2007-10-31 12:57:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8e3a2a520d (sys_exec_info_script,sys_exec_checkpoint_script): pass the current blocking factor in TAR_BLOCKING_FACTOR environment variable. 2007-10-31 12:56:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
745832a280 New actions: bell and ttyout 2007-10-31 12:56:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
458efab23b Minor fix 2007-10-30 14:58:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
23dcaa117f Update 2007-10-30 14:09:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5099ddf6cc Document --hard-dereference and --checkpoint-action options. Improve documentation of --check-links. 2007-10-30 14:09:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8476145508 Use texi2html and the CVS version of gendocs.sh to create HTML versions of the manual 2007-10-30 14:08:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
362492fe70 Use texi2html and the CVS version of gendocs.sh to create HTML versions of the manual 2007-10-30 14:08:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7111008659 Update 2007-10-29 16:57:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ec4741d732 (parse_opt): New options --hard-dereference, --checkpoint-action.
(decode_options): Call checkpoint_finish_compile.
2007-10-29 16:56:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bed7de0271 (sys_exec_checkpoint_script): New function.
(sys_exec_info_script): Restore SIGPIPE handler.
2007-10-29 16:56:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eaaadcfd36 (file_count_links): do nothing if hard_dereference_option is set. 2007-10-29 16:56:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a8830fbb86 (enum checkpoint_style): Remove.
(checkpoint_style): Remove.
(DEFAULT_CHECKPOINT): New define.
(hard_dereference_option): New variable.
(sys_exec_checkpoint_script): New declaration.
2007-10-29 16:55:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
848659f1c6 (checkpoint, do_checkpoint): Remove.
(_flush_write, simple_flush_read, _gnu_flush_read): Use
checkpoint_run.
2007-10-29 16:55:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
17cbd4862c checkpoint handling 2007-10-29 16:55:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
64ded9e702 (tar_SOURCES): add checkpoint.c 2007-10-29 16:54:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ccd0a527e4 Version 1.19.1 2007-10-29 16:54:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3f869877a4 Version 1.19.1 2007-10-29 16:53:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8c528937a9 Update 2007-10-29 16:53:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
460f4ec146 Update 2007-10-29 08:53:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eb59c14a1f (sys_exec_info_script): Initialize buf. Problem reported by Bengt-Arne Fjellner. 2007-10-29 08:51:46 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3c4f4ca423 Avoid compiler warnings.
* src/list.c (read_header_primitive): Define two locals, to
avoid incorrect "may be used uninitialized" warnings.
* src/incremen.c (procdir): Remove decl of unused local, "len".

expired.
SCALAR(0x830b08c)
2007-10-18 21:36:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
506b4db5d0 Update 2007-10-18 07:59:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5bfb6c5f9d (gzip): Remove compression patent warning. According to Brett Smith, the patent is expired. 2007-10-18 07:59:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3725b5606f Update 2007-10-17 09:12:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d1a7eebc30 Update 2007-10-17 09:12:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dfe280dcca Add Lasse Collin and Jean-Pierre Demailly. 2007-10-17 09:11:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
620a136e74 New options --auto-compress (-a) and --lzma 2007-10-17 09:11:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3fb5d67b28 (set_comression_program_by_suffix): New prototype. 2007-10-17 09:11:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c30a794679 (magic): Add an entry for new lzma format. Proposed by Lasse Collin 2007-10-17 09:11:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
00bb0d8f5c Add suffix.c 2007-10-17 09:10:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
af3e05b6af New file. Determine compression algorithm by archive file name suffix. Suggested by Jean-Pierre Demailly. 2007-10-17 09:10:34 +00:00
Paul Eggert
6060d613d1 * src/utf8.c (string_ascii_p): Recode to avoid bogus GCC 4.2.1
warning about "comparison is always true due to limited range of
data type" when char is unsigned.
2007-10-13 05:49:18 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3f12066739 Adjust to recent gnulib changes.
* configure.ac: Dont' check for strerror, since gnulib now does this.
* .cvsignore: Add m4, tar-[0-9]*.
* lib/.cvsignore: Adjust to various gnulib file name changes.
Add .deps, rmt-command.h.

SCALAR(0x830b0dc)
directories.

SCALAR(0x831ad2c)
2007-10-11 22:04:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3b74fbfc3b Update 2007-10-10 11:04:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
14d39a2c14 Update 2007-10-10 11:03:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7b57922073 Version 1.19 2007-10-10 11:03:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
05c6da4c62 Update 2007-10-05 11:21:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4ece30109d (dump_regular_file): Fix file padding in case of truncation to zero size. 2007-10-05 11:20:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
55f1eadbf2 Update 2007-10-04 07:16:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9b22262fc6 Use AT_DATA for sample output. 2007-10-04 07:16:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2de140fa95 Update 2007-10-03 20:18:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6f6864df13 (try_purge_directory): Ensure that arguments to T and R are safe. 2007-10-03 20:18:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
519a7c0c75 Update 2007-09-29 00:48:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1ef212d0fb (obstack_code_rename): Apply safer_name_suffix to name arguments before storing them in T and R records. Reported by Nicholas Cole. 2007-09-29 00:47:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
333780b227 Update 2007-09-27 09:16:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2c56ca0e7f Raise version number to 1.18.90 2007-09-27 09:16:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
63f8de655b Update 2007-09-27 08:05:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2743e1ba5b Document version 2 2007-09-27 08:05:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
40ece6bf4d Update 2007-09-26 22:08:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
63e835f5c0 New option --exclude-vcs
(exclude_vcs_files): New function
2007-09-26 22:08:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
efe6609cd9 (struct directory): New member tagfile
(make_directory): Initialize tagfile to NULL
(procdir): New argument: entry
Hanlde exclusion tags.
(makedumpdir): Take into account directory->tagfile.
(scan_directory): Hanlde exclusion tags.
2007-09-26 22:08:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b0d5935cb0 (exclusion_tag_warning, check_exclusion_tags): Remove static qualifier.
(check_exclusion_tags): account for dirname without terminating
slash.
(dump_dir0): exclusion_tag_all is handled elsewhere.
2007-09-26 22:07:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a1b1b7cc8a (exclusion_tag_warning, check_exclusion_tags): New prototypes 2007-09-26 22:06:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8940247418 Update 2007-09-26 22:06:24 +00:00
Paul Eggert
0dacafbbb0 * AUTHORS: Remove unnecessary information. Just list the
principal authors.
* THANKS: Remove info duplicated from AUTHORS.

SCALAR(0x82892dc)


SCALAR(0x8279918)

SCALAR(0x8289444)


stripping and name suffix normalization.
2007-09-14 21:00:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e3e50c987b Minor rewording 2007-09-08 08:49:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
923f0cda43 Update 2007-08-26 09:02:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c485b7984d (apply_nonancestor_delayed_set_stat): Rename st->sb to avoid shadowing another local. 2007-08-26 09:01:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d769b724f4 (diff_dumpdir): Rename stat->stat_data to avoid shadowing the syscall. 2007-08-26 09:01:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a0eb52da3f (check_exclusion_tags): Remove declaration of unused local, "ret". 2007-08-26 08:59:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
87ac3207fb Don't include <getline.h>. No longer needed. 2007-08-26 08:59:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c634f2c6f1 Raise version number to 1.18.1 2007-08-24 12:23:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5416153391 Update 2007-08-24 12:08:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5bb69a88d8 Add shortfile.at 2007-08-24 12:08:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0a848ff669 New test case for the today's change in src/buffer.c (1.111) 2007-08-24 12:08:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7c0b81cbb9 (check_compressed_archive): Detect files smaller than 512 bytes. 2007-08-24 12:07:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
862770bf91 Update 2007-08-19 09:17:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
89d682d0b9 Gnulib initialization destroyed paxutils m4 files.
Initialize paxutils structure after that of gnulib.
2007-08-19 09:17:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
764174dc1d Update 2007-08-12 08:25:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5ab30f709a (symlink_to_gnulib): Make sure the target directory exists and create it if it does not. 2007-08-12 08:25:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e2b8c8fa9f (contains_dot_dot): Fix double-dot recognition in case of duplicate /. Patch by Dmitry V. Levin. 2007-08-12 08:25:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
42250f5010 Update 2007-08-12 07:15:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
62571aa7c3 Fix a typo 2007-08-12 07:14:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
32f7047037 Update 2007-06-29 20:23:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a69be0adce Add to the repository 2007-06-29 20:22:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1fb35e7374 Final update for GPLv3 2007-06-29 20:20:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7e69b14775 Update 2007-06-28 17:01:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
625c45d304 Update for the change of the TP URL 2007-06-28 17:00:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3fe0f0d7f8 Update 2007-06-27 14:06:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c3d4fee823 Restore after an accidental remove 2007-06-27 13:46:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a0fb51e136 Relicense under GPLv3 2007-06-27 13:30:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ac8690fc4e Update copyright year 2007-06-21 08:52:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
395df04927 Update 2007-06-21 08:51:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
89a91c7b44 Skip test if genfile is unable to create the file 2007-06-21 08:51:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5635a428ab (AT_TAR_MKHIER): Skip test if genfile is unable to create the file 2007-06-21 08:50:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8b5f10a6c4 Resolve testsuite failures 40-42 on cygwin. 2007-06-21 07:12:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6e98015774 Update 2007-06-16 12:10:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bd13e18a63 Add back write permissions on dir 2007-06-16 12:10:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
01cf5c5315 New file 2007-06-16 12:09:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0dd814fac2 (Fixing Snapshot Files): New appendix 2007-06-16 12:09:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b27b516b68 (tar_TEXINFOS): Add tar-snapshot-edit.texi 2007-06-16 12:09:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c7f69c265b Update 2007-06-09 17:07:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bc00f45420 Sort the output 2007-06-09 17:07:46 +00:00
Paul Eggert
57304e8b0a Fix typo: occurence -> occurrence. 2007-06-08 18:49:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d3f04456e8 Raise version number to 1.17 2007-06-08 09:34:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d78083e82c Update 2007-06-08 08:27:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c8d4ceccc1 (Operation Summary): Restore alphabetical order of the options. 2007-06-08 08:27:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6287d3045f Update 2007-06-08 08:15:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9d3142805b s/(ASCII|ID|BSD)/@acronym{&}/;s/"[^"]+"/``&''/
Use `path' only when it refers to search paths, use
`file name' otherwise.
Fix various errors (based on patch by Benno Schulenberg)
2007-06-08 08:14:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
05eddc1a58 Update testsuite 2007-06-01 21:57:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
78bfbb5661 Update 2007-06-01 21:24:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fe576585e6 (decode_xform): Exempt symbolic links from component
stripping and name suffix normalization.
2007-06-01 21:24:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
080a6b2ac5 Update calls to transform_member_name 2007-06-01 21:24:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f236f33643 (xform_type): New data type
(transform_member_name): Last argument is of xform_type type
All callers updated
2007-06-01 21:23:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a4ffcfb875 Update 2007-05-30 19:15:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
967fcb9318 (decx): Unknown pax keywords produce a warning,not error. 2007-05-30 19:15:17 +00:00
Paul Eggert
12b3a5d5b1 * src/misc.c (set_file_atime): Use gl_futimens, not futimens,
due to gnulib change.

SCALAR(0x828a248)

SCALAR(0x828a404)
2007-05-29 16:48:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eeb610da48 Update 2007-05-19 17:04:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
749e20e6fa Update 2007-05-19 17:03:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
56f6556f94 (tarball_prereq): Discard eventual md5sum output. 2007-05-19 17:03:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
43c5343194 Minor fix 2007-05-19 17:03:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
250db35f17 Global extended_header removed, use new xheader calls instead. 2007-05-19 17:03:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6f929b2c89 (buffer_write_global_xheader): New function
Update to use new xheader calls.
2007-05-19 17:03:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
64cddf2fbc (xheader_init): New function
(xheader_decode_global,xheader_store,xheader_read)
(xheader_write_global,xheader_write,xheader_string_begin)
(xheader_string_add,xheader_string_end): Take xhdr as first
argument.
2007-05-19 17:02:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ccdbafb276 (struct xheader): New definition
(struct tar_stat_info): New member xhdr (extended header).
2007-05-19 17:02:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bd222d606a (buffer_write_global_xheader): New function
(struct xheader): Move definition to tar.h
(extended_header): Remove global
(xheader_init): New function
(xheader_decode_global,xheader_store,xheader_read)
(xheader_write_global,xheader_write,xheader_string_begin)
(xheader_string_add,xheader_string_end): Take xhdr as first
argument.
2007-05-19 17:02:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
94fb06f5db Fix typos 2007-05-18 09:14:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
74d217db74 Update 2007-05-18 08:22:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
17ef61b2fd (dump_file0): Original ctime cannot be used as a directory change indicator if --remove-files is given. 2007-05-18 08:22:21 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f32828d577 Adjust to latest Gnulib.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add dirfd.c, dirfd.h, float+.h, mbscasecmp.c,
stdio.h, stdio_.h, stdlib.h, stdlib_.h, time.h, time_.h, unistd.h.
Remove exit.h, getcwd.h, mempcpy.h, memrchr.h, mkdtemp.h, stpcpy.h,
strcase.h, strchrnul.h, strdup.h, strndup.h, strnlen.h, time_r.h,
vsnprintf.h.
* m4/.cvsignore: Remove localedir.h.  Sort.
2007-04-13 00:51:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e67e085421 Update 2007-04-03 21:52:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ca856c2585 (main): Don't call closeopen. 2007-04-03 21:52:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
18641602c1 Don't include <sys/time.h>, <sys/resource.h>; no longer needed. 2007-04-03 21:52:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8bdbc08a89 (closeopen): Remove decl. 2007-04-03 21:52:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a5d5cc599f Update 2007-04-03 21:38:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
761895d43c Update 2007-04-03 21:38:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5d4f057e31 (sys_exec_info_script): Store the inter-communication fd in the environment variable TAR_FD 2007-04-03 21:38:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7c0ba663c8 Update 2007-04-03 12:31:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
51118be241 Expect a warning on stderr 2007-04-03 12:30:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
69f5d77383 Update 2007-04-03 12:18:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d989864712 (main): Move closeopen after decode_options to allow shell process substitution to work. 2007-04-03 12:18:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
983d328ff2 Restore accidentally deleted lines 2007-03-30 19:28:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
586c684815 (transform_name_fp): Change signature. All callers updated. 2007-03-30 19:20:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bbf7dec45e Fix indentation 2007-03-30 19:19:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
40f79286ab Update 2007-03-30 19:18:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ebc522d521 (all_names_found): Remove check for matching_flags. 2007-03-30 19:18:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ad85f632c6 (transform_member_name): New function
(decode_header): Use transform_member_name
2007-03-30 19:18:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
062b37115f (extract_link, extract_symlink): Use
transform_member_name instead of safer_name_suffix so that
--transform and --strip-components affect links as well.
2007-03-30 19:18:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6261c58ae8 (transform_name_fp): Change signature
(transform_member_name): New function
2007-03-30 19:17:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
427bda01a3 Update 2007-03-30 08:50:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1d26fff0f3 Do not include mkdtemp.h 2007-03-30 08:50:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bb6b92e37d (slurp): Remove any occurrences of $bt from the generated gnulib.mk 2007-03-30 08:49:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8ca4064a8c Update 2007-03-30 08:49:38 +00:00
Paul Eggert
5c890a6003 Adjust to recent gnulib changes.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add fchownat.c, rmt-command.h, strerror.c, string.h,
string_.h, sys, sys_time_.h, unistd_.h, wchar_.h, wctype_.h.
Remove localedir.h, size_max.h, xsize.h.
* src/xheader.c: Don't include stpcpy.h; no longer needed, now that
gnulib string.h defines stpcpy on all platforms.
2007-01-26 23:02:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3705fd6452 Update 2007-01-23 10:26:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bde442ba15 Add exclude.at 2007-01-23 10:26:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9a8f1bc33 New test case 2007-01-23 10:26:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
66e9b9cd6c New options --exclude-caches-all, --exclude-caches-under, --exclude-tag-all, --exclude-tag-under 2007-01-23 10:25:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b9588c4722 (struct exclude_tag): rename to exclusion_tag
(check_exclusion_tags): New function
(cachedir_file_p): New function (from check_cache_directory)
(dump_dir0,dump_file0): Use check_exclusion_tags
2007-01-23 10:25:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9a41b3b3db (exclude_caches_option): Remove
(enum exclusion_tag_type): New data type
(add_exclude_tag): Rename to add_exclusion_tag
(cachedir_file_p): New prototype
2007-01-23 10:24:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
990e7d4437 Document --exclude-caches* and --exclude-tag* options. 2007-01-23 10:24:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
173d3229e3 Update 2007-01-19 15:43:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2d261da8f9 Version 1.16.2 2007-01-19 15:42:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
99527fa17b (sparse_skip_file,pax_dump_header_1)
(pax_decode_header): Keep track of the number of bytes written.
2007-01-19 15:42:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
868ee74028 (expand_sparse): use ftruncate to handle the trailing hole 2007-01-19 15:41:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8c90bf0414 Fix typos 2007-01-19 15:41:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
892cdea8a1 Require strerror 2007-01-19 15:41:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
00763876f1 Update 2007-01-04 20:06:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1a1cfaafa6 (list_dumpdir): Minor fixes. 2007-01-04 20:05:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
445d95be07 (diff_dumpdir): Compare directory contents using
dumpdir_cmp.  Do not free dumpdir_buffer, it will leave the
incremental directory table in the inconsistent state and trigger
full dump.
(read_and_process): Process dumpdirs no matter what the archive
format.
2007-01-04 20:05:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6fe55234c9 Update 2007-01-04 16:16:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e24d8574a8 (read_and_process): Fix type of "size" 2007-01-04 16:15:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4da5205ed6 Update 2006-12-13 08:22:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8241687465 Skip the test if genfile is not able to create the filename with an embedded newline. 2006-12-13 08:22:04 +00:00
Paul Eggert
8e3f3adf98 Port to Forte Developer 7 C 5.4 and C99.
* src/common.h (add_exclude_tag): Add decl; C99 requires this
and Forte warns about it.
* src/incremen.c: Include <mkdtemp.h> for mkdtemp prototype,
for same reason.
* src/misc.c (get_max_open_files): Rewrite to avoid code that
Forte C complains about as being unreachable.
* src/xheader.c (mtime_code): Rewrite to avoid Forte error
reported by Trond Hasle Amundsen.

* src/incremen.c (compare_dirnames): Rewrite to avoid casts.
* src/utf8.c (string_ascii_p): Likewise.
* src/xheader.c (mtime_coder, volume_size_coder, volume_offset_coder):
Likewise.

SCALAR(0x8283218)
2006-12-12 23:56:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e5ef01710a Fix wording 2006-12-08 16:59:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e70e63612a Update 2006-12-08 16:45:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
28b26242c7 Add paxutils files to dot_ignore. 2006-12-08 16:45:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6b279a6f8c Update 2006-12-08 13:40:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
079f2d6807 Raise version number to 1.16.1 2006-12-08 13:40:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b09417ca8d (slurp): Create .(cvs|git)ignore if not present 2006-12-08 13:39:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b15e3f1bbd Remove autogenerated files 2006-12-08 12:42:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1616b1d1b4 Update 2006-12-07 14:35:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f23bc997fd Update 2006-12-07 14:34:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8ec119a27f Update 2006-12-07 14:34:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e35d05b1d2 Use genfile instead of dd, because on some systems /dev/zero is not available. 2006-12-07 14:34:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cdb77dcd7b (extract_file): Call skip_member if open fails.
Patch proposed by Jan-Benedict Glaw <jbglaw@lug-owl.de>
2006-12-07 14:33:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9bf87b195e (dump_dir0): Move checks for exclude tags to
dump_file0.
(dump_dir): Move calls to ensure_slash to dump_file0
2006-12-07 14:33:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
643e3f2441 Update documentation of --exclude-tag 2006-12-07 14:33:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6e75833cb7 (distclean-local): Fixed 2006-12-07 14:33:17 +00:00
Paul Eggert
908d78d208 * NEWS: Fix some race conditions with tar -x --same-owner.
* src/extract.c (ARCHIVED_PERMSTATS): Add a comment saying that
S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO might be masked out.
(set_mode): Set the mode if some bits were masked out originally.
(set_stat): Don't chmod before chown, as that might temporarily
grant permissions that we don't want to grant.  The chmod was
there only to work around broken hosts, so add a comment advising
users not to use those broken hosts instead.
(repair_delayed_set_stat, extract_dir):
Remember to mask out current umask before inverting permissions.
(extract_dir): If the owner might change, or if the mode has
special bits, create the directory 700 at first, but restore it later.
(open_output_file): New arg mode; all uses changed.
(extract_file, extract_node, extract_fifo): If the owner might
change, omit group and other bits at first, but restore them after
changing the owner.
2006-12-04 21:35:56 +00:00
Paul Eggert
192f55e2a0 * doc/tar.texi (Long Options): Remove doubled word. 2006-12-04 09:33:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9d99fd13cd Update 2006-11-30 09:54:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
07902e9f9a (xheader_read): Remove unused variable 2006-11-30 09:53:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0c94a109b9 Update 2006-11-30 09:42:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
27094c4fc3 Implement --update-po and .bootstrap 2006-11-30 09:42:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5aca761e1b Remove src/mangle.c 2006-11-30 09:41:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cc82db7f2d (exclude): Document --exclude-tag 2006-11-30 09:41:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
137ebf41fd (dump_dir0): Implement --exclude-tag option 2006-11-30 09:40:47 +00:00
Paul Eggert
49ea4c5057 * NEWS: Remove support for mangled names.
* doc/tar.texi (verbose tutorial): Likewise.
* src/Makefile.am (tar_SOURCES): Remove mangle.c.
* src/common.h (extract_mangle): Remove decl.
* src/extract.c (extract_mangle_wrapper): Remove.
(prepare_to_extract): Remove support for mangled names.
* src/list.c (read_and, print_header): Likewise.
* src/mangle.c: Remove.
* src/tar.h (GNUTYPE_NAMES): Remove.
2006-11-30 06:39:29 +00:00
Paul Eggert
409bddf38c * lib/.cvsignore: Add fstatat.c, gnulib.mk, openat-proc.c, same-inode.h, stat_.h,
tempname.c, tempname.h, uinttostr.c.
2006-11-30 06:27:24 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c930802f31 Port to latest gnulib. There were a lot of changes, so the
simplest way to get this up and running was to switch to coreutils
bootstrap procedure.  I noticed one feature missing after this
merge: the ability to update a single .po file.  I can add that
later if need be.
* README-cvs, bootstrap.conf: New files.
* lib/.cvsignore: Remove Makefile.am, printf-parse.c, vasnprintf.c.
* lib/printf-parse.c, lib/vasnprintf.c: New files, from coreutils,
to override gnulib, so that we don't need xsize.h.
* bootstrap: Replace with coreutils bootstrap, except add support
for paxutils.
* configure.ac (gl_USE_SYSTEM_EXTENSIONS): Remove, as gl_EARLY now
does this.
(gl_EARLY, gl_INIT): Add.
(tar_GNULIB): Remove.
* gnulib.modules: Add configmake.
* lib/Makefile.tmpl: Remove, replacing with....
* lib/Makefile.am: New file.
* src/Makefile.am (tar.o): Remove dependency: Automake does this
for us.
* src/tar.c: Include <configmake.h> and <rmt-command.h>, not
<localedir.h>.
2006-11-30 00:14:10 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ca14885884 Remove trailing white space. 2006-11-29 18:28:45 +00:00
Paul Eggert
01d6188297 Remove trailing white space. 2006-11-29 18:16:27 +00:00
Paul Eggert
759c5208c5 Remove trailing white space. 2006-11-29 18:11:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8457e06b99 Do not depend on command timing. 2006-11-13 10:42:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8719c4f680 Update 2006-11-13 10:41:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
574022ab78 Do not use 'k' modifier in dd options. 2006-11-13 10:41:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
304d8b9f0c (start_header): Pass mtime as a call-specific data to xheader_store. 2006-11-13 10:39:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6712656eb2 (mtime_coder): Treat non-null data as a pointer to struct timespec, overriding st->mtime 2006-11-13 10:39:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
415d9c9e15 Update copyright year 2006-11-01 00:30:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1a8141ab8a Update 2006-11-01 00:24:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
023c766600 Do not assume tar's default archive is stdout 2006-11-01 00:24:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fdb46aa2e2 Add more keywords 2006-11-01 00:24:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2504e7d3ae Add new test cases. 2006-11-01 00:23:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b0765e257c (enum read_file_list_state.file_list_skip): New value
(read_name_from_file): Skip zero-length entries
2006-11-01 00:23:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
73d4c40a87 Update 2006-10-31 20:19:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7aed52718f Call last_component instead of base_name. The latter returns a malloced string since 2006-03-11. 2006-10-31 20:18:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f572ca0cfb Update 2006-10-21 16:48:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29236a68fa (distclean-local): New rule 2006-10-21 16:47:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a4b1564d4a Version 1.16 2006-10-21 16:47:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
94d0385a57 Update 2006-10-17 08:14:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
603c1d60a6 Fix help output formatting. Thanks Benno Schulenberg. 2006-10-17 08:13:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29e9004b69 Update 2006-10-16 07:51:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8da152d2b3 Update 2006-10-16 07:49:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
00746182f3 (dist-hook): Create a cpio archive. 2006-10-16 07:48:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6c8815909d Update 2006-10-14 21:13:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fde336b21a (AT_KEYWORDS): Keyword `filechange'
Test tar exit status.
2006-10-14 21:12:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
394b12d950 New test grow.at 2006-10-14 21:12:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
372638ae7a Do not attempt to close stderr after call to close_stdout. 2006-10-14 21:11:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c455373e5b (dump_regular_file,dump_file0): Set exit_status to
TAREXIT_DIFFERS if the file being dumped was truncated or
otherwise changed.
2006-10-14 21:11:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f2541c66cd (Synopsis): Document tar exit codes. 2006-10-14 21:11:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7e6d54d0c0 Update 2006-10-14 10:48:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
876e554157 (AT_KEYWORDS): Add stdout keyword 2006-10-14 10:46:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1118d24fd3 New test verbose.at 2006-10-14 10:46:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dc6f7ebf20 (_open_archive): Make sure stdlis is set to stderr
when we are writing archive to stdout (unless --index-file is
used). Bug introduced on 2006-07-06.
2006-10-14 10:45:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1102eeef1f Update 2006-10-02 15:45:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e8a4c35a73 Add new testcase: multiv05.at: 2006-10-02 15:44:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e359fad641 (xheader_string_end): Fix diagnostic message. 2006-10-02 15:44:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f5504a3bae (new_volume): Initialize current_block 2006-10-02 15:44:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
341be8f405 Add Joerg Weilbier 2006-10-02 15:43:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4f2a22f306 Update 2006-09-27 09:03:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a76ab340dd (doc0, doc1, initialize_argp_doc): Removed. Rely on the new argp method instead 2006-09-27 09:03:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3ad3ca8734 Minor fix 2006-09-27 09:03:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
82b2829e10 Use ${package} instead of hardcoding package name 2006-09-27 09:02:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f852428d5f Update 2006-09-12 09:59:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
86e91a5bfc Fix typo 2006-09-12 09:56:39 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ec5743a628 * tests/testsuite.at (AT_TAR_MKHIER): Use install-sh -d
rather than the no-longer-included mkinstalldirs.
2006-09-08 23:29:43 +00:00
Paul Eggert
bf7f4fdc1e Add at-func.c, configmake.h, fchmodat.c,
fcntl.h, fcntl_.h, inttypes_.h, lstat.c, lstat.h.
2006-09-08 23:27:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
98b9522499 Update 2006-09-08 16:47:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6398dbe1a5 List texinfo among build prerequisites for the CVS version. 2006-09-08 16:47:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
37724f5e20 (try_purge_directory): Initialize struct st. Fix condition for selecting candidates for removal. 2006-09-08 16:45:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c8c351684c (intl_files_to_remove): Do not remove m4/inttypes-h.m4 and m4/inttypes-pri.m4 2006-09-08 15:17:56 +00:00
Paul Eggert
01b6fb98bf * bootstrap: Set XGETTEXT_OPTIONS to flag our printf-format functions,
so that translators are warned about strings that are formats but
don't look like formats.  This might help prevent core dumps.
* configure.ac (AM_GNU_GETTEXT): Upgrade to need-formatstring-macros.
Suggested by Eric Blake to avoid problems like
<http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-coreutils/2006-07/msg00087.html>.
(AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION): Upgrade from 0.12.1 to 0.15.  The gettext
manual says we should use the version number normally expected of
maintainers, neither more nor less.
2006-08-11 21:39:36 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f1309bffbf * bootstrap (get_translations):
Don't exclude ky.po; it is working again.
2006-08-11 07:44:21 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c732eb584e * bootstrap: Don't exclude ja.po; it is working again.
Don't remove all old .po files if we're merely updating one.
* po/.cvsignore: Add Makevars.
2006-08-09 18:30:16 +00:00
Paul Eggert
0680ad4d42 * src/tar.c: Work around limitation imposed by gettext 0.15
by concatenating strings with "\v" after translation.
(doc): Remove, splitting into:
(doc0, doc1): New constants.
(argp): Don't use doc; just initialize to NULL.
(initialize_argp_doc): New function.
(decode_options): Use it.
2006-08-08 05:28:32 +00:00
Paul Eggert
1942370acd Fix typo: remove po/tar.html. 2006-08-07 22:58:12 +00:00
Paul Eggert
94de7c4c77 * bootstrap: Redo po file retrieval to match Bison's method,
since the translation project changed its index format.
Don't use --assume-autoconf; it's now replaced
by looking in configure.ac.
(m4/codeset.m4, m4/intdiv.m4, m4/inttypes-pri.m4, m4/isc-posix.m4):
(m4/lcmessage.m4, m4/onceonly_2_57.m4, m4/gettext.m4, m4/glibc21.m4):
(m4/inttypes_h.m4, m4/lib-ld.m4, m4/lib-prefix.m4, m4/po.m4):
(m4/stdint_h.m4, m4/uintmax_t.m4, m4/ulonglong.m4):
Don't rename to ..._gl.m4, as this is no longer needed.
(m4/geteext.m4): Patch to remove the need for intl/*.
Use autopoint manually, then remove the intl files,
then undo changes to gnulib files that autoreconf made,
and then run aclocal/autoconf/autoheader/automake.
This makes our bootstrap procedure closer to Bison's.
(po/Makevars): Generate automatically.
* configure.ac (AC_PREREQ): Update from 2.59 to 2.60.
(gl_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T, jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T): Remove.
* gnulib.modules: Add inttypes, stdint.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add close-stream.c, close-stream.h,
stdint.h, stdint_.h.
* po/Makefile: Remove; now automatically generated.
2006-08-07 22:57:25 +00:00
Paul Eggert
05805868f2 (read_incr_db_01): Check input strings more
carefully.  Do not pass arbitrary char values to isspace, as
this has undefined behavior.  Likewise for assigning arbitrary
uintmax_t values to other types.
(read_negative_num, read_unsigned_num, read_timespec):
New functions, to check input values a bit more carefuly.
(read_num): Use read_unsigned_num.  New arg MAX_VAL;
all callers changed.
(read_incr_db_2): Use these new functions.
Use a consistent diagnostic for unexpected EOF.
(read_directory_file): Do not assign arbitrary uintmax_t value
to int.
(read_timespec, write_directory_file_entry, write_directory_file):
Handle negative time_t values correctly.  We don't bother to do
this with pre-2 formats, since presumably the time stamps were
output incorrectly.
2006-08-07 21:29:27 +00:00
Paul Eggert
57aa98047e gettext 0.15 rejects this. 2006-08-07 21:12:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7573967406 Update 2006-07-24 09:14:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ab8711413c Add append02.at 2006-07-24 09:14:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9fd9a0913d New test case 2006-07-24 09:13:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f4e4adea80 (to_chars_subst): Update comment regarding OLDGNU
vs. GNU format differences.
(mode_to_chars): Treat OLDGNU_FORMAT same as GNU_FORMAT. Fixes bug
reported by TAMUKI Shoichi <tamuki@linet.gr.jp>, which caused
equivalent `tar cf ...' and `tar rf ...' commands to produce
different archives.
2006-07-24 09:13:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7110641821 (decode_options): Do not require -L with -M -Hpax.
It could be needed in future, but currently it is not.
2006-07-24 09:12:55 +00:00
Paul Eggert
fce454b5ca * bootstrap: Adjust to today's change to gnulib-tool by invoking
it with --assume-autoconf='latest-stable'.
2006-07-20 16:57:31 +00:00
Paul Eggert
8ad985ea6c Adjust to recent gnulib changes.
* lib/.cvsignore: Remove atexit.c, exit.c, getndelim2.c, getndelim2.h,
pathmax.h, paxconvert.c, paxerror.h, xstrdup.c.
Add inttypes.h, mktime.c, wcwidth.h, xstrndup.c, xstrndup.h.
* src/create.c (start_header): Adjust to API change to mode_adjust.
2006-07-17 05:47:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
37edfd9e8f Update 2006-07-09 11:26:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
016f7c87a7 Update 2006-07-09 11:26:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
52b8bea074 Add Ralf Wildenhues 2006-07-09 11:25:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5addfdcb03 Fix some typos 2006-07-09 11:25:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e707b47aba Fix entry ordering 2006-07-06 20:10:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
76dc519f9f Update 2006-07-06 20:08:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2a00376816 (TESTSUITE_AT): Add indexfile.at 2006-07-06 20:08:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9766528b07 Include indexfile.at 2006-07-06 20:08:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f26a90783b New test case 2006-07-06 20:08:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
36fe16aaf5 (decode_options): Initialize stdlis 2006-07-06 20:07:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
89f1667fdb (_open_archive): Remove stdlis initialization 2006-07-06 20:05:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f2d65dda39 Update 2006-07-05 06:46:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8370746251 (FIXME): Do not use deprecated @quote-args.
Do not use @allow-recursion. In its current form the macro is not
recursive.
2006-07-05 06:46:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2614af6d3c (manual): Fix TEXINPUTS 2006-07-05 06:46:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
614def3113 Update 2006-07-04 21:53:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b6365e9b03 Update 2006-07-04 21:52:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bf789e3642 Update --directory description 2006-07-04 21:52:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1421ee630d (main): Call closeopen 2006-07-04 21:52:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9869d0ae17 (chdir_arg): Use x2nrealloc to reallocate wd.
(get_max_open_files,closeopen): New functions
(chdir_do): Do not use save_cwd if it was already used more than
max_open_files-4 times to avoid running off the file
descriptors.
2006-07-04 21:52:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
edc0b12c5e (closeopen): New function 2006-07-04 21:51:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
808cafa454 (AC_CHECK_FUNCS): Check for getdtablesize 2006-07-04 21:51:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d1dedae402 (update_po): Fix single translation update 2006-07-03 16:46:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
de754902da Update 2006-06-27 13:39:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bc7f4ad027 Update 2006-06-26 14:42:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
55abc110f5 Add cross-references 2006-06-26 14:42:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4d753fced1 Minor fixes 2006-06-26 12:48:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85a4e0fdeb Do not depend on getopt.h 2006-06-26 11:18:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
583415c2c1 Update 2006-06-26 08:09:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6488588c5f Update 2006-06-26 08:08:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ac40b1e6f6 Update 2006-06-25 12:46:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4bf5f6dca4 --sparse-version turns on --sparse 2006-06-25 12:46:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ecaff7cbba Use ST_IS_SPARSE instead of sparse_file_p (update paxutils first) 2006-06-25 12:45:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ea9e2d8d8e (sparse_file_p): Remove 2006-06-25 12:45:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
39e5d9182c (Other Tars): New node describing how to extract
GNU-specific member formats using third-party tars.
2006-06-25 12:45:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c7aa519f09 (tar_TEXINFOS): Sorted 2006-06-25 12:44:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bf5ba3dbef A sample utility to expand sparse files
extracted by third-party tars. It is not meant to be installed nor
to be included in the distribution. It is here, so that it can be
obtained either from CVS or from the tar web site.
2006-06-25 12:44:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ea368b6d1b Update 2006-06-24 16:50:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d0201294c0 (xhdr_tab.decoder): pass keyword as a second
argument. All callers changed.
(decode_record): Check for numeric overflow
(xheader_string_end): Return boolean value. Check for possible
numeric overflow
2006-06-24 16:49:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c5b15c4ac1 (segm_count): Change type to size_t 2006-06-24 16:49:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4b3dd17c00 (pax_dump_header_0): Return false if
xheader_string_end fails (for 0.1 formats).
(pax_dump_header): Return meaningful value
2006-06-24 16:48:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d339cc38af Remove not used variables 2006-06-24 16:48:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
796a69787e (extract_volhdr): Add missing return 2006-06-24 16:48:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4c54e234c1 (name_init): New prototype.
(xheader_string_end): Return bool.
2006-06-24 16:47:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c027e03924 (print_total_stats): Add default case 2006-06-24 16:47:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6d615f12d4 Update 2006-06-23 15:24:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8f970d2c1e Include sparsemvp.at, spmvp00.at, spmvp01.at, spmvp10.at 2006-06-23 15:24:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d04af8f714 Rewritten as an include file.
(TAR_MVP_TEST): New macro
2006-06-23 15:24:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e2ecb82711 Explicitely give `-f -' to the tar invocation 2006-06-23 15:23:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8e2e731733 Add spmvp00.at, spmpv01.at, spmpv10.at 2006-06-23 15:23:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
19a63e523d Implement new keywords: GNU.sparse.name, GNU.sparse.major, GNU.sparse.minor, GNU.sparse.realsize 2006-06-23 15:22:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5679d3020e (struct tar_stat_info.sparse_major,sparse_minor): New members 2006-06-23 15:22:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1001c1b326 New option --sparse-version 2006-06-23 15:22:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
090d1d36ae Implement sparse format versioning. Implement new
version (1.0) of PAX sparse format.
(pax_sparse_member_p): Fix condition
(pax_dump_header): A dispatcher function
(pax_dump_header_0,pax_dump_header_1): New functions.
(pax_optab): Update
(oldgnu_dump_header): Minor fix: make sure
sparse_header.isextended is set before calling
set_next_block_after
2006-06-23 15:21:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2e1f904f2c (tar_sparse_major,tar_sparse_minor): New globals. 2006-06-23 15:20:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6a0b5421b9 Update master menu 2006-06-23 15:19:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9c764b14a9 (Sparse Formats): New node 2006-06-23 15:19:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ae67839879 (tar_TEXINFOS): Add sparse.texi 2006-06-23 15:19:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9588a106a7 New files 2006-06-23 15:18:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b3627f3f07 Update 2006-06-21 10:44:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ca7df3fe6b Raise version number to 1.15.92 2006-06-21 10:44:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ab19642053 Implement new option, --mtime, allowing to set
modification times for all archive members during creation.
(struct tar_args): textual_date_option replaced with a linked list
textual_date. All references updated.
(get_date_or_file,report_textual_dates): New functions.
2006-06-21 10:40:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a71b154289 (start_header): Override mtime if requested 2006-06-21 10:40:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ceaef10443 (set_mtime_option,mtime_option): New globals 2006-06-21 10:39:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5da6733724 (Overriding File Metadata): New node
Document --mtime option.
2006-06-21 10:39:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8d6c177ecb update 2006-06-20 15:15:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1ecd6672e1 (GNU.sparse.name): New variable for storing sparse file name. 2006-06-20 15:14:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ca2f855c90 (pax_dump_header): Store original sparse file name
in GNU.sparse.name variable. The name field in the ustar header
now contains generated name (%d/GNUSparseFile.%p/%f), so that
non-pax-aware tars won't extract the file under the original
filename.
2006-06-20 15:14:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
693134a4e7 (name_next_elt): Call register_individual_file
(namelist_match): Remove third argument
(name_match): Change return type to bool
(name_scan): Remove second argument
2006-06-20 15:14:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
90cec95580 (maybe_backup_file): Second argument is bool 2006-06-20 15:14:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b6fcb4ba8f (procdir): Use is_individual_file to check for
files explicitely specified in the command line. Fixes bug
reported by Dat Head on 19 Jun 2006 (descending into mountpoints
with --one-file-system in use)
2006-06-20 15:13:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6d1e9ab67e Remove second argument from calls to name_scan 2006-06-20 15:13:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
300210aa15 (struct name.explicit): Remove
Use variable names in all declarations
(name_scan): Remove second argument
2006-06-20 15:13:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
532b2dd31f Fix typo in a comment 2006-06-16 07:19:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3358f5fcc3 Update 2006-06-13 19:34:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
51e3f3f1ca Update 2006-06-13 14:59:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
caf6b29f1e (Using Multiple Tapes,Multi-Volume Archives): Rewritten 2006-06-13 14:59:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
12ae9f6912 Update 2006-06-13 13:35:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
64041696c9 (xopindex,opsummary): New macros 2006-06-13 13:35:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8ee09b9939 Define op as codeindex. Use xopindex and opsummary to
populate it
Consequently prefer @dfn{long options} over @dfn{mnemonic
options}.
Document --unquote, --no-unquote
(Short Option Summary): Build a table of cross-references to the
corresponding long options.
2006-06-13 13:35:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
72f60f9e5f (FIXME) [!PROOF_FOOTNOTED]: Enclose in a cartouche 2006-06-13 13:34:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
378818cb3e (check-options): Expand macros before grepping in $(info_TEXINFOS) 2006-06-13 13:34:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c980a06329 Update 2006-06-12 22:51:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4c7a2b10b8 Implement --overwrite-dir option (long ago documented) 2006-06-12 22:50:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8f3ed604b9 Update 2006-06-12 22:50:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b886724818 (check-options): New goal 2006-06-12 22:49:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f143fa5d64 Update 2006-06-12 13:21:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1e3568d947 (options, parse_opt): Allow for optional argument to
the --totals option, which specifies a signal upon delivery of which
the statistics must be output.
(main): Call print_total_stats if total_option is set.
2006-06-12 13:20:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b229a86dd7 (check_time): Use volume_start_time when checking
for the timestamp plausability.
2006-06-12 13:19:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
05b250d4a4 (records_skipped): Remove static qualifier, the
variable is used by print_total_stats in buffer.c
2006-06-12 13:19:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
42d180b24e (volume_start_time,last_stat_time): New globals
(print_total_written): Replaced with:
(print_total_stats): New function
2006-06-12 13:18:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8c10111c66 (total_blocks_deleted): New variable
(set_start_time): Set volume_start_time and last_stat_time as well
(set_volume_start_time): New function
(compute_duration): Do not call set_start_time, update
last_stat_time instead. Use it in calculation instead of
start_time, which is now set only once, upon startup.
(print_total_written): Removed.
(print_total_stats): New function for printing byte/speed statistics.
(_open_archive): Detect attempts to update compressed archives.
(_gnu_flush_write): Always update prev_written.
(open_archive): Call set_volume_start_time.
2006-06-12 13:18:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
15a55db341 Update 2006-06-12 13:17:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e721e74259 Document better the --totals option. 2006-06-12 13:17:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1bea3b4b25 Update 2006-06-11 20:07:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4ef056729e (xheader_set_single_keyword): Fix typo.
(decode_time): Avoid using gotos.
2006-06-11 20:06:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
37986cdff9 Update 2006-06-11 15:05:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5fe07ac97d Update master menu 2006-06-11 15:05:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a35935e973 (master-menu): New goal 2006-06-11 15:04:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e832cab432 New file 2006-06-11 15:04:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
578f46309f Update 2006-06-10 09:55:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4396675861 Remove leftover include 2006-06-10 09:54:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a3dd97d9be Update 2006-06-09 13:55:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
13adf3f762 Update 2006-06-09 13:50:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f1b1e9a476 Fix indentation, introduce end-of-format marker for texify.sed 2006-06-09 13:50:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fc4502c17e Update 2006-06-09 13:49:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0abf3a5ac9 Fix typo 2006-06-09 13:49:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
19b36aaf60 Auxiliary script to convert ../src/tar.h to header.texi 2006-06-09 13:48:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9b44f8efed *** empty log message *** 2006-06-09 13:46:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
97bfe578ed New file 2006-06-09 13:46:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fb88325f56 (tar_TEXINFOS): Add intern.texi
(EXTRA_DIST): Remove convtexi.pl, add texify.sed
2006-06-09 13:46:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a1b2406646 Update 2006-06-08 22:36:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5e14ef32c0 Minor fixes. 2006-06-08 22:35:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f9bd340c1b --checkpoint takes an optional argument specifying
number of records between two successive checkpoints (proposed
by Jason Armistead on 2004-06-22).Optional dot starting the
argument means "print dots instead of textual checkpoints".
(tar_help): New function
2006-06-08 22:35:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
46defea70e (checkpoint_option): Change type to unsigned
(checkpoint_style): New variable.
2006-06-08 22:34:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5daab19c27 Implement more flexible checkpoint style 2006-06-08 22:34:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7214086d3d Update 2006-06-08 22:34:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
93560dd669 Add Jason Armistead 2006-06-08 22:33:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c1f55f1c37 Update 2006-06-08 14:43:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2d2e1d411e (dumpdir_locate,obstack_code_rename,purge_directory): Re-implement renaming. Introduce
X control code.
(make_tmp_dir_name): Remove
2006-06-08 14:43:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5591fa407a Document dumpdir format 2006-06-08 14:42:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e2dbba2f07 (tar_TEXINFOS): Add dumpdir.texi 2006-06-08 14:42:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
018de58373 New file 2006-06-08 14:41:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
17111bef8f Add mkdtemp 2006-06-08 14:41:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3a9f2ea587 Update 2006-06-08 09:51:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
02c7b862a3 (add_char_segment): Fix length assignement 2006-06-08 09:50:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9154c0c43b Update 2006-06-08 09:43:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5108a3dc41 Update 2006-06-08 09:34:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c52e5fc4e8 Update 2006-06-08 09:28:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0fc3177ed2 Update 2006-06-08 09:27:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6be1349236 (set_transform_expr,_transform_name_to_obstack): Implement NUMBER flag. 2006-06-08 09:27:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a2625311c8 Update 2006-06-07 14:57:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6e2760f7d7 Update 2006-06-07 14:57:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8b2f4ad670 (_transform_name_to_obstack,set_transform_expr): Implement case conversion operations (GNU extension). 2006-06-07 14:57:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d4c0836ec2 Update 2006-06-06 21:36:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
40afe4d362 Update 2006-06-06 21:35:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
435edb824e (transform_name_fp): Run fun even if _transform_name_to_obstack returns false. 2006-06-06 21:33:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9d2e8df195 Update 2006-06-06 21:30:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
aa7476a68e Update 2006-06-03 20:53:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
16c48ef8d0 Update 2006-06-02 15:07:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0da8aac59f Use genfile --files-from 2006-06-02 15:06:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bb6f707781 Fix typo in the comment 2006-06-02 15:06:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7cb01d37bb Add incr04.at 2006-06-02 15:06:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d79bbe0fd1 (set_transform_expr): New function 2006-06-02 15:05:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f984c43b82 Update 2006-06-02 15:05:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d75890c1b8 (options): Minor rewording 2006-06-02 10:54:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b3b4347821 Update 2006-06-02 10:42:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
39080c7628 Update 2006-06-02 08:08:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c58063c17a New option --transform
New option --show-transformed-names generalizes
--show-stored-names. The latter is retained as an alias.
2006-06-02 08:06:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ae7bd36423 (print_header): Update displayable name selection. 2006-06-02 08:05:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
973b611290 (extract_archive): safer_name_suffix and stripped_prefix_len are now called by decode_header 2006-06-02 08:04:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29fb7356df (dump_file0): Transform file name 2006-06-02 08:03:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bbee515590 (transform_name, transform_name_fp): New functions
(show_stored_names_option): Renamed to
show_transformed_names_option. All uses changed
2006-06-02 08:03:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c8aa01c80c New file 2006-06-02 08:02:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
43ba23114f (tar_SOURCES): New module transform.c 2006-06-02 08:01:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7bfcbd6a27 Update 2006-06-02 08:01:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c5fd5f9e8d Update 2006-05-31 12:45:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a23a95b4a0 (make_directory): Fix initialization of struct directory. 2006-05-31 12:45:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
19498c9172 Initialize AM_CPPFLAGS 2006-05-25 19:29:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
edff149522 Update 2006-05-25 14:13:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f20e08dd45 (parse_opt): Add comment before --preserve case. 2006-05-25 14:12:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e6d15fc7af Updated 2006-05-25 14:12:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c96ba08e06 Update 2006-05-25 11:02:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6f89b1fce5 Document use of wildcards 2006-05-25 11:02:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
93f8f6780a Update 2006-05-25 07:05:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
75f37f4cef Make AT_SETUP more readable. 2006-05-25 07:05:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3947e63c25 (options): Move globbing-related options into a
separate group. Set -l as an alias to --check-links, as required
by UNIX98
(struct tar_args): New fields
wildcards,matching_flags,include_anchored
(MAKE_EXCL_OPTIONS,MAKE_INCL_OPTIONS): New macros
(parse_opt): Use x2nrealloc to grow archive_name_array.
Use MAKE_EXCL_OPTIONS,MAKE_INCL_OPTIONS to create appropriate
fnmatch options, and name_add_name,name_add_dir to handle member
name and -C arguments.
(decode_options): Likewise
(main): Remove call to init_names.
2006-05-25 07:05:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8b471d55ff Rewritten handling of member names in the command
line. Tar no longer attempts to guess globbing patterns, instead
it relies on --wildcard option.
(init_names): Removed.
(struct name_elt): New structure.
(name_array): Change type to struct name_elt. All references updated
(name_add_name,name_add_dir): New functions
(name_next_elt): New function
(name_next): Rewritten using name_next_elt.
(namelist_match): Rewritten pattern matching using
exclude_fnmatch.
(names_notfound): Warn if globbing patterns were used without
--wildcards option
2006-05-25 07:04:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c2c2df6c93 (dump_file,dump_file0): First argument is const char*. All callers updated. 2006-05-25 07:04:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cf857388c1 (struct name): Refactured
(warn_regex_usage): New variable.
(dump_file): First argument is const char*.
(name_init,name_add): Removed
(name_add_name,name_add_dir): New functions
(name_next): Return const char*.
2006-05-25 07:03:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9dfad74683 (AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE): Use tar-ustar option. Raise version requirement to 1.9 2006-05-25 07:03:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
57267f7ed9 Update 2006-05-25 07:02:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
476abe556b Update 2006-05-23 07:10:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fe72c79ad8 (change_tape_menu): Fix typo (uninitialized variable) introduced yesterday. 2006-05-23 07:10:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8fea578b22 Update 2006-05-22 10:02:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a46704b1bf (change_tape_menu): Break the loop after obtaining new archive name. Check for empty input line 2006-05-22 10:02:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6f8cbc5ca8 Use @var{file_name} instead of @var{file name} 2006-05-22 10:01:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c03131aba9 Update 2006-05-15 09:52:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9195c75be (AT_TAR_CHECK): Declare expected failure if $XFAILFILE exists. 2006-05-15 09:52:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5632d195f5 Create $XFAILFILE on failure 2006-05-15 09:52:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ef90e05363 (XFAILFILE): New variable 2006-05-15 09:51:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
939d63b92d Update 2006-05-13 14:03:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0ff13351f0 Update 2006-05-13 14:01:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c57418b462 New file 2006-05-13 14:01:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3c7dd57a17 Update 2006-05-13 13:58:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0b3fe146dd Update 2006-05-13 12:16:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
90088ff00d Update 2006-05-13 12:02:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a183d6f7f5 Update 2006-05-13 12:00:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4883aab47d (AT_STAR_PREREQ): Provide md5 sum. 2006-05-13 11:59:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
30873dbd97 Add keywords. 2006-05-13 11:59:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
74849d8119 (AT_TARBALL_PREREQ): New defun
(AT_STAR_PREREQ): Rewrite using tarball_prereq
Include chtype.at and volsize.at
2006-05-13 11:59:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3962eb6a3e (TEST_DATA_URL,STAR_DATA_URL)
(STAR_TESTSCRIPTS): Provide default values.
(tarball_prereq): New function
2006-05-13 11:58:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c99076e925 (TESTSUITE_AT): Add chtype.at, volsize.at
(check-full): New target
2006-05-13 11:58:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6315d1700b (read_header_primitive): New function
(read_header): Front end for read_header_primitive
2006-05-13 11:57:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
520104f5f8 (extract_volhdr): New function
(prepare_to_extract): Use extract_volhdr as extractor for volume
names.
2006-05-13 11:57:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
34e5f66589 (read_header_primitive): New function 2006-05-13 11:57:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d2b3114a3b (read_header0): Use read_header_primitive to avoid clubbering current_tar_info. All callers updated. 2006-05-13 11:57:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2b27e8de1f Update 2006-05-13 11:56:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a85cfd69e3 (find_directory_meta): Bugfix 2006-05-13 08:38:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4b951034f3 Update 2006-05-08 12:48:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1524831224 Call AT_SORT_PREREQ. Remove fd 2 redirection after sort invocations 2006-05-08 12:46:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ee6f14194d Call AT_UNPRIVILEGED_PREREQ 2006-05-08 12:46:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ac7f4e853d (AT_SORT_PREREQ, AT_UNPRIVILEGED_PREREQ): New defines 2006-05-08 12:46:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
47dd75e87b Update 2006-05-08 12:12:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6054b5e9d5 (AT_KEYWORDS): Add missing incremental kw 2006-05-08 12:12:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
edd6df370d Update for the new behavior 2006-05-08 12:11:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fd89d5a3cd Add incr03.at,rename01.at,rename02.at,rename03.at 2006-05-08 12:11:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
71f2e412ae New testcase 2006-05-08 12:11:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
67877f7de2 (collect_and_sort_names): Update dir_contents of the first non-fake name entry when in listed incremental mode. 2006-05-08 12:10:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9e7465642 (struct directory.contents, flags): New members
(nfs,found,new): Remove. Replaced by appropriate bitmask values in
`flags' field. All uses updated.
(directory_meta_table): New table.
(hash_directory): Rename to hash_directory_name
(compare_directories): Rename to compare_directory_names
(hash_directory_meta,compare_directory_meta,find_directory_meta):
New functions
(compare_dirents): Removed
(note_directory): Get 7th argument: directory contents.
All callers updated
(dumpdir_locate,makedumpdir): New functions
(scan_directory): Rewritten. Use makedumpdir to create a sorted
dumpdir array. This makes the obstack argument unnecessary. Besides,
ALL_CHILDREN flag is set only for new directories.
(procdir): Change return type to struct directory. Return
immediately if the directory was already initialized. Discover
directory renames using directory_meta_table.
(append_incremental_renames): New function.
(read_directory_file, write_directory_file): Use new snapshot file
format.
2006-05-08 12:10:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a0b4431f26 (rename_directory): New function 2006-05-08 12:09:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
192ac7136a (rename_directory,append_incremental_renames): New functions. 2006-05-08 12:09:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c2775aedf1 Raise version number to 1.15.91 2006-05-08 12:09:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f1fe157dfe Update 2006-05-08 12:09:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dd197c5ccb Update 2006-05-02 19:16:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c576ac1354 Always use genfile --file, this enables extra error checking. 2006-05-02 19:16:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
53d1279719 Attempt to extract a member with truncated file name from the archive. 2006-05-02 19:15:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
729b91adb1 (try_new_volume): Attempt to continue if the name is apparently truncated in a GNU format volume. 2006-05-02 19:15:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dc7c0f1309 Update 2006-05-02 16:33:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
783e58b394 (_open_archive): Remove unnecessary argument to check_compressed_archive. 2006-05-02 16:32:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c0e5268e75 Update 2006-04-25 17:27:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1518cef987 (@copying): Remove the reference to not existing invariant section. 2006-04-25 17:26:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8dd9a2105e Skip the test if the file system does not support sparse files. 2006-04-25 17:23:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9ec31e3438 Update 2006-04-11 12:02:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d4a41d5311 New testcase 2006-04-11 12:01:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a46e6aa4dc Include extrac06.at 2006-04-11 12:01:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b4d40436fd (TESTSUITE_AT): Add extrac06.at 2006-04-11 12:00:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f97d80335a (directory.new): New member
(note_directory,find_directory: Use make_directory to create
struct directory entries
(procdir): Avoid duplicating  directories in the incremental
backup map.
2006-04-11 12:00:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
90b061cf55 Minor changes 2006-04-11 11:59:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8300c820d5 (extract_dir): Fix toggling existing directory
permissions. Use parts of patch provided by Ian Jackson
<iwj@ubuntu.com>.
2006-04-11 11:59:40 +00:00
Paul Eggert
e0b3fc61e1 * tests/atlocal.in (PATH): Add build-aux from the source tree,
not the build tree.
2006-03-19 04:04:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
533854fd45 Update 2006-03-13 09:46:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e99d4f83df Add Benno Schulenberg 2006-03-13 09:44:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b8d5835375 Sort the two lines of stderr from the
first `tar -v --listed-incremental'.  They would come out
reversed and provoke a test failure on a tmpfs
file system.
2006-03-13 09:43:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
61dd37ec86 (options): Consistently begin help messages with a lowercase letter. 2006-03-13 09:42:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
48d20d8f9e Minor fixes. 2006-03-13 09:42:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
adbbde5d4f Update 2006-03-11 22:42:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
208389f3ad (AM_CPPFLAGS): Define LOCALEDIR 2006-03-11 22:42:07 +00:00
Paul Eggert
db0f0804f5 Remove unistd_.h from lib/.cvsignore. 2006-03-08 02:00:47 +00:00
Paul Eggert
18486cf8d7 * src/buffer.c (record_buffer_aligned): New var.
(init_buffer): Use it to ensure that the buffer is aligned.
This doesn't result in any measurable performance improvement
on my host (Debian GNU/Linux 3.1 stable, with default block size),
but I assume it does help on some hosts.
2006-03-08 00:55:56 +00:00
Paul Eggert
6c1020d386 * lib/.cvsignore: Add unistd_.h. Sort. 2006-03-08 00:23:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
38c0884898 Update 2006-03-04 09:58:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7bcb876c5a Use -f - to read from stdin. 2006-03-04 09:57:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dfd5ec2519 Update 2006-02-21 07:10:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e81556858b Fix typo: --to-command instead of --to-program 2006-02-21 07:09:39 +00:00
Paul Eggert
92554b7c94 * tests/multiv04.at (split directory members in a MV archive):
Don't use %X in an awk printf format; this doesn't work with
Solaris 10 /usr/bin/awk.  Use %x instead.
2006-02-21 05:55:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
631de61428 Fix copyright years 2006-02-20 10:01:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8bfefd8854 Uniformly start all test titles with a lower case letter 2006-02-20 10:00:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f7a29307e2 Update 2006-02-20 09:45:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
66ef04d4c8 New test 2006-02-20 09:43:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b6ffcac4db (AT_TAR_MKHIER): New macro
(lustar01.at,lustar02.at,lustar03.at): New tests.
2006-02-20 09:43:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
28698a5334 Reword test title 2006-02-20 09:42:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e304b58fff Remove mkhier, use AT_TAR_MKHIER instead 2006-02-20 09:42:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c532f12464 Add build-aux to the PATH 2006-02-20 09:41:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9fdd5baa0c (lustar01.at,lustar02.at,lustar03.at): New tests. 2006-02-20 09:41:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
31ef7e3afb (split_long_name): Fix maximum length estimation. Patch by Jim Lowe. 2006-02-20 09:41:29 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f2bf9f2ffa Avoid installation glitches on Solaris 8 with Sun C 5.4.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add system-ioctl.h.
* lib/Makefile.tmpl (noinst_HEADERS): Add system-ioctl.h.
* src/buffer.c: Include system-ioctl.h.
* src/compare.c: Likewise.
* src/delete.c: Likewise.
* src/system.c: Include <getline.h>, <setenv.h>.
* src/tar.c: Include <getline.h>.
2006-02-20 08:15:31 +00:00
Paul Eggert
cad45a0bae * bootstrap: Don't claim lib/Makefile.am is generated automatically
from itself.
2006-02-20 08:14:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f6ede25815 Update 2006-02-19 21:13:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
476019d083 (new_volume): Prompt the user for archive name if unable to open next archive. 2006-02-19 21:12:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cf440a191f Update 2006-02-19 20:37:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
588f444efe (add_chunk_header): Free st.orig_file_name after calling finish_header() 2006-02-19 20:36:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b4051cb07c Updated 2006-02-19 19:28:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5032e08eb9 Raise version number to 1.15.90 2006-02-19 19:28:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
36f41eabf4 (dump_file0): Restore file_count_links,accidentally removed on 2005-11-29. 2006-02-19 19:27:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
108edf3692 Updated 2006-02-08 21:34:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
780cf6f079 (tar_set_quoting_style): Provide second argument to the format spec: program_invocation_short_name. Reported by Jim Meyering. 2006-02-08 21:34:15 +00:00
Paul Eggert
84378fa99a * gnulib.modules: Add closeout, exitfial.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add __fpending.c, __fpending.h, closeout.c,
closeout.h.
* src/buffer.c: Incluse closeout.h.
(_open_archive): Use freopen rather than fopen, so
that stdlis is always either stdout or stderr.  Use
close_stdout_set_file_name to report its name.
* src/tar.c: Include closeout.h and exitfail.h.
(parse_opt, usage): Call close_stdout as appropriate, to check for
write errors.
(decode_options): Exit with status TAREXIT_FAILURE, not 1.
(main): Set exit_failure, to exit with proper status on memory
allocation failure and the like.
Use close_stdout rather than rolling our own test.
2006-02-07 23:51:37 +00:00
Paul Eggert
78b078b455 * NEWS: --version now outputs copyright etc., to conform to the
GNU coding standards.  Remove --license.
* gnulib.modules: Add version-etc-fsf.
* doc/tar.texi: Document the change.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add version-etc-fsf.c, version-etc.c, version-etc.h.
* scripts/Makefile.am (SED_CMD): Update PAKCAGE_NAME, not PACKAGE.
* scripts/backup.in: Remove --license.  Change --version to conform
to GCS.
* scripts/restore.in: Likewise.
* scripts/backup.sh.in (license): Output briefer license in the
style of coreutils, for consistency with other changes.
* src/tar.c: Include <version-etc.h>.
(LICENSE_OPTION): Remove.
(options): Remove --license.
(license): Remove.
(parse_opt): Use version_etc instead of rolling it ourselves.
Remove --license.
* tests/version.at (tar --version): Check only the first line of
output.
2006-02-07 22:18:36 +00:00
Paul Eggert
e86e864544 Update copyright year to 2006. 2006-02-07 20:55:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d21d48dfba Update 2006-02-07 13:58:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cf1e8b086b (sparse_map_decoder): Fix misleading diagnostic. 2006-02-07 13:57:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6912b7fb15 Update 2006-01-31 11:28:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6c28751ca7 (struct tar_stat_info): New members is_dumpdir and skipped. 2006-01-31 11:28:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0e848e7b2c (list_archive): Use is_dumpdir
Do not wrap skip_member in mv_begin/mv_end, the function itself
takes care of it.
(decode_header): Set stat_info->is_dumpdir
(skip_member): Do nothing if skipped is true
2006-01-31 11:28:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ab8a184336 (get_gnu_dumpdir): Static
(is_dumpdir): New function
(purge_directory): Use is_dumpdir
2006-01-31 11:28:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
48ce2946d9 (prepare_to_extract): Use is_dumpdir member to check for dumpdirs. 2006-01-31 11:27:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dde5c2391b (get_gnu_dumpdir): Remove prototype
(is_dumpdir): New function
2006-01-31 11:27:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
860577ee0e Update 2006-01-21 23:39:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a349bd80b9 (decode_options): Refuse using --delete with compression options 2006-01-21 23:39:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ba10157a0c Update 2006-01-18 15:36:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
514ea6ead4 Implement new options --quoting-style, --quote-chars and --no-quote-chars. 2006-01-18 15:36:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6a97a00688 Initial documentation for --quoting-style, --quote-chars and --no-quote-chars option. 2006-01-18 15:36:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7d822e225e (DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE): New configuration variable 2006-01-18 15:35:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
38f08784bc Updated 2006-01-18 15:35:34 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c17a9f91d0 * bootstrap: Default to pserver, and switch to cvs.sv.gnu.org,
to accommodate recent changes to the GNU CVS server.
2006-01-09 22:53:55 +00:00
Paul Eggert
0f4660c786 Add argp-pin.c, mkdirat.c, openat-priv.h. 2006-01-09 22:52:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5e01ba7dbe Update 2005-12-14 13:00:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
288315211a Update invocations of name_scan. 2005-12-14 12:58:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dacac1b6be (name_scan): Change prototype. 2005-12-14 12:58:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85cf996677 (name_scan): Take an additional argument requesting the exact matching. 2005-12-14 12:58:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6cbd7e1608 Update 2005-12-13 13:33:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b794387cba (addname,add_hierarchy_to_namelist): Initialize explicit member appropriately. 2005-12-13 13:32:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
91abd3da82 (procdir): If name_scan() returns something, check if it was explicitely given in the command line 2005-12-13 13:32:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5b3dc9e3dd (struct name): New member explicit'. Remove unused member isdir' 2005-12-13 13:31:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d3e525009d Update 2005-12-12 22:56:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
86ef91adff If --one-file-system is given and a
directory is found to be on another device, *and* this directory
is explicitely given in the command line, then do not omit it.
2005-12-12 22:55:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a92a8ff22d Update 2005-12-11 14:12:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1cdb7823ae (options,parse_opt): New options --delay-directory-restore and --no-delay-directory-restore 2005-12-11 14:12:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e73e4428e2 (directories_first): Replaced by delay_directory_restore_option. All uses changed. 2005-12-11 14:11:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d2dd096f1d (delay_directory_restore_option): New global. 2005-12-11 14:11:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fb0a0aaf52 Document --delay-directory-restore option.
(Configuring Help Summary): Document usage of ARGP_HELP_FMT
variable to customize help output.
2005-12-11 14:10:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d102bc35a5 Update 2005-12-11 14:10:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bb8c1d6a72 Update 2005-12-09 10:05:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f03fc1e078 (read_directory_file): Fix format string 2005-12-09 10:05:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
273810a9f7 (to_chars_subst): Remove unused variable
Make sure useful result code is returned.
2005-12-09 10:04:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
69abc76d13 (set_file_atime): Add prototype. 2005-12-09 10:04:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
12cd9cea81 (open_archive): Add default case to shut up gcc. 2005-12-09 10:04:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
bfa1bba5fd Fix typo 2005-12-08 15:55:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
09b46a0b47 Update 2005-12-08 15:41:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a169d65b94 (gid_to_chars, major_to_chars, minor_to_chars)
(mode_to_chars, off_to_chars, size_to_chars, time_to_chars)
(uid_to_chars, uintmax_to_chars): Return bool
(to_chars): Return bool
(start_header): Check return values of convertion routines. Fail
if unable to store data in the header.
2005-12-08 15:41:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
89e65f936d (gid_to_chars, major_to_chars, minor_to_chars)
(mode_to_chars, off_to_chars, size_to_chars, time_to_chars)
(uid_to_chars, uintmax_to_chars): Return bool
2005-12-08 15:41:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9ac15ae0f (Current status): Renamed to 'Changes' and moved to
appendices.
(Large or Negative Values): Rewritten
2005-12-08 15:40:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
67770b89f2 Change permissions in the sample outputs to more usual ones 2005-12-07 16:17:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f3e6ea7d49 Updated 2005-12-07 15:12:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0d2cdcb797 Remove @set's 2005-12-07 15:12:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
49e7ba5b17 Following the discussion with Karl Berry,
discontinue using @value{} substitutions for Texinfo commands.
Properly index all long options. Print a
separate long option index.
2005-12-07 15:11:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3f6d87a61c Update 2005-12-07 09:43:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
80855932f0 Resolve some more FIXMEs 2005-12-07 09:42:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9e50e81558 Fix typosin the recent entry 2005-12-07 08:40:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
02ec34f473 Update 2005-12-06 23:18:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
075c726752 Update 2005-12-06 23:16:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2e7a943d0e (options): Add --restrict option. Use macros for option grouping.
(license): Print full list of copyright years
2005-12-06 23:15:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4ba3b41e2e (sys_exec_info_script): The script can supply new
archive name to use by writing it to file descriptor 3.
2005-12-06 23:15:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4669306854 (sys_exec_info_script): Update delaration
(restrict_option): New global
2005-12-06 23:14:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ffc4fb7bdd (new_volume): Update invocation
(change_tape_menu): New function. Disable '!' command if given
--restrict option.
2005-12-06 23:14:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c7ab8eaba4 Use TAR_VOLUME instead of reading volno file. 2005-12-06 23:13:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3f166ce0f5 Update --info-scripts documentation 2005-12-06 23:13:19 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ac74317f46 * configure.ac (DENSITY_LETTER): Fix m4 overquoting.
* .cvsignore: Ignore .bootstrap.
2005-12-06 21:43:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ce522dce26 Update 2005-12-06 16:33:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f018d69aac (archive_format_string): Remove static qualifier.
(subcommand_string): New function.
2005-12-06 16:32:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ea019af0cc (sys_exec_info_script): New function. 2005-12-06 16:32:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0251059267 (archive_format_string,subcommand_string,sys_exec_info_script): New prototypes. 2005-12-06 16:32:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
13d43c302f (new_volume): Use sys_exec_info_script() instead of system(). 2005-12-06 16:31:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a5da71b142 Document --to-command and --info-script options. Add missing xrefs. 2005-12-06 16:31:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
853edfaff4 Update 2005-12-01 14:51:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ca43ee9769 Obtain root_device here, to make sure it works correctly with -C. 2005-12-01 14:50:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
888b0d82b7 Update 2005-12-01 12:58:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b84053c7be Add Guerkan Karaman 2005-12-01 12:57:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c040cabb98 Add incr02.at 2005-12-01 12:51:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ae00dc0d37 (purge_directory): Skip the member and return if the archive is not in incremental format. 2005-12-01 12:51:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5249a99377 Fix restoring of directory timestamps from
incremental archives.
(directories_first): New variable.
(prepare_to_extract): Set directories_first
(extract_archive): Call apply_nonancestor_delayed_set_stat() only
if not extracting from an incremental archive
2005-12-01 12:50:58 +00:00
Paul Eggert
2edff367d9 * doc/tar.texi (Option Summary): Rewrite the
--atime-preserve=system description in response to Ian Turner's
proposed patch.
* doc/tar.texi (Extracting Specific Files): Remove obsolescent
FIXME.
2005-12-01 00:18:05 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f8f4f49011 (parse_opt): Remove bogus \n in new atime diagnostic. 2005-11-29 19:41:34 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3fbdf738de * lib/.cvsignore: Add malloc.h, regcomp.c, regex.c, regex.h,
regex_internal.c, regex_internal.h, regexc.c; used by rpmatch.
2005-11-29 19:39:06 +00:00
Paul Eggert
7209cbed6c * THANKS: Add Ian Turner. 2005-11-29 19:26:13 +00:00
Paul Eggert
aa976a5170 * NEWS: New option --atime-preserve=system, which uses O_NOATIME.
* configure.ac: Prefer AC_CHECK_HEADERS_ONCE to AC_CHECK_HEADERS.
Check for stropts.h and sys/filio.h too, for _FIOSATIME.
* doc/tar.texi: Change "modification time" to "data modification
time", "change time" to "status change time", and "filesystem" to
"file system", so that we use terminology consistent with POSIX.
Use American spacing rather than French for sentence ends.
"non-dependable" -> "undependable".
(Option Summary, Attributes): Explain better the pitfalls of the
--atime-preserve option, and suggest read-only mounts,loopback
mounts, and noatime mounts for older systems.
* doc/value.texi (op-atime-preserve-system): Renamed from
op-atime-preserver-system to fix a misspelling.
* src/common.h (enum atime_preserve): Use lower case for enum values.
* src/compare.c: Don't include utimens.h; no longer needed.
(diff_file): Use set_file_atime rather than utimens; avoid closing
diff_handle until after this, so that we can set the file time stamp
via the file descriptor rather than via its name.
* src/create.c: Don't include utimens.h; no longer needed.
(dump_regular_finish): Remove.  All callers now do its work inline.
(dump_dir): New arg FD.  All callers changed.
Use fdsavedir rather than savedir.
(unknown_file_error): Arg is a const pointer now.
(dump_file0): 2nd arg is a const pointer now.
Treat directories more like files, with respect to --atime-preserve.
For example, also warn if a directory changes while we are dumping it.
Prefer file descriptors to file names when retrieving/setting file
attributes; this saves path-resolution time and allows us to avoid
changing mtime/ctime on Solaris when restoring atime as root.
Use O_DIRECTORY when opening directories, to avoid some race conditions.
Do not reset atime if mtime has changed.  Report an error if
we cannot reset atime.

First cut at adding support for --atime-preserve=system.
* doc/tar.texi (Option Summary): First cut at documenting it.
All other uses of --atime-preserve changed to --atime-preserve=replace.
* doc/value.texi (op-atime-preserve-replace, op-atime-preserver-system):
New.
(op-atime-preserve): Mention METHOD.
* src/common.h (atime_preserve): New enum.
(atime_preserve_option): Now of the enum type rather than bool.
All uses changed.
* src/compare.c (diff_file): Read with O_NOATIME if asked for.
* src/create.c (dump_file0): Read regular and CTG files with O_NOATIME
if asked for.
* src/tar.c (usage): Mention new usage.
(parse_opt): Parse new usage.
2005-11-29 19:14:21 +00:00
Paul Eggert
7b00db5675 Convert back to UTF-8, sort (using LC_ALL=en_US.UTF-8
on Debian stable), and consistently use tabs rather than spaces.
2005-11-29 18:53:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
36be286c03 Update 2005-11-27 12:00:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d543d2dbbd Remove prematurely introduced parts of new MV format support 2005-11-27 11:59:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5df61b429a Update 2005-11-26 19:32:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9590e781c0 (xheader_format_name): Fix memory leak. 2005-11-26 19:31:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
87dfaf3176 Update 2005-11-11 12:18:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c81a5e8bf5 Close stdin so that if something fails causing tar to ask for the next volume, it won't hang the testsuite. 2005-11-11 12:17:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b5775215d7 (confirm): Rewritten using rpmatch.
(decode_options): Minor optimizations
(main): Call stdopen() to ensure the first three descriptors are
open.
2005-11-11 12:17:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
df970c7332 Add rpmatch.c 2005-11-11 12:16:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f1f3b524f6 Add stdopen, imported from coreutils. 2005-11-11 12:16:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
575ea074cc Add rpmatch 2005-11-11 12:15:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6204e3c718 Updated 2005-11-11 00:28:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ecce6f3e9a (Tarcat): New node 2005-11-11 00:27:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85890103ae Handle archives in pax format. Improve handling of traditional archives. 2005-11-11 00:27:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7e51be5fe2 Update 2005-11-11 00:26:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
05ba292a93 (AT_TAR_CHECK): Define TEST_TAR_FORMAT 2005-11-11 00:26:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1ebdd88caf (xheader_format_name): Remove static
qualifier. Change last argument.
Correct buffer size calculation (allocated too much space).
(xheader_write): Increase global_header_count here ...
(xheader_write_global): ... instead of here
2005-11-11 00:26:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b6d3432810 (write_extended): Change type and meaning of the first argument. All callers updated 2005-11-11 00:25:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1e8f6d41c4 (flush_read,flush_write): Functions, again.
(write_extended): Changed declaration
(xheader_format_name): New declaration
2005-11-11 00:25:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5b1df7b55e (flush_write,flush_read): Change data type.
(flush_archive): Compute actual buffer fill level before calling
low level function.
(close_archive): Call flush_archive again if the first call
resulted in partially filled buffer.
(try_new_volume): Rewritten handling of initial headers.
(add_chunk_header): New function. Write an additional header
before the continuation chunk. The purpose of the header is to
allow third-party tars to extract the member.
(simple_flush_write): Take an argument.
(_gnu_flush_write): Correctly handle partially filled buffers.
2005-11-11 00:24:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
692f449623 Updated 2005-11-10 13:01:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5f060c2025 Add new test cases 2005-11-10 13:00:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d1867fd76c (xhdr_tab): New keyword GNU.volume.filename. 2005-11-10 12:59:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
813aa07a89 Do not pad compressed output if it goes to stdout. 2005-11-10 12:59:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9a42d94543 (sparse_dump_region): Call mv_size_left.
(sparse_dump_file): Enclose the loop in mv_begin/mv_end.
2005-11-10 12:59:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b9b37ee191 (try_new_volume): Bugfix. Always check
continued_file_name. If it is absent, the volume is out
of sync.
(add_multi_volume_header): Create GNU.volume.filename keyword in
the extended header.
2005-11-10 12:58:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
04549e1f21 Update 2005-11-09 13:13:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f3a24a7a51 (AT_KEYWORDS): Improve to allow executionof related tests in groups. 2005-11-09 13:09:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e1286c1989 (xhdr_tab): Support for new GNU keywords. 2005-11-09 13:09:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5eecc4c994 (decode_options): Allow to use --multi-volume and --label with pax archives. 2005-11-09 13:09:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cb3d8b0db9 Use mv_.* functions where necessary. 2005-11-09 13:08:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
52429bb956 Use mv_.* functions uniformly instead of fiddling with the global variables. 2005-11-09 13:08:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7200f4f5f7 (save_name,save_sizeleft,save_totsize): Remove
globals.
(volume_label,continued_file_name,continued_file_size): New
variables.
(flush_read,flush_write): Pointers to functions
(mv_begin,mv_end,mv_total_size,mv_size_left): New functions
(write_extended): New function.
2005-11-09 13:08:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
737b0251de Rewritten in a more modular fashion to provide
GNU extensions (multi-volume archives and archive labels) in
pax format.
(volume_label,continued_file_name,continued_file_size)
(continued_file_offset): New globals.
(save_name,save_totsize,save_sizeleft): Make static
(mv_begin,mv_end,mv_total_size,mv_size_left): New functions
(open_archive,flush_write,flush_read): Rewritten
2005-11-09 13:07:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
48d508b78b Update 2005-11-09 13:07:26 +00:00
Paul Eggert
57c2124d68 * src/tar.c (NS_PRECISION_FORMAT_MASK): New macro.
(tar_timespec_cmp): New function. Wrapper over
timespec_cmp using the timespec precision provided by the
current archive format.
* src/common.h (tar_timespec_cmp): New declaration.
* src/compare.c (diff_file): Use tar_timespec_cmp.
* src/extract.c (file_newer_p): Likewise.
* src/update.c (update_archive): Likewise.
* tests/truncate.at: Reverted changes
* tests/update.at: Reverted changes
2005-11-08 07:20:02 +00:00
Paul Eggert
06379466c1 (xheader_store): Last arg is void const *. 2005-11-07 05:11:55 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3eec6b3f46 (xheader_store): Last arg here is void const *, too. 2005-11-07 05:11:40 +00:00
Paul Eggert
60f8dd83b8 (struct xhdr_tab.coder): Last arg is void const *,
not void *, to avoid create.c warning from GCC "passing argument 3
of 'xheader_store' discards qualifiers from pointer target type".
(dummy_coder, atime_coder, gid_coder, gname_coder, linkpath_coder):
(ctime_coder, mtime_coder, path_coder, size_coder, uid_coder):
(uname_coder, sparse_size_coder, sparse_numblocks_coder):
(sparse_offset_coder, sparse_numbytes_coder, dumpdir_coder):
Likewise.
2005-11-07 05:03:09 +00:00
Paul Eggert
cfbf693855 * tests/truncate.at: Create files whose time stamps must fall on
1-second boundaries.  This prevents tests from failing on hosts
like Solaris 8 that have nanosecond-resolution file time stamps.
* tests/update.at: Likewise.
2005-11-07 04:03:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
35f5b48815 Update 2005-11-07 02:55:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
374ae10d39 (xheader_keyword_deleted_p): Remove static
qualifier.
(struct xhdr_tab.decoder): Change prototype. POSIX allows string
values to contain embedded nulls, so take an extra argument
specifying the length of the string.
(decx,decg,dummy_decoder,atime_decoder,gid_decoder)
(gname_decoder,linkpath_decoder,ctime_decoder,mtime_decoder)
(path_decoder,size_decoder,uid_decoder,uname_decoder)
(sparse_size_decoder,sparse_numblocks_decoder)
(sparse_offset_decoder,sparse_numbytes_decoder): Likewise.
(decode_record): Pass value length to the handler
(run_override_list): Pass value length to the decoder
(xheader_print_n): New function
(xheader_print): Rewritten using xheader_print_n
(xheader_finish): Do not rely om strlen to compute the length of
the collected string: it can contain embedded nulls
(xheader_string_begin,xheader_string_add,xheader_string_end): New
functions.
(sparse_map_decoder,dumpdir_coder,dumpdir_decoder): New
functions. Handle GNU.sparse.map and GNU.dumpdir variables.
(xhdr_tab): Add new variables.
2005-11-07 02:52:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4d22cbd47c Test gnu, oldgnu, and posix formats 2005-11-07 02:51:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e20e79e7ff (struct tar_stat_info.dumpdir): New member. 2005-11-07 02:50:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f865597c89 Incremental options are allowed with --format=pax
(tar_stat_destroy): Free dumpdir
2005-11-07 02:50:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1b9c48d934 (sparse_diff_file): Bugfix: set seekable.
(pax_dump_header): Store sparse map in GNU.sparse.map. If this
variable has been explicitely deleted, use GNU.sparse.offset/
GNU.sparse.numbytes variables.
2005-11-07 02:49:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f6458a827a (list_archive): Handle incremental backups in pax
format.
(decode_header): Initialize stat_info.dumpdir
2005-11-07 02:49:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
08a8d2dec6 (dumpdir_size, get_gnu_dumpdir): New functions.
(purge_directory): Use stat_info.dumpdir instead of getting its
value explicitely.
2005-11-07 02:48:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
aea1d50da9 (dump_dir0): Handle incremental backups in pax archives 2005-11-07 02:48:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
588232f859 (dumpdir_size,get_gnu_dumpdir)
(xheader_string_begin,xheader_string_add)
(xheader_string_end): New functions.
2005-11-07 02:48:08 +00:00
Paul Eggert
4c4c5a4dc1 Minor language and white space fixes. 2005-11-07 00:25:52 +00:00
Paul Eggert
d144e7c217 * tests/truncate.at: Use -H pax to preserve full time stamp resolution.
This prevents tests from failing on hosts like Solaris 8 that have
nanosecond-resolution file time stamps.
* tests/update.at: Likewise.
2005-11-06 23:29:30 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ef9ad717ba * src/xheader.c (strtoimax, strtoumax): Remove decls; now done
in system.h.
2005-11-06 22:48:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85ce2c24f8 Update 2005-11-06 11:52:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d01f65092c Properly document incremental dumps 2005-11-06 11:51:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
04e2551256 Update 2005-11-05 16:49:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8b2504deca Update 2005-11-05 16:49:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ad09c8373b New file 2005-11-05 16:47:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5b91f80787 Update 2005-11-05 15:57:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ef981aae38 Never skip the test. It should work on any filesystem 2005-11-05 15:55:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
36f1d689e4 Sleep 1 sec before creating second file. 2005-11-05 15:55:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1e304fc5fd (struct directory.mtime): New member.
(note_directory): Take additional arguments. All callers updated.
(scan_directory): Updated to use more metadata. In particular,
this allows to correctly detect renamed files.
(read_directory_file,write_directory_file)
(write_directory_file_entry): Support new directory file format.
2005-11-05 15:55:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b100f6ae5b (dump_file): Call update_parent_directory. 2005-11-05 15:54:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a6d2158837 (update_parent_directory): New prototype. 2005-11-05 15:54:14 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c641a16cba (set_stat): Rewrite to avoid bug in Forte
Developer 7 C 5.4 Patch 111708-09 (2004-02-19).
2005-11-04 21:25:47 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
65a7536d1f Updated 2005-11-04 12:42:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8c119485a9 Updated 2005-11-04 12:41:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a02a9ed099 Update 2005-11-04 07:48:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
71976fa77e Add Eric Blake 2005-11-04 07:38:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c2552c6c40 Fix quoting in help output.
(update_po): Use backward-compatible wget option --cache instead
of deprecated -C to accomodate for wget 1.10.
Changes proposed by Eric Blake
2005-11-04 07:38:23 +00:00
Paul Eggert
b272b3e2cf * doc/tar.texi: Consistently put two spaces after sentences,
and put commas after "i.e." and "e.g.".  This is the usual GNU
style in manuals.
2005-11-02 23:03:39 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c44d0d037f * lib/.cvsignore: Accommodate recent gnulib changes. 2005-11-02 22:45:07 +00:00
Paul Eggert
9c50f854a6 Add creat-safer.c, fcntl--.h, fcntl-safer.h,
open-safer.c, openat-die.c, verify.h, to accommodate recent gnulib
changes.
2005-11-02 22:44:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fc42672fe0 Updated 2005-10-28 09:29:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
64aea5de53 If file `.bootstrap' exists in the cwd and is readable, prepend its contents to the command line 2005-10-28 09:29:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
391c6f6bdb Add John Thomas McDole 2005-10-28 09:28:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9684c2728d (diff_dumpdir): Pass a valid device number to get_directory_contents. 2005-10-28 09:28:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cb8aacd9ef Updated 2005-10-21 18:15:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3ae9e51181 Skip test if ln fails (suppose the OS does not support hard links) 2005-10-21 18:13:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
7a246ab602 Updated 2005-10-04 07:31:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
35b9ca72db (decode_options): Report error if -A or -r is used together with compression option. 2005-10-04 07:30:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ecdef9daaa Fix cover page 2005-09-30 19:49:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eb744655a8 Updated 2005-09-29 16:31:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
57fcb1639e Use @option and @kbd consistently. Document new options. 2005-09-29 16:28:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
49f39c25b4 Updated 2005-09-28 20:42:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
40da86b2a1 Implement --show-stored-names option 2005-09-28 20:41:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
15b75f848e (print_header): If show_stored_names_option is given,
list member names as stored in the archive. Patch proposed by Erik
Cumps <erik.cumps@icos.be>
2005-09-28 20:41:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2a25112552 (show_stored_names_option): New variable 2005-09-28 20:41:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b2b60efaaf Updated 2005-09-28 19:42:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ddb0f96f00 New option --test-label tests the archive volume label. The option proposed by Wouter Verhelst 2005-09-28 19:41:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
13aead50a8 (all_names_found): If test_label_option is set return true 2005-09-28 19:41:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8f1d2fd9c3 (print_header): Special handling if test_label_option is set 2005-09-28 19:41:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a274294656 (test_label_option): New variable 2005-09-28 19:40:41 +00:00
Paul Eggert
63f64e4aaf * tests/Makefile.am (clean-local): Don't attempt to run
$(TESTSUITE) if it doesn't exist.  Problem reported by
Eric Blake.
2005-09-21 19:26:12 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3209329337 Don't filter time stamps through the resolution supported
by struct stat; keep them to full nanosecond resolution.
This affects behavior only on older hosts or file systems
that have lower-resolution time stamps.
* src/common.h (OLDER_STAT_TIME): Parenthesize arg.
(OLDER_TAR_STAT_TIME): New macro.
(code_timespec): New function.
(BILLION, LOG10_BILLION, TIMESPEC_STRSIZE_BOUND): New constants.
* src/compare.c (diff_file): Use full time stamp resolution.
* src/create.c (start_header, dump_file0): Likewise.
(start_header, dump_file0): Adjust to new structure layout.
(dump_regular_finish): Simplify by using timespec_cmp.
* src/extract.c (struct delayed_set_stat): Don't store stat info
that we don't need, to save space.  All uses changed.
(struct delayed_set_stat, struct delayed_link, file_newer_p):
(create_placeholder_file, extract_link, apply_delayed_links):
Use full time stamp resolution.
(check_time): Use code_timespec rather than rolling our own code.
(set_stat, delay_set_stat): Arg now points to tar_stat_info to
avoid losing time information.  All callers changed.
* src/list.c (read_and, decode_header, print_heaeder):
Use full time stamp resolution.
* src/misc.c (code_timespec): New function.
* src/tar.h (struct tar_stat_info): Record atime, mtime, ctime
separately, for benefit of hosts with lower resolution.
* src/update.c (update_archive): Use full time stamp resolution.
* src/xheader.c (code_time): Use new code_timespec function
to simplify code.
(atime_coder, atime_decoder, ctime_coder, ctime_decoder):
(mtime_coder, mtime_decoder): Use full time stamp resolution.

Report time stamps to full resolution in environment.
Report memory allocation failures rather than ignoring them.
* src/system.c (time_to_env): New function.
(oct_to_env, str_to_env, chr_to_env): Report memory allocation failures.
(stat_to_env): Report full resolution in time stamps.
2005-09-17 06:41:55 +00:00
Paul Eggert
2f800ce3fb Merge changes from gnulib for file system sub-second time stamps.
* configure.ac: Remove checks for struct stat.st_spare1, struct
stat.st_atim.tv_nsec, struct stat.st_atimespec.tv_nsec, struct
stat.st_atimensec, as gnulib now does this for us.
Similarly for LIB_CLOCK_GETTIME.
* gnulib.modules: Add stat-time.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add stat-time.h.
* src/common.h: Include stat-time.h.
(timespec_lt): Remove.  All callers changed to use timespec_cmp.
(get_stat_atime, get_stat_ctime, get_stat_mtime):
(set_stat_atime, set_stat_ctime, set_stat_mtime):
Remove; now defined by stat-time.h.
2005-09-16 07:03:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ae5473fe02 Updated 2005-09-14 13:25:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1f4437aa66 (list_dumpdir): New function. 2005-09-14 13:25:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8952196bc1 (list_archive): Use list_dumpdir() to display GNUTYPE_DUMPDIR blocks. Do that only if two or more -v options are given. 2005-09-14 13:23:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9093ca15d8 (list_dumpdir): New function. Used to dump contents of GNUTYPE_DUMPDIR blocks. 2005-09-14 13:23:12 +00:00
Paul Eggert
76efed4ca4 hard link patches 2005-09-12 18:46:38 +00:00
Paul Eggert
a2b6327eda Adjust to current gnulib and modules used.
Add getdelim.c, getdelim.h, mbchar.c, mbchar.h, mbuiter.h, memchr.c,
pipe-safer.c, size_max.h, strdup.c, strdup.h, strnlen.h, strnlen1.c,
strnlen1.h, unistd--.h.
Remove getndelim2.c, getndelim2.h, pathmax.h, sysexits.h, xstrdup.c.
2005-09-12 18:46:26 +00:00
Paul Eggert
af5d05729a Treat fishy-looking hard links like fishy-looking symlinks.
(struct delayed_set_stat): Rename after_symlinks
member to after_links.  All uses changed.
(struct delayed_link): Renamed from struct delayed_symlink.
All uses changed.  New member is_symlink.
(delayed_link_head): Renamed from delayed_symlink_head.  All uses
changed.
(create_placeholder_file): New function, taken from extract_symlink.
(extract_link): Create placeholders for fishy-looking hard links.
(extract_symlink): Move code into create_placeholder_file.
(apply_delayed_links): Renamed from apply_delayed_symlinks.
All uses changed.  Create both hard links and symlinks.
2005-09-12 18:45:59 +00:00
Paul Eggert
3070fff7d7 Mention gzip version problems, and valgrind. 2005-09-03 21:00:10 +00:00
Paul Eggert
6bb5c17aea * README-alpha: Modernize description of software required for
developers.
2005-09-03 20:54:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ecd43c1314 Update 2005-09-03 10:29:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f58c189f3e Updated 2005-09-03 10:28:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
931e305002 Add incr01.at 2005-09-03 10:28:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a57ecc51aa New test. 2005-09-03 10:27:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a5375b618c (purge_directory): Do not dereference symbolic links. Bug reported by Ralph Corderoy <ralph@inputplus.co.uk> and David Brown <davidb@davidb.org> 2005-09-03 10:27:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c40ba72fd3 Add strdup 2005-09-03 10:24:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eacde4bca7 Updated 2005-08-17 14:52:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
220ffceb44 (read_directory_file): Use strtoumax to read snapshot file contents. 2005-08-17 14:51:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b65b1ff9eb Updated 2005-08-01 06:28:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e0b0becead Remove dependency on file order. 2005-08-01 06:22:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9c76e7d56 (file_dumpable_p,dump_file0): Fix handling of sparse files to /dev/null with --totals option. 2005-08-01 06:22:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9d23481b5f Updated 2005-07-08 14:40:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
aa76a67b76 Fix typo 2005-07-08 14:40:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
59a4026674 Updated 2005-07-07 16:20:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9106e53684 Pipe the output from `tar xfv' through sort. 2005-07-07 16:20:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a34b0ad8c9 Updated 2005-06-25 09:13:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1992b53b8c (tar_sparse_init): Fill structure with zeros. Call
sparse_select_optab(). All callers updated.
(sparse_member_p, sparse_fixup_header): Use tar_sparse_init().
2005-06-25 09:13:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f319c5575b Updated 2005-06-23 12:57:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
44ce72fa96 Adapt to the new output format 2005-06-23 12:57:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2e9ea5f4a7 (pax_sparse_member_p): Checking member size vs. file size is not reliable enough. Use sparse_map_avail. 2005-06-23 12:57:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4bd38118e0 Updated 2005-06-23 12:17:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b65039526c Updated 2005-06-23 12:16:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fb1b9e3d0f New test. 2005-06-23 12:15:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
aedacf9d29 Updated 2005-06-23 09:51:31 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d9045bf409 (size_decoder): Do not set archive_file_size 2005-06-23 09:51:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8d52260315 Updated 2005-06-23 09:10:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
225e690142 (sparse_scan_file): Fix another bug, introduced yesterday: Initialize
archive_file_size to 0. The variable keeps size of the file *as stored
in the archive*, not the size reported by stat.
2005-06-23 09:10:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c877b48d68 Updated 2005-06-23 08:27:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
37d2462d7c (tar_sparse_init): Fix recent bugfixes: Initialize dumped_size to 0. 2005-06-23 08:27:22 +00:00
Paul Eggert
040b5ab5f9 A sweep of the sparse code prompted by a bug report by Jim Meyering.
* src/sparse.c: Include <inttostr.h>.
(struct tar_sparse_file): offset and dumped_size are off_t, not
size_t.  optab is now const *.
(dump_zeros): Return bool success flag, not off_t.
All callers changed.
Use a constant-zero buffer rather than clearing a buffer each time.
Don't mess up if write fails.
(dump_zeros, check_sparse_region):
Don't assume off_t is no wider than size_t.
(tar_sparse_init): Don't bother clearing a field that is already clear.
(zero_block_p): First arg is const *, not *.
(clear_block, SPARSES_INIT_COUNT): Remove.
(sparse_add_map): First arg is now struct start_stat_info *, not
struct tar_sparse_file *.  All callers changed.
Use x2nrealloc to check for size_t overflow.
(parse_scan_file): Cache commonly-used parts of file.
Use an auto buffer, not a static one.
Don't bother clearing the buffer; not needed.
Don't bother clearing items that are already clear.
(oldgnu_optab, star_optab, pax_optab): Now const.
(sparse_dump_region): Don't bother clearing the buffer before
reading into it; just clear the parts that aren't read into.
(sparse_dump_file): Clear the whole local variable 'file'.
(diff_buffer): Remove; now a local var.
(check_sparse_region): Don't bother clearing buffer before
reading into it.  Don't assume off_t is promoted to long.
(oldgnu_get_sparse_info, star_get_sparse_info):
Use an auto status, not static.
* src/tar.h (struct tar_stat_info): had_trailing_slash is
now bool, not int.
* src/xheader.c (sparse_offset_coder, sparse_numbytes_coder):
Rewrite to avoid cast.
(sparse_offset_decoder, sparse_numbytes_decoder):
Diagnose excess entries rather than crashing.
2005-06-23 06:55:01 +00:00
Paul Eggert
4f4a858eb6 * src/common.h (timespec_lt): Add a return type: bool. 2005-06-23 03:19:03 +00:00
Paul Eggert
d659cbaccd Carefully crafted invalid headers can cause buffer overrun.
Invalid header fields go undiagnosed.
Some valid time strings are ignored.

* NEWS: Better support for full-resolution time stamps.
The -v option now prints time stamps only to 1-minute resolution.
* gnulib.modules: Add utimens.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add imaxtostr.c, inttostr.c, inttostr.h,
offtostr.c, umaxtostr.c, utimens.c, utimens.h.  Remove paxconvert.c.
* lib/Makefile.tmpl (libtar_a_SOURCES): Remove paxconvert.c.
* lib/paxconvert.c: Remove; superseded by umaxtostr.c.
* po/POTFILES.in: Remove lib/paxconvert.c.  Add lib/xalloc-die.c,
lib/obstack.c.
* src/buffer.c (set_start_time, compute_duration, start_time):
Use gettime rather than rolling our own code.
* src/common.h (OLDGNU_NAME_FIELD_SIZE, MAXOCTAL11, MAXOCTAL7): Remove.
(newer_ctime_option): Remove.
(timespec_lt): New function.
(OLDER_STAT_TIME): Use it.
(string_to_chars): First arg is char const *, not char *.
(tartime): Time arg is now struct timespec.  New bool arg.
All callers changed.
(code_ns_fraction): New decl.
(sys_stat_nanoseconds): Remove decl.
(get_stat_atime, get_stat_ctime, get_stat_mtime): New functions.
(set_stat_atime, set_stat_ctime, set_stat_mtime): New functions.
* src/compare.c: Include utimens.h rather than rolling our own.
(diff_dir, diff_file, diff_link, diff_symlink, diff_special):
Prototype.
(diff_dumpdir, diff_multivol): Prototype.
(diff_file): Support higher-resolution time stamps.
* src/create.c: Include utimens.h rather than rolling our own.
(MAX_OCTAL_VAL): New macro.
(tar_copy_str, string_to_chars): Don't bother to zero-fill;
the destination is already zeroed.
(string_to_chars): First arg is char const *.
(start_private_header): Use MINOR_TO_CHARS, not MAJOR_TO_CHARS,
for minor device number.
(write_header_name, dump_hard_link, dump_file0):
Simplify test for old GNU format.
(start_header): Put in placeholders for uid, etc., even when
using extended headers, for benefit of older "tar" implementations.
Don't assume uintmax_t is wider than 32 bits.
Output extended header for mtime if needed.
(dump_regular_finish, dump_file0):
Support extended time stamp resolution.
* src/extract.c: Include utimens.h rather than rolling our own.
(check_time): Support extended time stamp resolution.
* src/list.c: Include <inttostr.h>.
(tartime): Use umaxtostr rather than stringify_uintmax_t_backwards.
* src/xheader.c: Include <inttostr.h>.
Do not include <xstrtol.h>.
(strtoimax) [!HAVE_DECL_STRTOIMAX && !defined strtoimax]: New decl.
(strtoumax) [!HAVE_DECL_STRTOUMAX && !defined strtoumax]: New decl.
(BILLION, LOG10_BILLION): New constants.
(to_decimal): Remove; superseded by inttostr.  All callers changed
to use umaxtostr.
(xheader_format_name): Don't assume pids and uintmax_t values
fit in 63 bytes (!) when printed.
(decode_record): Don't bother to check for ERANGE; an out of range
value must be treater than len_max anyway.
If the length is out of range, output it in the diagnostic.
(format_uintmax): Remove; all callers changed to use umaxtostr.
(xheader_print): Don't assume sizes can be printed in 99 bytes (!).
(out_of_range_header): New function.
(decode_time): Use it.
(code_time): Accept struct timespec, not time_t and unsigned long.
All callers changed.  Size sbuf properly, and remove unnecessary check.
Don't assume time stamps can fit in 199 bytes.
Handle negative time stamps.  Handle fractional time stamps
more consistently.  Don't output unnecessary trailing zeros.
(decode_time): Yield struct timespec, not time_t and unsigned long.
All callers changed.
Handle negative time stamps.  Truncate towards minus infinity
consistently.  Improve overflow checks, and output a better
diagnostic on overflow.
(code_num): Don't assume uintmax_t can be printed in 99 bytes (!).
(decode_num): New function, for better diagnostics.
(atime_coder, atime_decoder, gid_decoder, ctime_coder):
(ctime_decoder, mtime_coder, mtime_decoder, size_decoder):
(uid_decoder, sparse_size_decoder, sparse_numblocks_decoder):
(sparse_offset_decoder, sparse_numbytes_decoder):
Use decode_num, etc., instead of xstrtoumax, etc.

* src/xheader.c (sparse_numblocks_decoder): Remove unchecked use
of `calloc'.  Use xcalloc instead.
(decode_time, gid_decoder, size_decoder, uid_decoder):
(sparse_size_decoder, sparse_offset_decoder, sparse_numblocks_decoder):
Ensure that the result of calling xstrtoumax is no larger than
the maximum value for the target type.  Upon any failure, exit with
a diagnostic.
(sparse_numblocks_decoder): Avoid buffer overrun/heap corruption:
use x2nrealloc, rather than `n *= 2' and xrealloc(p, n,....
(decode_time): Rewrite to accept time strings like
1119018481.000000000.  Before, such strings were always ignored.
2005-06-22 06:24:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f6445e4ed6 Updated 2005-06-13 19:14:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3fe8fc3ef9 Add update.at 2005-06-13 19:11:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
372ff169e7 New test 2005-06-13 19:10:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c6cde895e3 (dump_file0): Check for is_avoided_name() first. Fixes bug reported by Martin Lohmeier 2005-06-13 19:09:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
28b44cc69c Updated 2005-06-13 12:54:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eb70fd51cb (AC_STRUCT_ST_BLKSIZE,AC_STRUCT_ST_BLOCKS): Removed. Handled by system.m4. 2005-06-13 12:53:25 +00:00
Paul Eggert
5c4ea58bd7 * src/names.c (excluded_name): excluded_filename ->
excluded_file_name, because the name was changed in gnulib.
2005-06-02 21:02:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85ad04d822 Updated 2005-05-30 15:15:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fb7b2f3645 (read_name_from_file,update_argv): Automatically detect nul-terminated list files. 2005-05-30 15:15:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ab03bd6a2c Updated 2005-05-30 13:38:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9d5fd390dc Bugfixes. 2005-05-27 12:03:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e5e43aa7a4 Updated 2005-05-26 12:51:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
77e56f876d Document new backup scripts behavior 2005-05-26 12:50:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2c49c610be (mt_begin,mt_rewind,mt_offline,mt_status): Use $MT to invoke mt
(init_common): Set --rsh-command option for mt if TAPE_FILE is a
 remote archive.
2005-05-26 12:50:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ec89da307c Minor fixes 2005-05-26 12:50:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ee870c97b9 Updated 2005-05-21 23:13:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ca5e64504b (hash_string_hasher,hash_string_compare)
(hash_string_insert,hash_string_lookup,removed_prefixes_p)
(safer_name_suffix): Moved to paxutils
2005-05-21 23:11:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cc07b9e170 Include paxlib.h instead of paxerror.h
(safer_name_suffix,removed_prefixes_p): Removed. The functions are
imported from paxutils
2005-05-21 23:10:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f2c8b1dff3 Update invocations of safer_name_suffix() 2005-05-21 23:10:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9129c846e7 Add new paxutils files 2005-05-21 23:09:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
df0913f3fe Updated 2005-05-21 23:09:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e20fdceb38 Updated 2005-05-19 15:35:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5c35fdb275 Remove defines and declarations imported from paxutils 2005-05-19 15:34:19 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
113b619383 Add paxerror.c paxexit.c paxconvert.c 2005-05-19 15:33:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
517205c31c (libtar_a_SOURCES): Add paxerror.c paxexit.c paxconvert.c 2005-05-19 15:33:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dfabe2397a Remove checking for LIB_SETSOCKOPT, it is handled by paxutils 2005-05-19 15:32:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8f1f0955cf (copy_files): Accept optional third argument: a prefix
to be appended to destination file names.
Import paxutils/paxlib files.
2005-05-19 15:32:38 +00:00
Paul Eggert
1672258959 * src/misc.c (remove_any_file): Fix typo in previous change. 2005-05-17 08:34:16 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c172481f41 (remove_any_file): Fix typo in previous change. 2005-05-17 08:34:03 +00:00
Paul Eggert
46f09016e8 Port to Solaris 10's treatment of unlinking directories.
* gnulib-modules: Add unlinkdir.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add unlinkdir.h, unlinkdir.c.
* src/common.h (we_are_root): Remove extern decl; it's now static.
* src/extract.c (we_are_root): Now static.
* src/misc.c: Include <unlinkdir.h>.
(remove_any_file): Use cannot_unlink_dir () rather than	we_are_root.
2005-05-15 06:23:49 +00:00
Paul Eggert
120e96c480 Update FSF postal mail address. 2005-05-15 03:59:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
271ed97494 Updated 2005-05-12 15:46:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3ac99bc540 Updated 2005-05-12 15:46:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a33b37a9a3 Add truncate.at 2005-05-12 15:40:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c9365a1d09 New test case 2005-05-12 15:39:54 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8d064bb816 (file_newer_p): Return false if file does not exist 2005-05-12 15:39:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29c902bc49 (dump_regular_file): Correctly pad archive members that shrunk during archiving. Repored by Frank Heckenbach. 2005-05-12 15:39:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d78f85d61d (diff_file): diff_handle was not initialized 2005-05-12 15:39:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
73be90ea0d (Genfile): New appendix 2005-05-12 15:38:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9adc789138 (tar_TEXINFOS): Add genfile.texi 2005-05-12 15:38:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cfe4eef5c2 Install files from paxutils/doc 2005-05-12 15:38:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0e61fd397f Updated 2005-05-12 15:38:19 +00:00
Paul Eggert
bb8dcc1e8c Update copyright. 2005-05-02 08:05:59 +00:00
Paul Eggert
87bd7f5d1c Update copyright. 2005-05-02 08:05:23 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ecac16a4a0 * src/incremen.c (hash_directory): Likewise.
* src/names.c (hash_string_hasher): Likewise.
* src/tar.c (parse_opt): Set it, and adjust to new modechange API.
2005-05-02 08:03:02 +00:00
Paul Eggert
89a4824c73 Tell awk to read from /dev/null. 2005-05-02 08:02:35 +00:00
Paul Eggert
9b7c6df82b Adjust to new hash API. 2005-05-02 08:02:09 +00:00
Paul Eggert
e2c431e9c2 Adjust to recent gnulib changes. 2005-05-02 07:36:26 +00:00
Paul Eggert
82c746410d (parse_opt): Adjust to new modechange API. 2005-05-02 07:36:09 +00:00
Paul Eggert
2e025f2dea (start_ueader): Adjust to new modechange API. 2005-05-02 07:35:47 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f2e17c0d8c (initial_umask): New var. 2005-05-02 07:34:53 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ed08ef0458 Add dup-safer.c, fd-safer.c, unistd-safer.h. 2005-05-02 07:34:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3ab983facf Updated 2005-04-19 09:06:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6c6fe16aaa Add shortrec.at 2005-04-19 09:05:32 +00:00
Paul Eggert
27b98aa8ae * src/buffer.c (reading_from_pipe): Remove. All uses removed.
(short_read): Don't warn about short reads; they're normal.
* tests/shortrec.at: New file.
* tests/testsuite.at: Include it.
2005-04-18 18:21:50 +00:00
Paul Eggert
18850a18f1 (gnulib_modules): Don't create a file modlist.tmp, as
it is sometimes left behind as a garbage file (maybe due to the
multiple traps?).
2005-04-18 18:14:58 +00:00
Paul Eggert
005d0d455c Use UTF-8 uniformly, rather than UTF-8 sometimes and Latin-1 sometimes. 2005-04-16 07:22:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a71807a247 Updated 2005-04-14 13:14:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d7af510d49 (SOLARIS_XHDTYPE): New define 2005-04-14 13:14:38 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ef0e611663 Handle Solaris 'X' type flag 2005-04-14 13:14:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8f9ecca0db Updated 2005-04-07 17:29:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9147c6c9f6 Add multiv04.at 2005-04-07 17:28:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ee738da4a8 Test splittind directory members between the archive volumes. 2005-04-07 17:28:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
42e53a98e1 Modified to match the new behavior 2005-04-07 17:27:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2d34da98d5 Assign orig_file_name
to save_name uniformly over the program. This fixes matching
directory names at the start of an archive volume.
2005-04-07 17:27:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
781d3818e5 (diff_init): Read directory file if in listed
incremental. This prevents spurious 'Contents differ' diagnostics.
(diff_archive): Minor fixes to text messages
(diff_file,diff_dumpdir,diff_multivol): Assign orig_file_name
to save_name uniformly over the program. This fixes matching
directory names at the start of an archive volume.
2005-04-07 17:26:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c861b96651 (flush_write): Warn when the name of the archive
straddling volume boundary is longer than 100 characters. Earlier
behavior was to issue a fatal error.
(struct zip_magic): Reverted part of changes from 2005-04-04.
They make the maintenance too costly. Removing `unsigned'
qualifier from `magic' member should be enough.
2005-04-07 17:26:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2872a5ae81 Minor fixes to text messages. Proposed by Benno Schulenberg.
(extract_file): Assign orig_file_name
        to save_name uniformly over the program. This fixes matching
        directory names at the start of an archive volume.
2005-04-07 17:25:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
62599b5285 Minor fixes to text messages. Proposed by Benno Schulenberg. 2005-04-07 17:24:56 +00:00
Paul Eggert
263604c2ec Sort and simplify. 2005-04-04 18:46:00 +00:00
Paul Eggert
7ebf107f89 Update copyright date. 2005-04-04 18:37:52 +00:00
Paul Eggert
5fe7f641e8 Rename config/ to build-aux/. 2005-04-04 18:35:53 +00:00
Paul Eggert
dbf96ec903 Spelling fixes. 2005-04-04 18:31:44 +00:00
Paul Eggert
5d87077565 * src/buffer.c: Fix struct zip_magic to avoid problems with pedantic
C compilers.  Make 'magic' const and redo it to save alignment and space.
2005-04-04 18:22:44 +00:00
Paul Eggert
7d4bd5b38d (struct zip_magic): Use char arrays, not pointers.
The unsigned char * pointer ran afoul of pedantic C compilers, and
we didn't need pointers anyway.  Put the size field before the
data to avoid unnecessary padding.  All uses changed.
(magic) Make it const, since it doesn't change.  All uses changed.
2005-04-04 18:21:55 +00:00
Paul Eggert
ad0bd3c9c4 * src/xheader.c (decode_record): Don't dump core when given
a corrupted extended header.
2005-04-02 06:39:37 +00:00
Paul Eggert
95fa3422d7 (decode_record): Don't dump core when given
a corrupted extended header.  Problem reported by Jim Meyering.
Also, check for other ways that the header might be invalid,
e.g., missing newline at end.  Do not allow keys with nulls.
Allow blanks before and after length, as POSIX requires.
Do not allow leading "-" in length.  Check for length overflow.
(xheader_decode, xheader_decode_global): Let decode_record
check for exhaustion of record.
(xheader_read): Null-terminate the extended record;
decode_record relies on this.
2005-04-02 06:39:19 +00:00
Paul Eggert
67c7284d07 * bootstrap (TP_URL): Change from
<http://www2.iro.umontreal.ca/~gnutra/po/maint/tar/> to
<http://www.iro.umontreal.ca/translation/maint/tar/> to avoid
some redirection glitches.
Use "trap - 0" rather than "trap 0" to fix a POSIX-conformance bug.
* doc/.cvsignore: Change "tar.info" to "tar.info*".  Sort.
2005-03-21 21:56:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6811232d8f Updated 2005-03-03 23:17:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fdbb1d8c7c (restore_fs): Use root_fs 2005-03-03 23:16:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f04c7701fa Use `head -n 1'. Provide missing argument to ${MT_STATUS}. Fixed typo in MT_OFFLINE assignment. Proposed by Jan Merka. 2005-03-03 23:14:52 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
63e90fdc62 Use `head -n 1'. Provide missing argument to ${MT_STATUS}. Proposed by Jan Merka. 2005-03-03 23:14:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b320151a23 (sparse_scan_file): Bugfix. offset had incorrect type. 2005-03-03 23:13:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9fc348aae9 Correctly parse empty uname/gname 2005-03-03 23:13:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0fd49f51a0 (print_header): Print UID/GID in case of
empty user/group name. This could occur when dumping
files belonging to non-existing users and when listing
broken archives.
Reported by Igor Lautar.
2005-03-03 23:13:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
002cd6843a Updated 2005-02-15 15:25:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b4fb3e9f74 Use -print with find 2005-02-15 15:24:51 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
549a691ada Replace strdup with xstrdup 2005-02-15 15:24:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e7e66c4426 Updated 2005-02-15 14:47:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ea9df3c243 Added reference to bug-tar archive 2005-02-15 14:46:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1d804e4f68 Updated 2005-02-10 22:53:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
eaa66dc858 Added append01.at 2005-02-10 22:52:13 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a66ab8591f Test appending of files with long names 2005-02-10 22:52:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6e63133691 (read_header): Removed assignment to oldgnu_header.isextended. It was breaking append mode. 2005-02-10 22:51:21 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b480196651 Added Tim Adye. Fixed UTF. 2005-02-10 22:51:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
371af209a7 Updated 2005-02-06 20:02:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5c2e32780e Various fixes in help and diagnostic messages 2005-02-06 20:01:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4d8ddc720e Merge list of required modules from paxutils with that from tar proper 2005-02-06 20:00:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5f405b1a2d List of required gnulib modules. 2005-02-06 20:00:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ef68503367 Updated 2005-02-05 22:25:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
64ba4757bc Reverted changes 2005-02-05 22:08:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cd02b0855c (options): Improved sorting. Document --backup=off.
(decode_options): Clear backup_option if necessary.
2005-02-05 22:03:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
35bb355734 (sys_exec_command): Use xclose, xpipe, xfork, xdup2 and exec_fatal. 2005-02-05 22:02:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fa63755f6b (exec_error,fork_error,dup2_error,pipe_error): Removed unneeded functions. 2005-02-05 22:01:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ea12939af0 (extract_archive): Do not check for EXTRACT_OVER_PIPE, decode_options() does this. 2005-02-05 22:01:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
9a71d32d2f Code clean up. 2005-02-05 22:00:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6609c2a607 (EXTRACT_OVER_PIPE): New macro 2005-02-05 22:00:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c580a1c407 Updated 2005-02-05 10:49:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
91ce177fc7 Added Hansjoerg Lipp 2005-02-05 10:35:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4d24adbecb Handle new options --to-command,--ignore-command-error 2005-02-05 10:35:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0b939d7dbc (sys_exec_command,sys_wait_command): New functions 2005-02-05 10:34:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
75a16f75a9 (exec_error, fork_error, dup_error,pipe_error): New functions 2005-02-05 10:34:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e758088191 (extract_file): Handle to_command_option
Fix error recovery: decrease `size' by `written', not
by `count', otherwise tar misses the next header
Do not diagnose write errror if to_command_option
is set, since the command may have exited prematurely.
It would be better to check for sigpipe, though.
(prepare_to_extract): Handle to_command_option
2005-02-05 10:34:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f96dc77bbc (to_command_option)
(ignore_command_error_option): New globals
(sys_exec_command,sys_wait_command): New commands
2005-02-05 10:33:25 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
23cf312ef1 Do not use 8-bit chars in comments 2005-02-05 10:33:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0e4b59b4b2 Get setenv module from gnulib 2005-02-05 10:32:35 +00:00
Paul Eggert
a6f6974f75 Improved checksum diagnostics; adjust to gnulib changes. 2005-02-04 01:52:48 +00:00
Paul Eggert
8f0112cb23 (from_header): New arg OCTAL_ONLY, normally false.
All uses changed.  Fix typo that sometimes suppressed all "Archive
contains obsolescent base-64 headers" warnings, not just the first
one.
(tar_checksum): Accept only octal checksums, since they aren't
supposed to overflow into weird formats.
2005-02-04 01:52:20 +00:00
Paul Eggert
9c2f942930 Adjust to gnulib changes.
* lib/.cvsignore: Add chdir-long.c, chdir-long.h, memrchr.c,
memrchr.h, openat.c, openat.h.  Remove pathmax.h (added by
mistake, perhaps?), sysexit.h (my typo), xstrdup.c (gnulib removed
this file).  Sort entries.
2005-02-04 01:44:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5422166048 Updated 2005-02-04 01:43:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0ad4063606 (update_argv): Changed type to void 2005-02-04 01:42:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
db2d3f2344 Removed unused variables. 2005-02-04 01:42:33 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5179c0b5e6 Further rewrite 2005-02-04 01:41:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
87a7b31a82 Updated 2005-02-04 00:05:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1044149e3a Determine path to the tar executable. 2005-02-04 00:04:55 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d8dc269927 (options) Minor spelling fix 2005-02-04 00:04:40 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1e2e868af5 Add translators' comments 2005-02-04 00:04:16 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c8764440d9 (extract_archive): Rewritten 2005-02-04 00:03:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
59f314a2c4 (start_private_header,write_header_name)
(dump_hard_link): Restore compatibility with 1.13.25
2005-02-04 00:03:42 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0e45413e1e (OLDGNU_NAME_FIELD_SIZE): New constant 2005-02-04 00:03:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2fcd454e17 Updated 2005-02-03 16:29:58 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e318ac6fe8 (RE_CHECK): Added missing space 2005-02-03 16:29:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
71b7086ff7 sort ls output 2005-02-03 16:29:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5cf84df777 Add translators' comment 2005-02-03 16:29:08 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4a7703ff21 Use quote() 2005-02-03 16:28:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
91c69c885b (short_read): Use ngettext()
(new_volume): use quote().
2005-02-03 16:28:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
63c140752f Added tests/genfile.c 2005-02-03 16:27:11 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ce852113e0 Updated 2005-02-03 00:06:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ccb2072c7e Extract and compare sparse file 2005-02-03 00:04:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d8b24b63e8 Skip the test on filesystems that do not update ctime of a file when renaming it. To be reverted when the new incremental mode is ready. 2005-02-03 00:04:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0dcb0ad279 Added sparse02.at 2005-02-03 00:04:02 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0cde2ad44c Test extracting sparse files over a pipe. 2005-02-03 00:03:44 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
88e9b05867 Updated 2005-02-02 11:02:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
198596f161 Extract sparse files even if the output fd is not seekable. 2005-02-02 11:01:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ccac216e67 Updated 2005-02-01 05:52:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
660d760587 Ignore all *.m4 files 2005-02-01 05:51:24 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
771ac30e0f Updated 2005-02-01 05:48:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ebd88883f5 Add append.at 2005-02-01 05:47:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
81572b57a3 Insert Emacs magic to the first line. 2005-02-01 05:47:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5be8e9d4c7 Add a comment to lib/Makefile.am saying that this is an autogenerated file.
Exit with code 1 if any of autotools fails.
2005-02-01 05:46:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4e52e75bbe Updated 2005-01-18 01:53:09 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4caea8d763 Updated 2005-01-18 01:20:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0037ae7f9e Remove inclusion of obstack.h 2005-01-18 01:18:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
01778aa4a9 Updated 2005-01-18 01:18:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3360b2cce4 Moved rendition macros and option value definitions from tar.texi into separate files 2005-01-18 01:15:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5f19de0372 Document new options. Moved rendition macros and option value definitions into separate files 2005-01-18 01:14:04 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cdb27293db New options --unquote (--no-unquote) and --add-file
(add_file_id,read_name_from_file,update_argv): New functions
(parse_opt): Rewritten handling of -T option. Handle hidden
--HANG option for debugging purposes.
(decode_options): Init unquote_option to true. Init argv_stk.
Remove unneded references to files_from_option
2005-01-18 01:12:34 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
937202acb9 (name_file): Removed variable.
(read_name_from_file): Removed function. All callers changed.
(name_close): Removed function. All callers changed.
2005-01-18 01:11:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3971a56b22 (stat_fatal): New function 2005-01-18 01:11:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
18ee9a103a Remove inclusion of obstack.h src/incremen.c 2005-01-18 01:11:05 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
de772cad88 Include obstack.h
(files_from_option): Removed
(unquote_option): New variable
(stat_fatal): New function
(name_close): Removed function.
2005-01-18 01:10:39 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2c9d869851 Raised version number to 1.15.2 2005-01-18 01:10:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2b9556cb8e Complete the reference 2005-01-14 09:27:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
47b2def4a2 *** empty log message *** 2005-01-14 08:47:36 +00:00
Paul Eggert
f389e8657d * tests/testsuite.at (RE_CHECK): Use "join - file", not "join file -". 2005-01-13 20:57:40 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c6ca601327 (RE_CHECK): Use "join - file", not
"join file -", to work around a bug in Solaris 8 join.
2005-01-13 20:57:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5dc9944b5a Updated 2005-01-13 16:19:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
fabcc30f69 Updated 2005-01-13 16:13:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8a59f40796 Updated 2005-01-13 16:07:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1859998c22 Added Josef Bauer 2005-01-13 16:01:14 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e7db56c0ef Added long01.at 2005-01-13 16:00:59 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
14d8c8a035 Sort tar output 2005-01-13 16:00:45 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
471cf501e5 Test listing of GNU long names divisible by 512. 2005-01-13 16:00:23 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
4719a5d55b Use memset instead of bzero, memmove
(or memcpy, if appropriate), instead of bcopy, and
strchr/strrchr instead of index/rindex.
Rename isnumber to isnumber_p. Proposed by Albert Chin.
2005-01-13 15:59:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
cff5cfb5ce Updated 2005-01-12 00:08:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ef96e14fe1 Template file for gendocs.sh 2005-01-12 00:07:49 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
248069ea4a Updated 2005-01-11 16:28:17 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
d882e8f39b Reworded docstrings for --[no-]same-permissions 2005-01-11 16:28:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3e5686c1ec Updated docs for --[no-]same-permissions 2005-01-11 16:27:57 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b8efe40f54 Use gendocs.sh to generate web documentation 2005-01-11 16:27:43 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
73777093b1 Updated for 1.15.1 2005-01-11 16:27:26 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
746e6b45b6 Updated 2005-01-06 18:33:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c251377da9 Updated 2005-01-06 18:27:36 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
39a00a8f4f Do not create useless directory 2005-01-06 18:17:20 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
85d8f1d2a2 Add options02.at 2005-01-06 18:16:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2266e14d8c Test that tar correctly handles non-option arguments interspersed with options. 2005-01-06 18:16:30 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
941d7586db Call tar_PAXUTILS 2005-01-06 18:15:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
1c7a6c11ce Create m4/paxutils.m4 2005-01-06 18:15:12 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2ad41b6fe0 (parse_opt): Bugfix: Use ARGP_KEY_ARG. Thanks Mike Frysinger <vapier@gentoo.org> for reporting. 2005-01-05 17:30:36 +00:00
Paul Eggert
af2fa08aa0 * lib/Makefile.tmpl (localedir.h): Omit needless quotes and a
needless sed command.
2005-01-04 20:20:56 +00:00
Paul Eggert
93e4188e60 Accommodate latest gnulib. 2004-12-24 07:44:30 +00:00
Paul Eggert
c0eaf364d0 Add getdate.texi. 2004-12-24 07:43:52 +00:00
Paul Eggert
86c379f7c1 Do not treat alloca-opt specially; this is no
longer needed (and breaks builds) with latest gnulib.
2004-12-24 07:43:32 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
3352016cf0 Updated 2004-12-22 10:54:22 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
6bc808b25f (main): Reverted recent changes (#ifdef). 2004-12-22 10:53:48 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
19f60610d1 Updated 2004-12-21 16:21:53 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2433f6813e (open_compressed_archive): Do not attemt to determine compression type if handling multi-volume archive 2004-12-21 15:10:56 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
76bbb5710f Minor improvement: reset hit_eof in open_compressed_archive 2004-12-21 15:00:29 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
e8fbac5ec1 Updated 2004-12-21 14:45:18 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5842962ed6 (main): Protect invocation of setlocale by ifdef. 2004-12-21 14:44:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
368172bf25 (from_header, tar_checksum): Changed declaration. All callers updated. 2004-12-21 14:44:03 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
0f9b299745 (tar_checksum): changed declaration 2004-12-21 14:42:15 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
ab3b31cfef (check_compressed_archive): Check remote archves as well 2004-12-21 14:41:35 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
f152367c57 Updated 2004-12-21 13:38:01 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
a34d0e906f Updated 2004-12-21 13:27:50 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
dcedecad2b Rewritten in xhtml to follow recent GNU site standards. 2004-12-21 13:27:28 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
436741221c Discard stderr from sort, on some systems it spits out lots of irrelevant info. 2004-12-21 13:27:06 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
8ccde495f4 Use AT_GZIP_PREREQ 2004-12-21 13:26:41 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
29a6b977e9 (comprec.at,pipe.at): New tests 2004-12-21 13:26:07 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
5129d9eb8c New test 2004-12-21 13:24:37 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
b5c890b887 (main): Protect invocation of setlocale by ifdef. 2004-12-21 13:24:00 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
2d57bb240d Bugfix. Changes introduced 2004-11-26 broke extraction from stdin. 2004-12-21 13:23:46 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
554e50b438 Entry for 1.15.1 2004-12-21 13:23:27 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
c6834baaf6 Raise version number to 1.15.1; Check for locale.h 2004-12-21 13:23:10 +00:00
Sergey Poznyakoff
17600e0de8 Updated 2004-12-20 14:02:22 +00:00
219 changed files with 26948 additions and 18762 deletions

View File

@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
config
configure
aclocal.m4
ABOUT-NLS
autom4te.cache
config.hin
COPYING
INSTALL
Makefile.in
config.log
config.status
Makefile
config.h
stamp-h1
*.tar
*.tar.gz
*.tar.bz2
*.shar.gz
gnulib
gnulib/*
gnulib/*/*
rmt
rmt/*
rmt/*/*

31
.gitignore vendored Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
*.a
*.la
*.lo
*.o
*.so
*~
.bootstrap
.deps
.emacs*
.libs
ABOUT-NLS
ChangeLog
INSTALL
Makefile
Makefile.in
Make.rules
aclocal.m4
autom4te.cache
config.h
config.h.in
config.log
config.status
configure
gnulib
libtool
m4
paxutils
stamp-h1
build-aux/
gnu

41
AUTHORS
View File

@@ -1,34 +1,15 @@
Authors of GNU tar.
The following contributions warranted legal paper exchanges with the
Free Software Foundation. Also see files ChangeLog and THANKS.
Public domain tar was written by John Gilmore, with contributions from
Henry Spencer, Fred Fish, Ian Darwin, Geoff Collyer, Stan Barber, Guy
Harris, Dave Brower, Richard Todd, Michael Rendell, Stu Heiss, and
Rich Salz.
TAR Sergey Poznyakoff 2003-10
Assigns his past and future changes.
The FSF version, named GNU tar, was derived from public domain tar by
Jay Fenlason and Joy Kendall. Amy Gorin and Melissa Weisshaus
contributed to the manual. GNU tar has been maintained in turn by
Thomas Bushnell BSG, François Pinard, Paul Eggert, and Sergey
Poznyakoff.
TAR Paul Eggert 2000-10
Assigns his past and future changes.
TAR Jay Fenlason
Assigns his changes.
TAR Richard E Salz 1993-03-11
Disclaims changes to getdate.y.
TAR MANUAL (?) Amy Gorin (US 1963) 1995-01-10
Assigns the Tar Manual.
TAR Francois Pinard Canada 1949 1996-02-01
Assigns past and future changes.
TAR Melissa Weisshaus US 1966 1997-04-09
Assigns changes to the manual and future changes.
melissa@gnu.ai.mit.edu
TAR Thomas Michael Innis Bushnell US 1967 1997-04-09
Assigns changes.
thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu
TAR Thomas Michael Innis Bushnell US 1967 1997-04-09
Assigns changes to manual.
thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu
Many others have contributed to GNU tar; please see the files THANKS
and ChangeLog.

676
COPYING Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,676 @@
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 3, 29 June 2007
Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc. <http://fsf.org/>
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
Preamble
The GNU General Public License is a free, copyleft license for
software and other kinds of works.
The licenses for most software and other practical works are designed
to take away your freedom to share and change the works. By contrast,
the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to
share and change all versions of a program--to make sure it remains free
software for all its users. We, the Free Software Foundation, use the
GNU General Public License for most of our software; it applies also to
any other work released this way by its authors. You can apply it to
your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not
price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you
have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for
them if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you
want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new
free programs, and that you know you can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to prevent others from denying you
these rights or asking you to surrender the rights. Therefore, you have
certain responsibilities if you distribute copies of the software, or if
you modify it: responsibilities to respect the freedom of others.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether
gratis or for a fee, you must pass on to the recipients the same
freedoms that you received. You must make sure that they, too, receive
or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they
know their rights.
Developers that use the GNU GPL protect your rights with two steps:
(1) assert copyright on the software, and (2) offer you this License
giving you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify it.
For the developers' and authors' protection, the GPL clearly explains
that there is no warranty for this free software. For both users' and
authors' sake, the GPL requires that modified versions be marked as
changed, so that their problems will not be attributed erroneously to
authors of previous versions.
Some devices are designed to deny users access to install or run
modified versions of the software inside them, although the manufacturer
can do so. This is fundamentally incompatible with the aim of
protecting users' freedom to change the software. The systematic
pattern of such abuse occurs in the area of products for individuals to
use, which is precisely where it is most unacceptable. Therefore, we
have designed this version of the GPL to prohibit the practice for those
products. If such problems arise substantially in other domains, we
stand ready to extend this provision to those domains in future versions
of the GPL, as needed to protect the freedom of users.
Finally, every program is threatened constantly by software patents.
States should not allow patents to restrict development and use of
software on general-purpose computers, but in those that do, we wish to
avoid the special danger that patents applied to a free program could
make it effectively proprietary. To prevent this, the GPL assures that
patents cannot be used to render the program non-free.
The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and
modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS
0. Definitions.
"This License" refers to version 3 of the GNU General Public License.
"Copyright" also means copyright-like laws that apply to other kinds of
works, such as semiconductor masks.
"The Program" refers to any copyrightable work licensed under this
License. Each licensee is addressed as "you". "Licensees" and
"recipients" may be individuals or organizations.
To "modify" a work means to copy from or adapt all or part of the work
in a fashion requiring copyright permission, other than the making of an
exact copy. The resulting work is called a "modified version" of the
earlier work or a work "based on" the earlier work.
A "covered work" means either the unmodified Program or a work based
on the Program.
To "propagate" a work means to do anything with it that, without
permission, would make you directly or secondarily liable for
infringement under applicable copyright law, except executing it on a
computer or modifying a private copy. Propagation includes copying,
distribution (with or without modification), making available to the
public, and in some countries other activities as well.
To "convey" a work means any kind of propagation that enables other
parties to make or receive copies. Mere interaction with a user through
a computer network, with no transfer of a copy, is not conveying.
An interactive user interface displays "Appropriate Legal Notices"
to the extent that it includes a convenient and prominently visible
feature that (1) displays an appropriate copyright notice, and (2)
tells the user that there is no warranty for the work (except to the
extent that warranties are provided), that licensees may convey the
work under this License, and how to view a copy of this License. If
the interface presents a list of user commands or options, such as a
menu, a prominent item in the list meets this criterion.
1. Source Code.
The "source code" for a work means the preferred form of the work
for making modifications to it. "Object code" means any non-source
form of a work.
A "Standard Interface" means an interface that either is an official
standard defined by a recognized standards body, or, in the case of
interfaces specified for a particular programming language, one that
is widely used among developers working in that language.
The "System Libraries" of an executable work include anything, other
than the work as a whole, that (a) is included in the normal form of
packaging a Major Component, but which is not part of that Major
Component, and (b) serves only to enable use of the work with that
Major Component, or to implement a Standard Interface for which an
implementation is available to the public in source code form. A
"Major Component", in this context, means a major essential component
(kernel, window system, and so on) of the specific operating system
(if any) on which the executable work runs, or a compiler used to
produce the work, or an object code interpreter used to run it.
The "Corresponding Source" for a work in object code form means all
the source code needed to generate, install, and (for an executable
work) run the object code and to modify the work, including scripts to
control those activities. However, it does not include the work's
System Libraries, or general-purpose tools or generally available free
programs which are used unmodified in performing those activities but
which are not part of the work. For example, Corresponding Source
includes interface definition files associated with source files for
the work, and the source code for shared libraries and dynamically
linked subprograms that the work is specifically designed to require,
such as by intimate data communication or control flow between those
subprograms and other parts of the work.
The Corresponding Source need not include anything that users
can regenerate automatically from other parts of the Corresponding
Source.
The Corresponding Source for a work in source code form is that
same work.
2. Basic Permissions.
All rights granted under this License are granted for the term of
copyright on the Program, and are irrevocable provided the stated
conditions are met. This License explicitly affirms your unlimited
permission to run the unmodified Program. The output from running a
covered work is covered by this License only if the output, given its
content, constitutes a covered work. This License acknowledges your
rights of fair use or other equivalent, as provided by copyright law.
You may make, run and propagate covered works that you do not
convey, without conditions so long as your license otherwise remains
in force. You may convey covered works to others for the sole purpose
of having them make modifications exclusively for you, or provide you
with facilities for running those works, provided that you comply with
the terms of this License in conveying all material for which you do
not control copyright. Those thus making or running the covered works
for you must do so exclusively on your behalf, under your direction
and control, on terms that prohibit them from making any copies of
your copyrighted material outside their relationship with you.
Conveying under any other circumstances is permitted solely under
the conditions stated below. Sublicensing is not allowed; section 10
makes it unnecessary.
3. Protecting Users' Legal Rights From Anti-Circumvention Law.
No covered work shall be deemed part of an effective technological
measure under any applicable law fulfilling obligations under article
11 of the WIPO copyright treaty adopted on 20 December 1996, or
similar laws prohibiting or restricting circumvention of such
measures.
When you convey a covered work, you waive any legal power to forbid
circumvention of technological measures to the extent such circumvention
is effected by exercising rights under this License with respect to
the covered work, and you disclaim any intention to limit operation or
modification of the work as a means of enforcing, against the work's
users, your or third parties' legal rights to forbid circumvention of
technological measures.
4. Conveying Verbatim Copies.
You may convey verbatim copies of the Program's source code as you
receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice;
keep intact all notices stating that this License and any
non-permissive terms added in accord with section 7 apply to the code;
keep intact all notices of the absence of any warranty; and give all
recipients a copy of this License along with the Program.
You may charge any price or no price for each copy that you convey,
and you may offer support or warranty protection for a fee.
5. Conveying Modified Source Versions.
You may convey a work based on the Program, or the modifications to
produce it from the Program, in the form of source code under the
terms of section 4, provided that you also meet all of these conditions:
a) The work must carry prominent notices stating that you modified
it, and giving a relevant date.
b) The work must carry prominent notices stating that it is
released under this License and any conditions added under section
7. This requirement modifies the requirement in section 4 to
"keep intact all notices".
c) You must license the entire work, as a whole, under this
License to anyone who comes into possession of a copy. This
License will therefore apply, along with any applicable section 7
additional terms, to the whole of the work, and all its parts,
regardless of how they are packaged. This License gives no
permission to license the work in any other way, but it does not
invalidate such permission if you have separately received it.
d) If the work has interactive user interfaces, each must display
Appropriate Legal Notices; however, if the Program has interactive
interfaces that do not display Appropriate Legal Notices, your
work need not make them do so.
A compilation of a covered work with other separate and independent
works, which are not by their nature extensions of the covered work,
and which are not combined with it such as to form a larger program,
in or on a volume of a storage or distribution medium, is called an
"aggregate" if the compilation and its resulting copyright are not
used to limit the access or legal rights of the compilation's users
beyond what the individual works permit. Inclusion of a covered work
in an aggregate does not cause this License to apply to the other
parts of the aggregate.
6. Conveying Non-Source Forms.
You may convey a covered work in object code form under the terms
of sections 4 and 5, provided that you also convey the
machine-readable Corresponding Source under the terms of this License,
in one of these ways:
a) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by the
Corresponding Source fixed on a durable physical medium
customarily used for software interchange.
b) Convey the object code in, or embodied in, a physical product
(including a physical distribution medium), accompanied by a
written offer, valid for at least three years and valid for as
long as you offer spare parts or customer support for that product
model, to give anyone who possesses the object code either (1) a
copy of the Corresponding Source for all the software in the
product that is covered by this License, on a durable physical
medium customarily used for software interchange, for a price no
more than your reasonable cost of physically performing this
conveying of source, or (2) access to copy the
Corresponding Source from a network server at no charge.
c) Convey individual copies of the object code with a copy of the
written offer to provide the Corresponding Source. This
alternative is allowed only occasionally and noncommercially, and
only if you received the object code with such an offer, in accord
with subsection 6b.
d) Convey the object code by offering access from a designated
place (gratis or for a charge), and offer equivalent access to the
Corresponding Source in the same way through the same place at no
further charge. You need not require recipients to copy the
Corresponding Source along with the object code. If the place to
copy the object code is a network server, the Corresponding Source
may be on a different server (operated by you or a third party)
that supports equivalent copying facilities, provided you maintain
clear directions next to the object code saying where to find the
Corresponding Source. Regardless of what server hosts the
Corresponding Source, you remain obligated to ensure that it is
available for as long as needed to satisfy these requirements.
e) Convey the object code using peer-to-peer transmission, provided
you inform other peers where the object code and Corresponding
Source of the work are being offered to the general public at no
charge under subsection 6d.
A separable portion of the object code, whose source code is excluded
from the Corresponding Source as a System Library, need not be
included in conveying the object code work.
A "User Product" is either (1) a "consumer product", which means any
tangible personal property which is normally used for personal, family,
or household purposes, or (2) anything designed or sold for incorporation
into a dwelling. In determining whether a product is a consumer product,
doubtful cases shall be resolved in favor of coverage. For a particular
product received by a particular user, "normally used" refers to a
typical or common use of that class of product, regardless of the status
of the particular user or of the way in which the particular user
actually uses, or expects or is expected to use, the product. A product
is a consumer product regardless of whether the product has substantial
commercial, industrial or non-consumer uses, unless such uses represent
the only significant mode of use of the product.
"Installation Information" for a User Product means any methods,
procedures, authorization keys, or other information required to install
and execute modified versions of a covered work in that User Product from
a modified version of its Corresponding Source. The information must
suffice to ensure that the continued functioning of the modified object
code is in no case prevented or interfered with solely because
modification has been made.
If you convey an object code work under this section in, or with, or
specifically for use in, a User Product, and the conveying occurs as
part of a transaction in which the right of possession and use of the
User Product is transferred to the recipient in perpetuity or for a
fixed term (regardless of how the transaction is characterized), the
Corresponding Source conveyed under this section must be accompanied
by the Installation Information. But this requirement does not apply
if neither you nor any third party retains the ability to install
modified object code on the User Product (for example, the work has
been installed in ROM).
The requirement to provide Installation Information does not include a
requirement to continue to provide support service, warranty, or updates
for a work that has been modified or installed by the recipient, or for
the User Product in which it has been modified or installed. Access to a
network may be denied when the modification itself materially and
adversely affects the operation of the network or violates the rules and
protocols for communication across the network.
Corresponding Source conveyed, and Installation Information provided,
in accord with this section must be in a format that is publicly
documented (and with an implementation available to the public in
source code form), and must require no special password or key for
unpacking, reading or copying.
7. Additional Terms.
"Additional permissions" are terms that supplement the terms of this
License by making exceptions from one or more of its conditions.
Additional permissions that are applicable to the entire Program shall
be treated as though they were included in this License, to the extent
that they are valid under applicable law. If additional permissions
apply only to part of the Program, that part may be used separately
under those permissions, but the entire Program remains governed by
this License without regard to the additional permissions.
When you convey a copy of a covered work, you may at your option
remove any additional permissions from that copy, or from any part of
it. (Additional permissions may be written to require their own
removal in certain cases when you modify the work.) You may place
additional permissions on material, added by you to a covered work,
for which you have or can give appropriate copyright permission.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, for material you
add to a covered work, you may (if authorized by the copyright holders of
that material) supplement the terms of this License with terms:
a) Disclaiming warranty or limiting liability differently from the
terms of sections 15 and 16 of this License; or
b) Requiring preservation of specified reasonable legal notices or
author attributions in that material or in the Appropriate Legal
Notices displayed by works containing it; or
c) Prohibiting misrepresentation of the origin of that material, or
requiring that modified versions of such material be marked in
reasonable ways as different from the original version; or
d) Limiting the use for publicity purposes of names of licensors or
authors of the material; or
e) Declining to grant rights under trademark law for use of some
trade names, trademarks, or service marks; or
f) Requiring indemnification of licensors and authors of that
material by anyone who conveys the material (or modified versions of
it) with contractual assumptions of liability to the recipient, for
any liability that these contractual assumptions directly impose on
those licensors and authors.
All other non-permissive additional terms are considered "further
restrictions" within the meaning of section 10. If the Program as you
received it, or any part of it, contains a notice stating that it is
governed by this License along with a term that is a further
restriction, you may remove that term. If a license document contains
a further restriction but permits relicensing or conveying under this
License, you may add to a covered work material governed by the terms
of that license document, provided that the further restriction does
not survive such relicensing or conveying.
If you add terms to a covered work in accord with this section, you
must place, in the relevant source files, a statement of the
additional terms that apply to those files, or a notice indicating
where to find the applicable terms.
Additional terms, permissive or non-permissive, may be stated in the
form of a separately written license, or stated as exceptions;
the above requirements apply either way.
8. Termination.
You may not propagate or modify a covered work except as expressly
provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to propagate or
modify it is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under
this License (including any patent licenses granted under the third
paragraph of section 11).
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your
license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a)
provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and
finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright
holder fails to notify you of the violation by some reasonable means
prior to 60 days after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is
reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the
violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have
received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that
copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days after
your receipt of the notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the
licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from you under
this License. If your rights have been terminated and not permanently
reinstated, you do not qualify to receive new licenses for the same
material under section 10.
9. Acceptance Not Required for Having Copies.
You are not required to accept this License in order to receive or
run a copy of the Program. Ancillary propagation of a covered work
occurring solely as a consequence of using peer-to-peer transmission
to receive a copy likewise does not require acceptance. However,
nothing other than this License grants you permission to propagate or
modify any covered work. These actions infringe copyright if you do
not accept this License. Therefore, by modifying or propagating a
covered work, you indicate your acceptance of this License to do so.
10. Automatic Licensing of Downstream Recipients.
Each time you convey a covered work, the recipient automatically
receives a license from the original licensors, to run, modify and
propagate that work, subject to this License. You are not responsible
for enforcing compliance by third parties with this License.
An "entity transaction" is a transaction transferring control of an
organization, or substantially all assets of one, or subdividing an
organization, or merging organizations. If propagation of a covered
work results from an entity transaction, each party to that
transaction who receives a copy of the work also receives whatever
licenses to the work the party's predecessor in interest had or could
give under the previous paragraph, plus a right to possession of the
Corresponding Source of the work from the predecessor in interest, if
the predecessor has it or can get it with reasonable efforts.
You may not impose any further restrictions on the exercise of the
rights granted or affirmed under this License. For example, you may
not impose a license fee, royalty, or other charge for exercise of
rights granted under this License, and you may not initiate litigation
(including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that
any patent claim is infringed by making, using, selling, offering for
sale, or importing the Program or any portion of it.
11. Patents.
A "contributor" is a copyright holder who authorizes use under this
License of the Program or a work on which the Program is based. The
work thus licensed is called the contributor's "contributor version".
A contributor's "essential patent claims" are all patent claims
owned or controlled by the contributor, whether already acquired or
hereafter acquired, that would be infringed by some manner, permitted
by this License, of making, using, or selling its contributor version,
but do not include claims that would be infringed only as a
consequence of further modification of the contributor version. For
purposes of this definition, "control" includes the right to grant
patent sublicenses in a manner consistent with the requirements of
this License.
Each contributor grants you a non-exclusive, worldwide, royalty-free
patent license under the contributor's essential patent claims, to
make, use, sell, offer for sale, import and otherwise run, modify and
propagate the contents of its contributor version.
In the following three paragraphs, a "patent license" is any express
agreement or commitment, however denominated, not to enforce a patent
(such as an express permission to practice a patent or covenant not to
sue for patent infringement). To "grant" such a patent license to a
party means to make such an agreement or commitment not to enforce a
patent against the party.
If you convey a covered work, knowingly relying on a patent license,
and the Corresponding Source of the work is not available for anyone
to copy, free of charge and under the terms of this License, through a
publicly available network server or other readily accessible means,
then you must either (1) cause the Corresponding Source to be so
available, or (2) arrange to deprive yourself of the benefit of the
patent license for this particular work, or (3) arrange, in a manner
consistent with the requirements of this License, to extend the patent
license to downstream recipients. "Knowingly relying" means you have
actual knowledge that, but for the patent license, your conveying the
covered work in a country, or your recipient's use of the covered work
in a country, would infringe one or more identifiable patents in that
country that you have reason to believe are valid.
If, pursuant to or in connection with a single transaction or
arrangement, you convey, or propagate by procuring conveyance of, a
covered work, and grant a patent license to some of the parties
receiving the covered work authorizing them to use, propagate, modify
or convey a specific copy of the covered work, then the patent license
you grant is automatically extended to all recipients of the covered
work and works based on it.
A patent license is "discriminatory" if it does not include within
the scope of its coverage, prohibits the exercise of, or is
conditioned on the non-exercise of one or more of the rights that are
specifically granted under this License. You may not convey a covered
work if you are a party to an arrangement with a third party that is
in the business of distributing software, under which you make payment
to the third party based on the extent of your activity of conveying
the work, and under which the third party grants, to any of the
parties who would receive the covered work from you, a discriminatory
patent license (a) in connection with copies of the covered work
conveyed by you (or copies made from those copies), or (b) primarily
for and in connection with specific products or compilations that
contain the covered work, unless you entered into that arrangement,
or that patent license was granted, prior to 28 March 2007.
Nothing in this License shall be construed as excluding or limiting
any implied license or other defenses to infringement that may
otherwise be available to you under applicable patent law.
12. No Surrender of Others' Freedom.
If conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or
otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this License, they do not
excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot convey a
covered work so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this
License and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may
not convey it at all. For example, if you agree to terms that obligate you
to collect a royalty for further conveying from those to whom you convey
the Program, the only way you could satisfy both those terms and this
License would be to refrain entirely from conveying the Program.
13. Use with the GNU Affero General Public License.
Notwithstanding any other provision of this License, you have
permission to link or combine any covered work with a work licensed
under version 3 of the GNU Affero General Public License into a single
combined work, and to convey the resulting work. The terms of this
License will continue to apply to the part which is the covered work,
but the special requirements of the GNU Affero General Public License,
section 13, concerning interaction through a network will apply to the
combination as such.
14. Revised Versions of this License.
The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/or new versions of
the GNU General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will
be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to
address new problems or concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the
Program specifies that a certain numbered version of the GNU General
Public License "or any later version" applies to it, you have the
option of following the terms and conditions either of that numbered
version or of any later version published by the Free Software
Foundation. If the Program does not specify a version number of the
GNU General Public License, you may choose any version ever published
by the Free Software Foundation.
If the Program specifies that a proxy can decide which future
versions of the GNU General Public License can be used, that proxy's
public statement of acceptance of a version permanently authorizes you
to choose that version for the Program.
Later license versions may give you additional or different
permissions. However, no additional obligations are imposed on any
author or copyright holder as a result of your choosing to follow a
later version.
15. Disclaimer of Warranty.
THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY
APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT
HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY
OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM
IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF
ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
16. Limitation of Liability.
IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING
WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MODIFIES AND/OR CONVEYS
THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY
GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE
USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF
DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD
PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS),
EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGES.
17. Interpretation of Sections 15 and 16.
If the disclaimer of warranty and limitation of liability provided
above cannot be given local legal effect according to their terms,
reviewing courts shall apply local law that most closely approximates
an absolute waiver of all civil liability in connection with the
Program, unless a warranty or assumption of liability accompanies a
copy of the Program in return for a fee.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Programs
If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest
possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it
free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms.
To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest
to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively
state the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least
the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found.
<one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does.>
Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
(at your option) any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail.
If the program does terminal interaction, make it output a short
notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode:
<program> Copyright (C) <year> <name of author>
This program comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type `show w'.
This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it
under certain conditions; type `show c' for details.
The hypothetical commands `show w' and `show c' should show the appropriate
parts of the General Public License. Of course, your program's commands
might be different; for a GUI interface, you would use an "about box".
You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or school,
if any, to sign a "copyright disclaimer" for the program, if necessary.
For more information on this, and how to apply and follow the GNU GPL, see
<http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
The GNU General Public License does not permit incorporating your program
into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you
may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with
the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General
Public License instead of this License. But first, please read
<http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/why-not-lgpl.html>.

View File

@@ -19,8 +19,8 @@ GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with GNU Tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
----- ChangeLog -----

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

View File

@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
# Main Makefile for GNU tar.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003 Free
# Software Foundation, Inc.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2007,
# 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
## any later version.
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -15,10 +15,26 @@
## You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
## along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
## Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
## 02111-1307, USA.
## Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
## 02110-1301, USA.
ACLOCAL_AMFLAGS = -I m4
EXTRA_DIST = ChangeLog.1 PORTS
SUBDIRS = doc lib rmt src scripts po tests
EXTRA_DIST = ChangeLog.1 Make.rules
SUBDIRS = doc gnu lib rmt src scripts po tests
dist-hook:
$(MAKE) changelog_dir=$(distdir) make-ChangeLog
-rm -f $(distdir).cpio
find $(distdir) | cpio -Hcrc -o | \
GZIP=$(GZIP_ENV) gzip -c > $(distdir).cpio.gz
distclean-local:
-rm -f $(distdir).cpio.gz
include Make.rules
gen_start_date = 2009-03-06
prev_change_log = ChangeLog.CVS
changelog_dir = .

View File

@@ -1,378 +0,0 @@
# Makefile.in generated automatically by automake 1.1n from Makefile.am
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This Makefile.in is free software; the Free Software Foundation
# gives unlimited permission to copy, distribute and modify it.
# Main Makefile for GNU tar.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
# 02111-1307, USA.
SHELL = /bin/sh
srcdir = @srcdir@
top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
VPATH = @srcdir@
prefix = @prefix@
exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
bindir = @bindir@
sbindir = @sbindir@
libexecdir = @libexecdir@
datadir = @datadir@
sysconfdir = @sysconfdir@
sharedstatedir = @sharedstatedir@
localstatedir = @localstatedir@
libdir = @libdir@
infodir = @infodir@
mandir = @mandir@
includedir = @includedir@
oldincludedir = /usr/include
pkgdatadir = $(datadir)/@PACKAGE@
pkglibdir = $(libdir)/@PACKAGE@
pkgincludedir = $(includedir)/@PACKAGE@
top_builddir = .
ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@
AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@
AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@
AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@
INSTALL = @INSTALL@
INSTALL_PROGRAM = @INSTALL_PROGRAM@
INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
INSTALL_SCRIPT = @INSTALL_SCRIPT@
transform = @program_transform_name@
NORMAL_INSTALL = true
PRE_INSTALL = true
POST_INSTALL = true
NORMAL_UNINSTALL = true
PRE_UNINSTALL = true
POST_UNINSTALL = true
ACLOCAL = @ACLOCAL@
AUTOCONF = @AUTOCONF@
AUTOHEADER = @AUTOHEADER@
AUTOMAKE = @AUTOMAKE@
CATALOGS = @CATALOGS@
CATOBJEXT = @CATOBJEXT@
CC = @CC@
DATADIRNAME = @DATADIRNAME@
ECHO_C = @ECHO_C@
ECHO_N = @ECHO_N@
GENCAT = @GENCAT@
GMOFILES = @GMOFILES@
GMSGFMT = @GMSGFMT@
GT_NO = @GT_NO@
GT_YES = @GT_YES@
INSTOBJEXT = @INSTOBJEXT@
INTLDEPS = @INTLDEPS@
INTLLIBS = @INTLLIBS@
INTLOBJS = @INTLOBJS@
MAKEINFO = @MAKEINFO@
MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
MSGFMT = @MSGFMT@
PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
POFILES = @POFILES@
POSUB = @POSUB@
RANLIB = @RANLIB@
RMT = @RMT@
U = @U@
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL = @USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
USE_NLS = @USE_NLS@
VERSION = @VERSION@
YACC = @YACC@
AUTOMAKE_OPTIONS = gnits dist-shar
BABYL = rmail/* admin/*/RMAIL
EXTRA_DIST = AC-PATCHES AM-PATCHES BI-PATCHES PORTS rebox.el
SUBDIRS = doc lib intl src scripts po tests
ACLOCAL_M4 = $(top_srcdir)/aclocal.m4
CONFIG_HEADER_IN = config.h.in
CONFIG_HEADER_FULL = config.h
mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs
CONFIG_HEADER = config.h
CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES =
DIST_COMMON = README ABOUT-NLS AUTHORS BACKLOG COPYING ChangeLog \
INSTALL Makefile.am Makefile.in NEWS THANKS TODO acconfig.h \
acinclude.m4 aclocal.m4 config.h.in configure configure.in install-sh \
missing mkinstalldirs stamp-h.in
DISTFILES = $(DIST_COMMON) $(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) $(TEXINFOS) $(EXTRA_DIST)
TAR = tar
GZIP = --best
default: all
.SUFFIXES:
$(srcdir)/Makefile.in: Makefile.am $(top_srcdir)/configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4)
cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOMAKE) --gnits Makefile
Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status $(BUILT_SOURCES)
cd $(top_builddir) \
&& CONFIG_FILES=$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
$(srcdir)/aclocal.m4: configure.in acinclude.m4
cd $(srcdir) && $(ACLOCAL)
config.status: configure
$(SHELL) ./config.status --recheck
$(srcdir)/configure: configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4) $(CONFIGURE_DEPENDENCIES)
cd $(srcdir) && $(AUTOCONF)
$(CONFIG_HEADER): stamp-h
stamp-h: $(CONFIG_HEADER_IN) $(top_builddir)/config.status
cd $(top_builddir) \
&& CONFIG_FILES= CONFIG_HEADERS=$(CONFIG_HEADER_FULL) \
$(SHELL) ./config.status
@echo timestamp > stamp-h
$(srcdir)/$(CONFIG_HEADER_IN): stamp-h.in
$(srcdir)/stamp-h.in: $(top_srcdir)/configure.in $(ACLOCAL_M4) acconfig.h
cd $(top_srcdir) && $(AUTOHEADER)
echo timestamp > $(srcdir)/stamp-h.in
mostlyclean-hdr:
clean-hdr:
distclean-hdr:
rm -f $(CONFIG_HEADER)
maintainer-clean-hdr:
# This directory's subdirectories are mostly independent; you can cd
# into them and run `make' without going through this Makefile.
# To change the values of `make' variables: instead of editing Makefiles,
# (1) if the variable is set in `config.status', edit `config.status'
# (which will cause the Makefiles to be regenerated when you run `make');
# (2) otherwise, pass the desired values on the `make' command line.
@SET_MAKE@
all-recursive install-data-recursive install-exec-recursive \
installdirs-recursive install-recursive uninstall-recursive \
check-recursive installcheck-recursive info-recursive dvi-recursive \
mostlyclean-recursive clean-recursive distclean-recursive \
maintainer-clean-recursive:
@for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
target=`echo $@ | sed s/-recursive//`; \
echo "Making $$target in $$subdir"; \
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) $$target) \
|| case "$(MFLAGS)" in *k*) fail=yes;; *) exit 1;; esac; \
done && test -z "$$fail"
tags-recursive:
list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) tags); \
done
tags: TAGS
TAGS: tags-recursive $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES) config.h.in $(TAGS_DEPENDENCIES)
tags=; \
here=`pwd`; \
list='$(SUBDIRS)'; for subdir in $$list; do \
test -f $$subdir/TAGS && tags="$$tags -i $$here/$$subdir/TAGS"; \
done; \
test -z "$(ETAGS_ARGS)config.h.in$(SOURCES)$(HEADERS)$$tags" \
|| (cd $(srcdir) && etags $(ETAGS_ARGS) $$tags config.h.in $(SOURCES) $(HEADERS) -o $$here/TAGS)
mostlyclean-tags:
clean-tags:
distclean-tags:
rm -f TAGS ID
maintainer-clean-tags:
distdir = $(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)
# This target untars the dist file and tries a VPATH configuration. Then
# it guarantees that the distribution is self-contained by making another
# tarfile.
distcheck: dist
rm -rf $(distdir)
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) zxf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r
mkdir $(distdir)/=build
mkdir $(distdir)/=inst
dc_install_base=`cd $(distdir)/=inst && pwd`; \
cd $(distdir)/=build \
&& ../configure --with-included-gettext --srcdir=.. --prefix=$$dc_install_base \
&& $(MAKE) \
&& $(MAKE) dvi \
&& $(MAKE) check \
&& $(MAKE) install \
&& $(MAKE) installcheck \
&& $(MAKE) dist
rm -rf $(distdir)
@echo "========================"; \
echo "$(distdir).tar.gz is ready for distribution"; \
echo "========================"
dist: distdir
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) chozf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r $(distdir)
rm -rf $(distdir)
dist-shar: distdir
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
rm -rf $(distdir)
dist-all: distdir
-chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
GZIP=$(GZIP) $(TAR) chozf $(distdir).tar.gz --mode=a+r $(distdir)
rm -rf $(distdir)
distdir: $(DISTFILES)
@if sed 15q $(srcdir)/NEWS | fgrep -e "$(VERSION)" > /dev/null; then :; else \
echo "NEWS not updated; not releasing" 1>&2; \
exit 1; \
fi
rm -rf $(distdir)
mkdir $(distdir)
-chmod 755 $(distdir)
@for file in $(DISTFILES); do \
d=$(srcdir); \
test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
|| ln $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file 2> /dev/null \
|| cp -p $$d/$$file $(distdir)/$$file; \
done
for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
test -d $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|| mkdir $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|| exit 1; \
chmod 755 $(distdir)/$$subdir; \
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) distdir=../$(distdir)/$$subdir distdir) \
|| exit 1; \
done
info: info-recursive
dvi: dvi-recursive
check: all-am
$(MAKE) check-recursive
installcheck: installcheck-recursive
all-recursive-am: $(CONFIG_HEADER)
$(MAKE) all-recursive
all-am: Makefile config.h all-local
install-exec: install-exec-recursive
@$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
install-data: install-data-recursive
@$(NORMAL_INSTALL)
install: install-recursive
@:
uninstall: uninstall-recursive
all: all-recursive-am all-am
install-strip:
$(MAKE) INSTALL_PROGRAM='$(INSTALL_PROGRAM) -s' install
installdirs: installdirs-recursive
mostlyclean-generic:
test -z "$(MOSTLYCLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(MOSTLYCLEANFILES)
clean-generic:
test -z "$(CLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(CLEANFILES)
distclean-generic:
rm -f Makefile $(DISTCLEANFILES)
rm -f config.cache config.log stamp-h
test -z "$(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)" || rm -f $(CONFIG_CLEAN_FILES)
maintainer-clean-generic:
test -z "$(MAINTAINERCLEANFILES)" || rm -f $(MAINTAINERCLEANFILES)
test -z "$(BUILT_SOURCES)" || rm -f $(BUILT_SOURCES)
mostlyclean-am: mostlyclean-hdr mostlyclean-tags mostlyclean-generic
clean-am: clean-hdr clean-tags clean-generic mostlyclean-am
distclean-am: distclean-hdr distclean-tags distclean-generic clean-am
maintainer-clean-am: maintainer-clean-hdr maintainer-clean-tags \
maintainer-clean-generic distclean-am
mostlyclean: mostlyclean-recursive mostlyclean-am
clean: clean-recursive clean-am
distclean: distclean-recursive distclean-am
rm -f config.status
maintainer-clean: maintainer-clean-recursive maintainer-clean-am
@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
rm -f config.status
.PHONY: default mostlyclean-hdr distclean-hdr clean-hdr \
maintainer-clean-hdr install-data-recursive uninstall-data-recursive \
install-exec-recursive uninstall-exec-recursive installdirs-recursive \
uninstalldirs-recursive all-recursive check-recursive \
installcheck-recursive info-recursive dvi-recursive \
mostlyclean-recursive distclean-recursive clean-recursive \
maintainer-clean-recursive tags tags-recursive mostlyclean-tags \
distclean-tags clean-tags maintainer-clean-tags distdir info dvi \
installcheck all-recursive-am all-am install-exec install-data install \
uninstall all installdirs mostlyclean-generic distclean-generic \
clean-generic maintainer-clean-generic clean mostlyclean distclean \
maintainer-clean
all-local: $(CONFIG_HEADER)
id: ID
ID:
cd lib && $(MAKE) $@
cd src && $(MAKE) $@
dist-zoo: $(DISTFILES)
rm -rf $(distdir)
mkdir $(distdir)
distdir=`cd $(distdir) && pwd` \
&& cd $(srcdir) \
&& automake --include-deps --output-dir=$$distdir
@for file in $(DISTFILES); do \
test -f $(distdir)/$$file \
|| cp -p $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir)/$$file; \
done
for subdir in $(SUBDIRS); do \
test -d $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|| mkdir $(distdir)/$$subdir \
|| exit 1; \
chmod 777 $(distdir)/$$subdir; \
(cd $$subdir && $(MAKE) dist) || exit 1; \
done
@sublist="$(DIST_SUBDIRS)"; \
for dir in $$sublist; do \
echo copying directory $$dir; \
tar -chf - $$dir | (cd $(distdir) && tar -xBpf -); \
done
chmod -R a+r $(distdir)
find $(distdir) -type f | xargs dosfn
# find $(distdir) -type f | xargs recode :ibmpc
mv $(distdir) $(PACKAGE)
find $(PACKAGE) -type f | zoo ahIq $(PACKAGE).zoo
rm -rf $(PACKAGE)
# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make to not export all variables.
# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
.NOEXPORT:

544
NEWS
View File

@@ -1,14 +1,462 @@
GNU tar NEWS - User visible changes.
Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004
Free Software Foundation, Inc.
See the end for copying conditions.
GNU tar NEWS - User visible changes. 2009-03-05
Please send GNU tar bug reports to <bug-tar@gnu.org>
version 1.22 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2009-03-05
* Support for xz compression
Tar uses xz for compression if one of the following conditions is met:
1. The option --xz or -J (see below) is used.
2. The xz binary is set as compressor using --use-compress-program option.
3. The file name of the archive being created ends in `.xz' and
auto-compress option (-a) is used.
Xz is used for decompression if one of the following conditions is met:
1. The option --xz or -J is used.
2. The xz binary is set as compressor using --use-compress-program option.
3. The file is recognized as xz compressed stream data.
* Short option -J reassigned as a short equivalent of --xz
* New option -I
The -I option is assigned as a short equivalent for
--use-compress-program.
* The --no-recursive option works in incremental mode.
version 1.21 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2008-12-27
* New short option -J
A shortcut for --lzma.
* New option --lzop
* New option --no-auto-compress
Cancels the effect of previous --auto-compress (-a) option.
* New option --no-null
Cancels the effect of previous --null option.
* Compressed format recognition
If tar is unable to determine archive compression format, it falls
back to using archive suffix to determine it.
* VCS support.
Using --exclude-vcs handles also files used internally by Bazaar,
Mercurial and Darcs.
* Transformation scope flags
Name transformation expressions understand additional flags that
control type of archive members affected by them. The flags are:
- r
Apply transformation to regular archive members.
- s
Apply transformation to symbolic link targets.
- h
Apply transformation to hard link targets.
Corresponding upper-case letters negate the meaning, so that
`H' means ``do not apply transformation to hard link targets.''
The scope flags are listed in the third part of an `s' expression,
e.g.:
tar --transform 's|^|/usr/local/|S'
Default is `rsh', which means that transformations are applied to
both regular archive members and to the targets of symbolic and hard
links. If several transform expressions are used, the default flags
can be changed using `flags=' statement before the expressions, e.g.:
tar --transform 'flags=S;s|^|/usr/local/|S'
* Bugfixes
** The --null option disabled handling of tar options in list files. This
is fixed.
** Fixed record size autodetection. If detected record size differs from
the expected value (either default, or set on the command line), tar
always prints a warning if verbosity level is set to 1 or greater,
i.e. if either -t or -v option is given.
version 1.20 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2008-04-14
* New option --auto-compress (-a)
With --create, selects compression algorithm basing on the suffix
of the archive file name.
* New option --lzma
Selects LZMA compression algorithm
* New option --hard-dereference
During archive creation, dereferences hard links and stores the files
they refer to, instead of creating usual hard link members (type '1').
* New option --checkpoint-action
This action allows to specify an action to be executed upon hitting a
checkpoint. Recognized actions are: dot, echo (the default),
echo=string, ttyout=string, exec=cmdline, and sleep=value. Any number
of `--checkpoint-action' options can be specified, the actions will be
executed in order of their appearance in the command line. See
chapter 3.8 "Checkpoints" for a complete description.
* New options --no-check-device, --check-device.
The `--no-check-device' option disables comparing device numbers during
preparatory stage of an incremental dump. This allows to avoid
creating full dumps if the device numbers change (e.g. when using an
LVM snapshot).
The `--check-device' option enables comparing device numbers. This is
the default. This option is provided to undo the effect of the previous
`--no-check-device' option, e.g. if it was set in TAR_OPTIONS
environment variable.
* The --transform option.
Any number of `--transform' options can be given in the command line.
The specified transformations will be applied in turn.
The argument to `--transform' option can be a list of replace
expressions, separated by a semicolon (as in `sed').
Filename transformations are applied to symbolic link targets
during both creation and extraction. Tar 1.19 used them only
during extraction.
For a detailed description, see chapter 6.7 "Modifying File and Member
Names".
* Info (end-of-volume) scripts
The value of the blocking factor is made available to info and
checkpoint scripts via environment variable TAR_BLOCKING_FACTOR.
* Incremental archives
Improved (sped up) extracting from incremental archives.
* Bugfixes.
** Fix bug introduced in version 1.19: tar refused to update non-existing
archives.
version 1.19 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-10-10
* New option --exclude-vcs
Excludes directories and files, created by several widely used version
control systems, e.g. "CVS/", ".svn/", etc.
* --exclude-tag and --exclude-cache options
The following options now work with incremental archives as well:
--exclude-caches
--exclude-caches-all
--exclude-tag
--exclude-tag-all
--exclude-tag-under
* Fix handling of renamed files in listed incremental archives.
Previous versions always stored absolute file names in rename
records, even if -P was not used. This is fixed: rename records
contain file names processed in accordance with the command line
settings.
* Fix --version output.
* Recognition of broken archives.
When supplied an archive smaller than 512 bytes in reading mode (-x,
-t), the previous version of tar silently ignored it, exiting with
code 0. It is fixed. Tar now issues the following diagnostic message:
'This does not look like a tar archive', and exits with code 2.
* Fix double-dot recognition in archive member names in case of duplicate '/.'.
* Fix file padding in case of truncation of the input file to zero size.
version 1.18 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-06-29
* Licensed under the GPLv3
* Fixed several bugs in the testsuite
version 1.17 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2007-06-08
* Fix archivation of sparse files in posix mode. Previous versions padded
sparse members with spurious zero blocks.
* Fix operation of --verify --listed-incremental. Version 1.16.1 produced
a full dump when both options were given.
* Fix --occurrence. In previous versions it continued scanning the archive
even though all requested members has already been extracted.
* Scope of --transform and --strip-components options.
In addition to affecting regular archive members, the --transform
option affects hard and soft link targets and the --strip-components
option affects hard link targets as well.
* End-of-volume script can send the new volume name to tar by writing
it to the file descriptor stored in the environment variable `TAR_FD'.
version 1.16.1 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-12-09
* New option --exclude-tag allows to specify "exclusion tag files", i.e.
files whose presence in a directory means that the directory should not
be archived.
* The --exclude-cache option excludes directories that contain the
CACHEDIR.TAG file from being archived. Previous versions excluded
directory contents only, while the directories themselves were
still added to the archive.
* Support for reading ustar type 'N' header logical records has been removed.
This GNU extension was generated only by very old versions of GNU 'tar'.
Unfortunately its implementation had security holes; see
<http://archives.neohapsis.com/archives/fulldisclosure/2006-11/0344.html>.
We don't expect that any tar archives in practical use have type 'N'
records, but if you have one and you trust its contents, you can
decode it with GNU tar 1.16 or earlier.
* Race conditions have been fixed that in some cases briefly allowed
files extracted by 'tar -x --same-owner' (or plain 'tar -x', when
running as root) to be accessed by users that they shouldn't have been.
version 1.16 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-10-21
* After creating an archive, tar exits with code 1 if some files were
changed while being read. Previous versions exited with code 2 (fatal
error), and only if some files were truncated while being archived.
* New option --mtime allows to set modification times for all archive
members during creation.
* Bug fixes
** Avoid running off file descriptors when using multiple -C options.
** tar --index-file=FILE --file=- sent the archive to FILE, and
the listing to stderr.
version 1.15.91 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-06-16
* Incompatible changes
** Globbing
Previous versions of GNU tar assumed shell-style globbing when
extracting from or listing an archive. For example:
tar xf foo.tar '*.c'
would extract all files whose names end in '.c'. This behavior
was not documented and was incompatible with traditional tar
implementations. Therefore, starting from this version, GNU tar
no longer uses globbing by default. For example, the above invocation
is now interpreted as a request to extract from the archive the file
named '*.c'.
To treat member names as globbing patterns, use --wildcards option.
If you wish tar to mimic the behavior of versions up to 1.15.90,
add --wildcards to the value of the environment variable TAR_OPTIONS.
The exact way in which tar interprets member names is controlled by the
following command line options:
--wildcards use wildcards
--anchored patterns match file name start
--ignore-case ignore case
--wildcards-match-slash wildcards match `/'
Each of these options has a '--no-' counterpart that disables its
effect (e.g. --no-wildcards).
These options affect both the interpretation of member names from
command line and that of the exclusion patterns (given with --exclude
and --exclude-from options). The defaults are:
1. For member names: --no-wildcards --anchored
2. For exclusion patterns: --wildcards --no-anchored --wildcards-match-slash
The options can appear multiple times in the command line, thereby
changing the way command line arguments are interpreted. For example,
to use case-insensitive matching in exclude patterns and to revert to
case-sensitive matching for the rest of command line, one could write:
tar xf foo.tar --ignore-case --exclude-from=FILE --no-ignore-case file.name
** Short option -l is now an alias of --check-links option, which complies
with UNIX98. This ends the transition period started with version 1.14.
* New features
** New option --transform allows to transform file names before storing them
in the archive or member names before extracting. The option takes a
sed replace expression as its argument. For example,
tar cf foo.tar --transform 's,^,prefix/,'
will add 'prefix/' to all file names stored in foo.tar.
** --strip-components option works when deleting and comparing. In previous
versions it worked only with --extract.
** New option --show-transformed-names enables display of transformed file
or archive. It generalizes --show-stored-names option, introduced in
1.15.90. In particular, when creating an archive in verbose mode, it lists
member names as stored in the archive, i.e., with any eventual prefixes
removed and file name transformations applied. The option is useful,
for example, while comparing `tar cv' and `tar tv' outputs.
** New incremental snapshot file format keeps information about file names
as well as that about directories.
** The --checkpoint option takes an optional argument specifying the number
of records between the two successive checkpoints. Optional dot
starting the argument intructs tar to print dots instead of textual
checkpoints.
** The --totals option can be used with any tar operation (previous versions
understood it only with --create). If an argument to this option is
given, it specifies the signal upon delivery of which the statistics
is to be printed. Both forms of this option (with and without
argument) can be given to in a single invocation of tar.
* Bug fixes
** Detect attempts to update compressed archives.
version 1.15.90 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2006-02-19
* New features
** Any number of -T (--files-from) options may be used in the command line.
The file specified with -T may include any valid `tar' options,
including another -T option.
Compatibility note: older versions of tar would only recognize -C
as an option name within the file list file. Now any file whose name
starts with - is handled as an option. To insert file names starting with
dash, use the --add-file option.
** List files containing null-separated file names are detected and processed
automatically. It is no longer necessary to give the --null option.
** New option --no-unquote disables the unquoting of input file names.
This is useful for processing output from `find dir -print0'.
An orthogonal option --unquote is provided as well.
** New option --test-label tests the archive volume label.
If an argument is specified, the label is compared against its value.
Tar exits with code 0 if the two strings match, and with code 2 if
they do not.
If no argument is given, the --verbose option is implied. In this case,
tar prints the label name if present and exits with code 0.
** New option --show-stored-names. When creating an archive in verbose mode,
it lists member names as stored in the archive, i.e., with any eventual
prefixes removed. The option is useful, for example, while comparing
`tar cv' and `tar tv' outputs.
** New option --to-command pipes the contents of archive members to the
specified command.
** New option --atime-preserve=system, which uses the O_NOATIME feature
of recent Linux kernels to avoid some problems when preserving file
access times.
** New option --delay-directory-restore delays restoring modification times
and permissions of extracted directories until the end of extraction.
This is necessary for restoring from archives with unusual member
ordering (in particular, those created with --no-recursion option).
This option is implied when restoring from incremental archives.
** New option --restrict prohibits use of some potentially harmful tar
options. Currently it disables '!' escape in multi-volume name menu.
** New options --quoting-style and --quote-chars control the way tar
quotes member names on output. The --quoting-style takes an argument
specifying the quoting style to use (literal, shell, shell-always,
c, escape, locale, clocale). The argument to --quote-chars is a string
specifying characters to quote, even if the selected quoting style
would not quote them otherwise. The option --no-quote-chars is
provided to disable quoting certain characters.
** The end-of-volume script (introduced with --info-script option) can
get current archive name from the environment variable TAR_ARCHIVE and
the volume number from the variable TAR_VOLUME. It can alter the
archive name by writing new name to the file descriptor 3.
** Better support for full-resolution time stamps. Tar cannot restore
time stamps to full nanosecond resolution, though, until the kernel
guys get their act together and give us a system call to set file time
stamps to nanosecond resolution.
** The -v option now prints time stamps only to 1-minute resolution,
not full resolution, to avoid using up too many output columns.
Nanosecond resolution is now supported, but that would be too much.
* Bug fixes
** Allow non-option arguments to be interspersed with options.
** When extracting or listing archives in old GNU format, tar
used to read an extra block of data after a long name header
if length of the member name was divisible by block size (512).
Consequently, the file pointer was set off and the next member
was not processed correctly.
** Previous version created invalid archives when files shrink
during reading.
** Compare mode (tar d) hung when trying to compare file contents.
** Previous versions in certain cases failed to restore directory
modification times.
** When creating an archive, do not attempt to store files whose
meta-data cannot be stored in the header due to format limitations
(for ustar and v7 formats).
** The --version option now also outputs information about copyright,
license, and credits. This reverts to the behavior of tar 1.14 and
earlier, and conforms to the GNU coding standards. The --license (-L)
option introduced in tar 1.15 has been removed, since it's no longer
needed.
version 1.15.1 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2004-12-21
This version fixes a bug introduced in 1.15 which caused
tar to refuse to extract files from standard input.
version 1.15 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2004-12-20
* Compressed archives are recognised automatically, it is no longer
necessary to specify -Z, -z, or -j options to read them. Thus, you can
necessary to specify -Z, -z, or -j options to read them. Thus, you can
now run `tar tf archive.tar.gz'.
* When restoring incremental dumps, --one-file-system option
@@ -18,7 +466,7 @@ from being purged.
With the previous versions of tar it was dangerous to create
incremental dumps with --one-file-system option, since they
would recursively remove mount points when restoring from the
back up. This change fixes the bug.
back up. This change fixes the bug.
* Renamed --strip-path to --strip-components for consistency with
the GNU convention.
@@ -27,28 +475,28 @@ the GNU convention.
seeks.
* Restore script starts restoring only if it is given --all (-a) option,
or some patterns. This is to prevent accidental restores.
or some patterns. This is to prevent accidental restores.
* `tar --verify' prints a warning if during archive creation some of
the file names had their prefixes stripped off.
* New option --exclude-caches instructs tar to exclude cache directories
automatically on archive creation. Cache directories are those
automatically on archive creation. Cache directories are those
containing a standardized tag file, as specified at:
http://www.brynosaurus.com/cachedir/spec.html
http://www.brynosaurus.com/cachedir/spec.html
* New configure option --with-rmt allows to specify full path name to
the `rmt' utility. This supercedes DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND variable
the `rmt' utility. This supersedes DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND variable
introduced in version 1.14
* New configure variable DEFAULT_RMT_DIR allows to specify the directory
where to install `rmt' utility. This is necessary since modifying
where to install `rmt' utility. This is necessary since modifying
--libexecdir as was suggested for version 1.14 produced a side effect: it
also modified installation prefix for backup scripts (if
--enable-backup-scripts was given).
* Bugfixes:
* Bug fixes:
** Fixed flow in recognizing files to be included in incremental dumps.
** Correctly recognize sparse archive members when used with -T option.
** GNU multivolume headers cannot store filenames longer than 100 characters.
@@ -56,16 +504,16 @@ Do not allow multivolume archives to begin with such filenames.
** If a member with link count > 2 was stored in the archive twice,
previous versions of tar were not able to extract it, since they
were trying to link the file to itself, which always failed and
lead to removing the already extracted copy. Preserve the first
lead to removing the already extracted copy. Preserve the first
extracted copy in such cases.
** Restore script was passing improper argument to tar --listed option (which
didn't affect the functionality, but was logically incorrect).
** Fixed verification of created archives.
** Fixed verification of created archives.
** Fixed unquoting of file names containing backslash escapes (previous
versions failed to recognize \a and \v).
** When attempting to delete a non-existing member from the archive, previous
versions of tar used to overwrite last archive block with zeroes.
version 1.14 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2004-05-11
@@ -81,28 +529,28 @@ version 1.14 - Sergey Poznyakoff, 2004-05-11
option is now the default; use --no-overwrite-dir if you prefer
the previous default behavior.
* The semantics of -o option is changed. When extracting, it
does the same as --no-same-owner GNU tar option. This is compatible
with UNIX98 tar. Otherwise, its effect is the same as that of
--old-archive option. This latter is deprecated and will be removed
* The semantics of -o option is changed. When extracting, it
does the same as --no-same-owner GNU tar option. This is compatible
with UNIX98 tar. Otherwise, its effect is the same as that of
--old-archive option. This latter is deprecated and will be removed
in future.
* New option --check-links prints a message if not all links are dumped
for a file being archived. This corresponds to the UNIX98 -l option.
for a file being archived. This corresponds to the UNIX98 -l option.
The current semantics of the -l option is retained for compatibility
with previous releases, however such usage is strongly deprecated as
the option will change to its UNIX98 semantics in the future releases.
* New option --occurrence[=N] can be used in conjunction with one of
* New option --occurrence[=N] can be used in conjunction with one of
the subcommands --delete, --diff, --extract or --list when a list of
files is given either on the command line or via -T option. This
files is given either on the command line or via -T option. This
option instructs tar to process only the Nth occurrence of each named
file. N defaults to 1, so `tar -x -f archive --occurrence filename'
file. N defaults to 1, so `tar -x -f archive --occurrence filename'
extracts the first occurrence of `filename' from `archive'
and terminates without scanning to the end of the archive.
* New option --pax-option allows to control the handling of POSIX
keywords in `pax' extended headers. It is equivalent to `pax'
keywords in `pax' extended headers. It is equivalent to `pax'
-o option.
* --incremental and --listed-incremental options work correctly on
@@ -114,18 +562,18 @@ option is given to configure.
* By default tar searches "rmt" utility in "$prefix/libexec/rmt",
which is consistent with the location where the version of "rmt"
included in the package is installed. Previous versions of tar
used "/etc/rmt". To install "rmt" to its traditional location,
run configure with option --libexecdir=/etc. Otherwise, if you
included in the package is installed. Previous versions of tar
used "/etc/rmt". To install "rmt" to its traditional location,
run configure with option --libexecdir=/etc. Otherwise, if you
already have rmt installed and wish to use it, instead of the
shipped in version, set the variable DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND to
the full path name of the utility, e.g. ./configure
the full path name of the utility, e.g., ./configure
DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND=/etc/rmt.
Notice also that the full path name of the "rmt" utility to
use can be set at runtime, by giving option --rmt-command to
tar.
tar.
* Removed obsolete command line options:
** --absolute-paths superseded by --absolute-names
** --block-compress is not needed any longer
@@ -138,7 +586,7 @@ tar.
* New message translations fi (Finnish), gl (Galician), hr (Croatian),
hu (Hungarian), ms (Malaysian), nb (Norwegian), ro (Romanian), sk
(Slovak), zh_CN (Chinese simplified), zh_TW (Chinese traditional).
The code 'no' for Norwegian (Bokm<EFBFBD>l) has been withdrawn; use 'nb' instead.
The code 'no' for Norwegian (Bokmål) has been withdrawn; use 'nb' instead.
* Bug fixes.
@@ -196,7 +644,7 @@ version 1.13.20 - Paul Eggert, 2001-08-27
The translation for Korean has been withdrawn due to encoding errors.
It will be reissued once those are fixed.
version 1.13.19 - Paul Eggert, 2001-01-13
* The -I option has been withdrawn, as it was buggy and confusing.
@@ -205,7 +653,7 @@ version 1.13.19 - Paul Eggert, 2001-01-13
* With an option like -N DATE, if DATE starts with "/" or ".", it is taken
to be a file name; the last-modified time of that file is used as the date.
version 1.13.18 - Paul Eggert, 2000-10-29
* Some security problems have been fixed. `tar -x' now modifies only
@@ -233,7 +681,7 @@ version 1.13.18 - Paul Eggert, 2000-10-29
* This version of tar works best with GNU gzip test version 1.3 or later.
Please see <ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/gzip/>.
* `tar --delete -f -' now works again.
@@ -265,7 +713,7 @@ version 1.13.16 - Paul Eggert, 1999-12-13.
when extracting, and warns about such file names when creating an archive.
To enable the old behavior, use the -P or --absolute-names option.
* Tar now handles file names with multibyte encodings (e.g. UTF-8, Shift-JIS)
* Tar now handles file names with multibyte encodings (e.g., UTF-8, Shift-JIS)
correctly. It relies on the mbrtowc function to handle multibyte characters.
* The file generated by -g or --listed-incremental now uses a format
@@ -280,19 +728,19 @@ version 1.13.16 - Paul Eggert, 1999-12-13.
`quoted like this' (in the default C locale) or are followed by
colon, newline, or space, depending on context. Unprintable
characters are escaped with a C-like backslash conventions.
Terminating characters (e.g. close-quote, colon, newline)
Terminating characters (e.g., close-quote, colon, newline)
are also escaped as needed.
* tar now ignores socket files when creating an archive.
Previously tar archived sockets as fifos, which caused problems.
version 1.13.15 - Paul Eggert, 1999-12-03.
* If a file's ctime changes when being archived, report an error.
Previously tar looked at mtime, which missed some errors.
version 1.13.14 - Paul Eggert, 1999-11-07.
* New translations ja, pt_BR.
@@ -403,7 +851,7 @@ version 1.13.6 - Paul Eggert, 1999-08-11.
* The protocol for talking to rmt has been extended slightly.
Open flags are now communicated in symbolic format as well as numeric.
The symbolic format (e.g. "O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC") is for portability
The symbolic format (e.g., "O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC") is for portability
when rmt is operating on a different operating system from tar.
The numeric format is retained, and rmt uses it if symbolic format is absent,
for backward compatibility with older versions of tar and rmt.
@@ -451,7 +899,7 @@ version 1.13.1 - Paul Eggert, 1999-07-12.
version 1.13 - Paul Eggert, 1999-07-08.
* Support for large files, e.g. files larger than 2 GB on many 32-bit hosts.
* Support for large files, e.g., files larger than 2 GB on many 32-bit hosts.
Also, support for larger uids, device ids, etc.
* Many bug fixes and porting fixes.
* This release is only for fixes. A more ambitious test release,
@@ -642,14 +1090,14 @@ Versions 1.07 back to 1.00 by Jay Fenlason.
Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003
Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003,
2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of GNU tar.
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -659,10 +1107,14 @@ GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
Local variables:
mode: outline
paragraph-separate: "[ ]*$"
eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
time-stamp-start: "changes. "
time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d"
time-stamp-end: "\n"
end:

173
PORTS
View File

@@ -1,173 +0,0 @@
Ports of GNU tar and other tars
See the end of file for copying conditions.
* Introduction
Most entries in this file are out of date, unfortunately. Such
entries are marked with an `X'. Run grep '^\*\*[^X]' PORTS to
extract valid entries.
Please write bug-tar@gnu.org if you are aware of various ports of GNU tar
to non-GNU and non-Unix systems not listed here, or for corrections.
Please provide the goal system, a complete and stable URL, the maintainer
name and address, the tar version used as a base, and your comments.
* GNU/Linux and Unix
** Star is a tape archiver similar to tar.
<http://www.fokus.gmd.de/research/cc/glone/employees/joerg.schilling/private/star.html>
* Amiga
**X ftp://ftp.wustl.edu/systems/amiga/aminet/util/arc/GNUtar-1.11.8.lha
maintained by Enrico Forestieri <enrico@com.unipr.it>
Based on tar 1.11.8.
**X ftp://ftp.ninemoons.com/pub/ade/current/amiga-bin/tar-1.11.8-bin.lha
maintained by the ADE group <fnf@fishpond.ninemoons.com>
Based on tar 1.11.8, needs ixemul.library.
**X ftp://ftp.wustl.edu/systems/amiga/aminet/util/arc/gnutar.lha
maintained by <mscheler@wuarchive.wustl.edu>
* DEC alpha (NT)
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
* DEC VAX (VMS)
**X http://www.lp.se/free/vmstar/
maintained by Richard Levitte <levitte@lp.se>
This is not GNU tar, but a separate implementation.
** maintained by William Bader <william@nscs.fast.net>
For V4.7. Based on an old PDtar. Requires compatible shared libraries
to run V5 or V6 executables.
* IBM/PC (DV/X)
**X ftp://qdeck.com/ (?)
maintained by David Ronis <ronis@gibbs.chem.mcgill.ca>
For Desqview/X. Everything works besides compression. Copy of hacked
sources available, some of DV/X's programmer's library also needed.
* IBM/PC (MSDOS)
**X http://www.simtel.net/simtel.net/
http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/platforms/pc/gnuish (Germany)
ftp://ftp.simtel.net/simtelnet/gnu
ftp://ftp.leo.org/pub/comp/platforms/pc/gnuish
maintained by Darrel Hankerson <hankedr@mail.auburn.edu>
You get many GNU tools, not only `tar'. The GNUish project is described
in `gnuish_t.htm'.
** The DJGPP development tools also include some `tar' utilities.
**X ftp://ftp.mcs.com/mcsnet.users/les/dos-gnutar/
maintained by Leslie Mikesell <les@mcs.net>
Based on tar 1.11.2. Support for SCSI (via ASPI) and network (rsh over
packet driver). No support for win95 long file names.
**X ftp://ftp.wu-wien.ac.at/pub/src/PCmisc/aspi-tar/*
maintained by Christoph Splittgerber <chris@orion.sdata.de>
Based on tar 1.10. Support for SCSI (via ASPI).
**X ftp://wuarchive (?)
Several DOS version based on PDtar. John Gilmore <gnu@toad.com> says
he has copies of several vintages saved.
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.exe
ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.taz
ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.14/languages/ada/toolkit/msdos/gtar/gtar.zip
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.4/os2/archiver/tar.zip
Based on PDtar.
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
GNU tar for NT (intel and Alpha platforms).
** ftp://garbo.uwasa.fi/pc/unix/untgz095.zip
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
The `untgz' program is a fast .tar or .tar.gz (.tgz) extractor.
**X http://people.darmstadt.netsurf.de/tst/tar.htm
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
This is not a `tar' port, but an index of them.
* IBM/PC (OS/2)
**X http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/os/os2/leo/gnu/archiver/gtar254.zip
http://www.leo.org/pub/comp/os/os2/leo/gnu/archiver/gtak254.zip
maintained by Andreas Kaiser <Andreas.Kaiser@stuttgart.netsurf.de>
Version 2.54. Based on tar 1.10. The second archive contains SCSI
drivers (DAT streamers notably) and rmt-type programs.
* IBM/PC (Win32: Windows 95, NT 3.5 or NT 4.0)
**X ftp://ftp.cygnus.com:~ftp/pub/sac/win32/usersrc/*
maintained by Cygnus
GNU-Win32 B17.1 distribution. Download all files, `cat' them together,
and `untar' the result. You get many GNU tools, not only `tar'.
Based on tar 1.11.2.
**X ftp://ftp.cdrom.com/.20/windows/archiver/tar.zip
maintained by Drew Bliss & Geoff Voelker
GNU tar for NT (intel and Alpha platforms).
** ftp://garbo.uwasa.fi/pc/unix/untgz095.zip
maintained by Tillmann Steinbrecher <tst@darmstadt.netsurf.de>
The `untgz' program is a fast .tar or .tar.gz (.tgz) extractor.
* IBM/PC (Windows 3.1)
**X ftp://ftp.mcs.com/mcsnet.users/les/win-gnutar/
maintained by Leslie Mikesell <les@mcs.net>
Support for network (rsh over winsock). No support for win95 long
file names.
**X ftp://ftp.gamesdomain.ru/.1/os/windows/programr/tar.zip
Based on GNU tar 1.11.2.
* Macintosh
** Paulo Abreu (paulotex at yahoo dot com) did a
limited port of GNU tar to Darwin, with support for resource forks
and finder info, but this no longer seems to be available.
** There is a tar in Stuffit Expander which is available many places and
comes with MacOS. It creates some spurious files but works on average.
** There is an excellent GNU tar bundled in Tenon MachTen, but it does not
seem to be available separately.
* Copyright notice
Copyright (C) 1999, 2001, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of GNU tar.
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with GNU tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
Local Variables:
mode: outline
paragraph-separate: "[ ]*$"
version-control: never
End:

10
README
View File

@@ -78,7 +78,7 @@ scripts.
** `--disable-largefile' omits support for large files, even if the
operating system supports large files. Typically, large files are
those larger on 2 GB on a 32-bit host.
those larger than 2 GB on a 32-bit host.
* Installation hints
@@ -223,13 +223,13 @@ and share your findings by writing to <bug-tar@gnu.org>.
* Copying
Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1994, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000,
2001, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2001, 2003, 2004, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of GNU tar.
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -239,8 +239,8 @@ and share your findings by writing to <bug-tar@gnu.org>.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
Local Variables:

View File

@@ -5,20 +5,23 @@ Please send comments and problem reports to <bug-tar@gnu.org>.
If you have taken the sources from CVS you will need the following
packages (or later) to build GNU tar. We don't make any extra effort
to accommodate older versions of these packages. If we discover that
newer versions are needed to bootstrap, we'll update the version
numbers in this list.
to accommodate older versions of these packages, so please make sure
that you have the latest stable version.
autoconf 2.59
automake 1.8
bison 1.875
gettext 0.12.1
m4 1.4
wget 1.7
- Automake <http://www.gnu.org/software/automake/>
- Autoconf <http://www.gnu.org/software/autoconf/>
- Bison <http://www.gnu.org/software/bison/>
- Gettext <http://www.gnu.org/software/gettext/>
- Gzip <http://www.gnu.org/software/gzip/>
- M4 <http://www.gnu.org/software/m4/>
- Texinfo <http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo>
- Wget <http://www.gnu.org/software/wget/>
For GNU m4 1.4, we recommend also installing the `translit' patch; see
Debian bug 211477 <http://bugs.debian.org/cgi-bin/bugreport.cgi?bug=211477>.
This patch is bundled into Debian m4 1.4-17 or later.
As of this writing, the latest stable version of Gzip is 1.2.4 but we
suggest using test version 1.3.5 (or later, if one becomes available).
Valgrind <http://valgrind.org/> is also highly recommended, if
Valgrind supports your architecture.
Before building the package, run "bootstrap". It obtains various
additional files from the CVS repository and the Translation Project
@@ -59,13 +62,13 @@ some other value.
Copyright (C) 2001, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Copyright (C) 2001, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of GNU tar.
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -75,6 +78,5 @@ GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.

71
README-hacking Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
These notes intend to help people working on the Git version of
this package.
* Requirements
You need the following packages to build the Git version of GNU
tar. We do not make any efforts to accommodate older versions of
these packages, so please make sure that you have the latest stable
version.
- Automake <http://www.gnu.org/software/automake/>
- Autoconf <http://www.gnu.org/software/autoconf/>
- M4 <http://www.gnu.org/software/m4/>
- Texinfo <http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo>
- Gnulib <http://www.gnu.org/software/gnulib>
- Git <http://git.or.cz>
* Bootstrapping
Obviously, if you are reading these notes, you did manage to clone
tar from Git. The next step is to get other files needed to build,
which are extracted from other source packages:
1. Change to the source tree directory
cd tar
2. Run
./bootstrap
Once done, proceed as described in the file README (section
INSTALLATION).
Normally you will have to run bootstrap only once. However, if you
intend to hack on GNU tar, you might need to run it again later. In
this case, you will probably want to save some time and bandwidth by
avoiding downloading the same files again. If so, create in GNU tar
root directory the file named `.bootstrap' with the following
contents:
--gnulib-srcdir=$HOME/gnulib
Replace `$HOME/gnulib' with the actual directory where the Gnulib
sources reside.
For more information about `bootstrap', run `bootstrap --help'.
* Copyright information
Copyright (C) 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
of this document, or of portions of it,
under the above conditions, provided also that they
carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
^L
Local Variables:
mode: outline
paragraph-separate: "[ ^L]*$"
version-control: never
End:

84
THANKS
View File

@@ -1,11 +1,6 @@
GNU tar THANKS file
Public domain tar was written by John Gilmore, with contributions
from Henry Spencer, Fred Fish, Ian Darwin, Geoff Collyer, Stan Barber,
Guy Harris, Dave Brower, Richard Todd, Michael Rendell, Stu Heiss and
Rich $alz. The FSF version, named GNU tar, was derived from PDTAR by
Jay Fenlason and Joy Kendall, and was maintained in turn by Fran<61>§ois
Pinard and Paul Eggert.
Please see the AUTHORS file for the list of principal authors.
Many people further contributed to GNU tar by reporting problems,
suggesting various improvements or submitting actual code. Here is a
@@ -13,6 +8,7 @@ list of these people. Help me keep it complete and exempt of errors.
See various ChangeLogs for a detailed description of contributions.
Aage Robeck aagero@ifi.uio.no
Adye, TJ (Tim) T.J.Adye@rl.ac.uk
Akiko Matsushita matusita@sra.co.jp
Alan Bawden Alan@lcs.mit.edu
Alan Cox alan@cymru.net
@@ -32,7 +28,7 @@ Andreas Haumer andreas@vlsivie.tuwien.ac.at
Andreas Jaeger aj@arthur.pfalz.de
Andreas Koppenhoefer koppenh@trick.informatik.uni-stuttgart.de
Andreas Reuter ar205@bonzo.geowiss.nat.tu-bs.de
Andreas Schuldei andreas@schuldei.org
Andreas Schuldei andreas@schuldei.org
Andreas Schwab schwab@issan.informatik.uni-dortmund.de
Andrew A. Ivanov ivanov@mics.msu.su
Andrew J. Schorr schorr@ead.dsa.com
@@ -52,6 +48,7 @@ Bela Lubkin filbo@armory.com
Ben A. Mesander ben@piglet.cr.usgs.gov
Benedikt Stockebrand benedikt@devnull.ruhr.de
Bennett Todd bet@mordor.com
Benno Schulenberg benno@nietvergeten.nl
Benny Holmgren benny@hgs.se
Bernard Chen bern@cs.ucla.edu
Bernard Derval derval@iro.umontreal.ca
@@ -62,12 +59,12 @@ Bob Mende Pie mende@piecomputer.rutgers.edu
Bradley A. Smith basmith@prometheus.chem.umn.edu
Brendan Kehoe brendan@cygnus.com
Brett Gaines gaines@saifr00.ateng.az.honeywell.com
Bryan Ford baford@mit.edu
Brian Perkins bperkins@netspace.org
Brian R. Smith brian@cygnus.com
Bruce Evans bde@runx.oz.au
Bruce Jerrick bruce@cse.ogi.edu
Bruno Haible haible@ilog.fr
Bryan Ford baford@mit.edu
Bryant Fujimoto fujimoto@denali.chem.washington.edu
Burkhard Plache plache@krusty.optimax.ns.ca
Calvin Cliff cliff@trifid.astro.ucla.edu
@@ -90,7 +87,7 @@ Chris Metcalf metcalf@catfish.lcs.mit.edu
Chris Ransom chris@quests.com
Christian Callsen Christian.Callsen@eng.sun.com
Christian Kirsch ck@held.mind.de
Christian Laubscher <christian.laubscher@tiscalinet.ch>
Christian Laubscher christian.laubscher@tiscalinet.ch
Christian T. Dum ctd@mpe-garching.mpg.de
Christian von Roques roques@pond.sub.org
Christoph Litauer litauer@mailhost.uni-koblenz.de
@@ -105,9 +102,11 @@ Clinton Carr clint@netcom.com
Conrad Hughes chughes@maths.tcd.ie
Constantin Belous const@cris.net
Coranth Gryphon gryphon@bur.visidyne.com
Cyril Strejc strejc@unicontrols.cz
Dale R. Worley worley@world.std.com
Dale Wiles wiles@geordi.calspan.com
Dan Bloch dan@transarc.com
Dan Drake dan@dandrake.org
Dan Reish dreish@izzy.net
Daniel Hagerty hag@gnu.org
Daniel Quinlan quinlan@pathname.com
@@ -118,6 +117,7 @@ Danny R. Johnston danny@cs.weber.edu
Dave Barr barr@math.psu.edu
Dave Gentzel gentzel@nova.enet.dec.com
Dave Gregorich dtg@ipac.caltech.edu
David Brown davidb@davidb.org
David J. MacKenzie djm@uunet.uu.net
David Johnson David.W.Johnson@colorado.edu
David K. Drum ccdavid@mizzou1.missouri.edu
@@ -147,14 +147,17 @@ Drew Sullivan drew@sni.ca
Drew Trieger trieger@woodstock.abbott.com
Dunstan Vavasour dev@cegelecproj.co.uk
Ed Childs echilds@bgs.com
Ed Leaver ewleaver@comcast.net
Edgar Taube et@immd8.informatik.uni-erlangen.de
Eduardo Kortright eduardo@cs.ua.edu
Eduardo V. de Rivas eddie@asterion.com
Edward Welbourne eddy@gen.cam.ac.uk
Elmar Heeb heeb@itp.ethz.ch
Elmer Fittery elmerf@ptw.com
Enric Hernandez ehernandez@notariado.org
Eric Backus ericb@lsid.hp.com
Eric Benson eb@amazon.com
Eric Blake ebb9@byu.net
Eric M. Boehm Eric.M.Boehm@optimumtech.com
Eric Norum eric@ee.ualberta.ca
Erich Stefan Boleyn erich@uruk.org
@@ -163,9 +166,10 @@ Erik D. Frederick edf@deckard.mc.duke.edu
Esa Karell karell@cs.helsinki.fi
Ezra Peisach epeisach@mit.edu
Fabio d'Alessi cars@civ.bio.unipd.it
Frank Heckenbach frank@g-n-u.de
Frank Koenen koenfr@lidp.com
Franz-Werner Gergen gergen@edvulx.mpi-stuttgart.mpg.de
Fran<EFBFBD>§ois Pinard pinard@iro.umontreal.ca
François Pinard pinard@iro.umontreal.ca
Fritz Elfert fritz@fsun.triltsch.de
George Chyu gschyu@ccgate.dp.beckman.com
Gerben Wierda gerben@rna.indiv.nluug.nl
@@ -179,9 +183,12 @@ Greg Chung gchung@caip.rutgers.edu
Greg Hudson ghudson@mit.edu
Greg Maples greg@clari.net
Greg McGary gkm@cstone.net
G<EFBFBD>¶ran Uddeborg gvran@uddeborg.pp.se
Greg Schafer gschafer@zip.com.au
Göran Uddeborg gvran@uddeborg.pp.se
Gürkan Karaman karaman@dssgmbh.de
Hans Guerth 100664.3101@compuserve.com
Harald K<>¶nig koenig@tat.physik.uni-tuebingen.de
Hansjörg Lipp hjlipp@web.de
Harald König koenig@tat.physik.uni-tuebingen.de
Harald Milz hm@seneca.ix.de
Heiko Schinke mdqac@biochemtech.uni-halle.de
Heiko Schlichting heiko@fu-berlin.de
@@ -195,6 +202,7 @@ Hunyue Yau hunyue.yau@picksys.com
Ian Jackson ijackson@gnu.org
Ian Lance Taylor ian@cygnus.com
Ian T. Zimmerman itz@crl.com
Ian Turner ian@zmanda.com
Indra Singhal indra@synoptics.com
J. Dean Brock brock@cs.unca.edu
J.J. Bailey jjb@jagware.bcc.com
@@ -211,11 +219,14 @@ Jan Djarv jan.djarv@mbox200.swipnet.se
Janice Burton r06a165@bcc25.kodak.com
Janne Snabb snabb@niksula.hut.fi
Jason R. Mastaler jason@webmaster.net
Jason Armistead Jason.Armistead@otis.com
Jay Fenlason hack@gnu.org
Jean-Louis Martineau martineau@zmanda.com
Jean-Michel Soenen soenen@lectra.fr
Jean-Ph. Martin-Flatin syj@ecmwf.int
Jean-loup Gailly jloup@chorus.fr
Jean-Loup Gailly jloup@chorus.fr
Jeff Moskow jeff@rtr.com
Jean-Ph. Martin-Flatin syj@ecmwf.int
Jean-Pierre Demailly Jean-Pierre.Demailly@ujf-grenoble.fr
Jeff Prothero jsp@betz.biostr.washington.edu
Jeff Siegel js@hornet.att.com
Jeff Sorensen sorenj@alumni.rpi.edu
@@ -239,14 +250,16 @@ John David Anglin dave@hiauly1.hia.nrc.ca
John Gilmore gnu@toad.com
John J. Szetela johns@angelo.amd.com
John L. Chmielewski jlc@attmail.com
John L. Males jlmales@yahoo.com
John L. Males jlmales@yahoo.com
John Oleynick juo@klinzhai.rutgers.edu
John R. Vanderpool fish@daacdev1.stx.com
John Rouillard rouilj@cs.umb.edu
John Thomas McDole john.thomas.mcdole@nagra.com
Jon Lewis jlewis@inorganic5.fdt.net
Jonathan I. Kamens jik@cam.ov.com
Jonathan N. Sherman sysjns@etacrs1.safb.af.mil
Jonathan Thornburg thornbur@theory.physics.ubc.ca
Josef Bauer Josef.Bauer@mchp.siemens.de
Joseph E. Sacco jsacco@ssl.com
Joshua R. Poulson jrp@plaza.ds.adp.com
Joutsiniemi Tommi Il tj75064@cs.tut.fi
@@ -254,12 +267,14 @@ Joy Kendall jak8@world.std.com
Judy Ricker jricker@gdstech.grumman.com
Juha Sarlin juha@tds.kth.se
Jurgen Botz jbotz@orixa.mtholyoke.edu
J<EFBFBD>¼rgen L<>¼ters jlueters@t-online.de
J<EFBFBD>¼rgen Reiss reiss@psychologie.uni-wuerzburg.de
Jyh-Shyang Wang erik@vsp.ee.nctu.edu.tw
J<EFBFBD>rg Weule weule@cs.uni-duesseldorf.de
J<EFBFBD>¶rgen H<>¤gg Jorgen.Hagg@axis.se
J<EFBFBD>¶rgen Weigert jw@suse.de
Jörg Schilling schilling@fokus.fraunhofer.de
Jörg Weule weule@cs.uni-duesseldorf.de
Jörg Weilbier gnu@weilbier.net
Jörgen Hågg Jorgen.Hagg@axis.se
Jörgen Weigert jw@suse.de
Jürgen Lüters jlueters@t-online.de
Jürgen Reiss reiss@psychologie.uni-wuerzburg.de
Kai Petzke wpp@marie.physik.tu-berlin.de
Kai Schlichting kai@computel.com
Karl Berry karl@cs.umb.edu
@@ -281,15 +296,16 @@ Konno Hiroharu konno@pac.co.jp
Kurt Jaeger pi@lf.net
Larry Creech lcreech@lonestar.rcclub.org
Larry Schwimmer rosebud@cyclone.stanford.edu
Lasse Collin lasse.collin@tukaani.org
Laurent Caillat-Vallet caillat@noe.lyon.cemagref.fr
Laurent Sainte-Marthe smarthe@genethon.fr
Leland Lucius llucius@tiny.net
Les Mikesell les@mcs.com
Loren J. Rittle rittle@comm.mot.com
Lo<EFBFBD>¯c Prylli Loic.Prylli@lip.ens-lyon.fr
Loïc Prylli Loic.Prylli@lip.ens-lyon.fr
Luke Mewburn lukem@connect.com.au
Mads Martin Joergensen mmj@suse.de
Machael Stone mstone@cs.loyola.edu
Mads Martin Joergensen mmj@suse.de
Manfred Weichel Manfred.Weichel@mch.sni.de
Manuel Munier Manuel.Munier@loria.fr
Marc Boucher marc@cam.org
@@ -305,7 +321,7 @@ Markus Kuhn mskuhn@cip.informatik.uni-erlangen.de
Martin Bellenberg sunsoft@ifm.uni-hamburg.de
Martin Goik goik@HDM-Stuttgart.de
Martin Mares mj@k332.feld.cvut.cz
Martin Simmons ZYHYLCRMZPRP@spammotel.com
Martin Simmons ZYHYLCRMZPRP@spammotel.com
Marty Leisner leisner@eso.mc.xerox.com
Massimo Dal Zotto dz@cs.unitn.it
Mats Lofkvist d87-mal@nada.kth.se
@@ -378,7 +394,10 @@ Pierce Cantrell cantrell@ee.tamu.edu
R. Kent Dybvig dyb@cadence.bloomington.in.us
R. Scott Butler butler@prism.es.dupont.com
Rainer Orth ro@TechFak.Uni-Bielefeld.DE
Ralf Wildenhues Ralf.Wildenhues@gmx.de
Ralf S. Engelschall rse@engelschall.com
Ralf Suckow suckow@contrib.de
Ralph Corderoy ralph@inputplus.co.uk
Ralph Schleicher rs@purple.ul.bawue.de
Randy Bias randyb@edge.edge.net
Ray Dassen jdassen@wi.leidenuniv.nl
@@ -412,15 +431,15 @@ Rodney Brown RBrown@cocam.com.au
Roland McGrath roland@gnu.org
Roland Schemers III schemers@vela.acs.oakland.edu
Rolf Niepraschk niepraschk@chbrb.berlin.ptb.de
Roman Gollent roman@portal.stwing.upenn.edu
Roman Czyborra czyborra@cs.tu-berlin.de
Roman Gollent roman@portal.stwing.upenn.edu
Ron Guilmette rfg@netcom.com
Roy Marantz marantz@nbcs.rutgers.edu
Russ Evans e_gs18@ub.nmh.ac.uk
Russell Cattelan cattelan@thebarn.com
Ryutaro Susukita susukita@pn.scphys.kyoto-u.ac.jp
Sam Richards sam@blueskyprod.com
Sakai Kiyotaka ksakai@netwk.ntt-at.co.jp
Sam Richards sam@blueskyprod.com
Santiago Vila Doncel sanvila@unex.es
Sarah Quady squady@warp10.keck.hawaii.edu
Saul Lubkin lubkin@cs.rochester.edu
@@ -433,9 +452,9 @@ Serge Granik serge@euler.berkeley.edu
Seth Robertson seth@ctr.columbia.edu
Sherwood Botsford sherwood@space.ualberta.ca
Simon Wright simon.j.wright@gecm.com
Simon Wright simon@pogner.demon.co.uk
Sisira Jayasinghe sisira.jayasinghe@sdrc.com
Skip Montanaro skip@mojam.com http://www.musi-cal.com/~skip/
Simon Wright simon@pogner.demon.co.uk
Solar Designer solar@openwall.com
Stefan Skoglund sp2stes1@ida.his.se
Steffen Stempel stempel@ira.uka.de
@@ -449,9 +468,10 @@ Sylvain Rougier un@grolier.fr
Tarang Kumar Patel mombasa@ptolemy.arc.nasa.gov
Ted Rule Ted_Rule@flextech.co.uk
The King elvis@gnu.org
Thomas metaf4@users.askja.de
Thomas Bushnell n/BSG thomas@gnu.org
Thomas K<>¶nig Thomas.Koenig@ciw.uni-karlsruhe.de
Thomas Krebs krebs@faps.uni-erlangen.de
Thomas König Thomas.Koenig@ciw.uni-karlsruhe.de
Thomas M. Browder Jr. browder@use1.eglin.af.mil
Thomas Priesner priesner@flo.sh.bosch.de
Thomas Waas waas@echild.aiss.de
@@ -464,9 +484,10 @@ Tim P. Starrin noid@cyborg.larc.nasa.gov
Tim Ramsey tar@ksu.ksu.edu
Tim Rylance tkr@puffball.demon.co.uk
Tim Towers tzt@uniplex.co.uk
Timothy J. Lee timlee@netcom.com
Timothy Fossum fossum@cs.uwp.edu
Timothy J. Lee timlee@netcom.com
Tito Flagella tito@di.unipi.it
Todd Vierling tv@duh.org
Tom Popovitch tpop@informix.com
Tom Quinn trq@astro.washington.edu
Tom Tromey tromey@drip.colorado.edu
@@ -491,16 +512,17 @@ Werner Almesberger werner.almesberger@lrc.di.epfl.ch
William Bader william@nscs.fast.net
William J. Eaton wje@hoffman.rstnu.bcm.tmc.edu
William Kucharski kucharsk@netcom.com
Włodzimierz Jan Martin wjm@pg.gda.pl
Wojciech Polak polak@gnu.org
Wolfgang Rupprecht wolfgang@wsrcc.com
Wolfram Gloger Wolfram.Gloger@dent.med.uni-muenchen.de
Wolfram Kleff bugreport@wkleff.intergenia.de
Wolfram Wagner ww@mpi-sb.mpg.de
Włodzimierz Jan Martin wjm@pg.gda.pl
Yasushi Suzudo SGR00413@niftyserve.or.jp
Yu-Min Liang min@taz.ho.att.com
;;;; Local variables:
;;;; Local Variables:
;;;; mode: Fundamental
;;;; buffer-file-coding-system: utf-8
;;;; coding: utf-8
;;;; End:

26
TODO
View File

@@ -1,5 +1,7 @@
Suggestions for improving GNU tar.
* <45BEC0DB.8040903@unix-beratung.de>
* Incorporate fixes from major distributions, e.g., Debian GNU/Linux.
* Add support for restoring file time stamps to sub-second resolution,
@@ -10,25 +12,9 @@ Suggestions for improving GNU tar.
* --append should bail out if the two archives are of different types.
* Add support for GNU private keywords in POSIX 1003.1-2001 headers,
so that the GNU extensions (--incremental, --label and
--multi-volume) may be used with POSIX archives.
* Add support for a 'pax' command that conforms to POSIX 1003.1-2001.
This would unify paxutils with tar.
* Remove command-line incompatibilities between GNU tar and UNIX tar
as specified by UNIX98. The main problem is:
l GNU tar doesn't cross filesystem boundaries.
UNIX98 tar warns if all links cannot be resolved.
(GNU tar --check-links option)
Currently tar prints a warning when this option is used. Sometime
in the future its semantics will be changed to that of --check-links.
In the meanwhile we should announce a phase-in period where "l"
changes in semantics.
* Interoperate better with Joerg Schilling's star implementation.
* Add an option to remove files that compare successfully.
@@ -59,13 +45,13 @@ so that the GNU extensions (--incremental, --label and
* Copyright notice
Copyright (C) 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Copyright (C) 2003, 2004, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of GNU tar.
GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -75,8 +61,8 @@ so that the GNU extensions (--incremental, --label and
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with tar; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
Local variables:

View File

@@ -1,88 +0,0 @@
/* Special definitions for GNU tar, processed by autoheader.
Copyright <20> 1994, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Fran<61>ois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1993.
*/
/* This is unconditionally defined for setting a GNU environment. */
#undef _GNU_SOURCE
/* Define to a string giving the full name of the default archive file. */
#undef DEFAULT_ARCHIVE
/* Define to a number giving the default blocking size for archives. */
#undef DEFAULT_BLOCKING
/* Define to 1 if density may be indicated by [lmh] at end of device. */
#undef DENSITY_LETTER
/* Define to a string giving the prefix of the default device, without the
part specifying the unit and density. */
#undef DEVICE_PREFIX
/* Define to 1 if you lack a 3-argument version of open, and want to
emulate it with system calls you do have. */
#undef EMUL_OPEN3
/* Define to 1 if NLS is requested. */
#undef ENABLE_NLS
/* Define as 1 if you have catgets and don't want to use GNU gettext. */
#undef HAVE_CATGETS
/* Define to 1 if you have getgrgid(3). */
#undef HAVE_GETGRGID
/* Define to 1 if you have getpwuid(3). */
#undef HAVE_GETPWUID
/* Define as 1 if you have gettext and don't want to use GNU gettext. */
#undef HAVE_GETTEXT
/* Define if your locale.h file contains LC_MESSAGES. */
#undef HAVE_LC_MESSAGES
/* Define to 1 if you have the valloc function. */
#undef HAVE_VALLOC
/* Define to 1 if some rsh exists, or if you have <netdb.h>. */
#undef HAVE_RTAPELIB
/* Define to 1 if mknod function is available. */
#undef HAVE_MKNOD
/* Define to 1 if stpcpy function is available. */
#undef HAVE_STPCPY
/* Define if `union wait' is the type of the first arg to wait functions. */
#undef HAVE_UNION_WAIT
/* Define to 1 if utime.h exists and declares struct utimbuf. */
#undef HAVE_UTIME_H
/* Define to mt_model (v.g., for DG/UX), else to mt_type. */
#undef MTIO_CHECK_FIELD
/* Define to the name of the distribution. */
#undef PACKAGE
/* Define to 1 if ANSI function prototypes are usable. */
#undef PROTOTYPES
/* Define to the full path of your rsh, if any. */
#undef REMOTE_SHELL
/* Path to directory containing system wide message catalog sources. */
#undef STD_INC_PATH
/* Define to the version of the distribution. */
#undef VERSION
/* Define to 1 if using the `glocale' package for message catalogs. */
#undef WITH_CATALOGS
/* Define to 1 for better use of the debugging malloc library. See
site ftp.antaire.com in antaire/src, file dmalloc/dmalloc.tar.gz. */
#undef WITH_DMALLOC
/* Define to 1 if GNU regex should be used instead of GNU rx. */
#undef WITH_REGEX

View File

@@ -1,425 +0,0 @@
## ----------------------------------------- ##
## Find how to suppress newlines with echo. ##
## ----------------------------------------- ##
# Once this macro is called, you may output with no echo in a Makefile or
# script using: echo @ECHO_N@ "STRING_TO_OUTPUT@ECHO_C@".
AC_DEFUN(fp_PROG_ECHO,
[AC_MSG_CHECKING(how to suppress newlines using echo)
AC_CACHE_VAL(fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl,
[if (echo "testing\c"; echo 1,2,3) | grep c >/dev/null; then
if (echo -n testing; echo 1,2,3) | sed s/-n/xn/ | grep xn >/dev/null; then
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=no
else
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=option
fi
else
fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl=escape
fi
])
AC_MSG_RESULT($fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl)
case $fp_cv_prog_echo_nonl in
no) ECHO_N= ECHO_C= ;;
option) ECHO_N=-n ECHO_C= ;;
escape) ECHO_N= ECHO_C='\c' ;;
esac
AC_SUBST(ECHO_N)dnl
AC_SUBST(ECHO_C)dnl
])
## ------------------------------------------- ##
## Check if --with-included-malloc was given. ##
## From Franc,ois Pinard ##
## ------------------------------------------- ##
# In 1992, Michael Bushnell (now Thomas Bushnell <thomas@gnu.ai.mit.edu>)
# devised a test for avoiding HP/UX malloc and using GNU malloc instead.
# Bruno Haible <haible@ma2s2.mathematik.uni-karlsruhe.de> recycled this
# test for CLISP Common LISP and extended it to cover broken mallocs from
# Sun and SGI. I (<pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>) reworked it a little so
# it is independent of config.guess, and overridable by the installer.
# On IRIX 5.2, libc malloc is broken, but the -lmalloc one was usable.
# So in my packages, I once unconditionally used -lmalloc if it existed.
# This does not do anymore, because the -lmalloc malloc is broken on
# Solaris 2.4 to 2.5.1 (alignment is 4 bytes instead of 8 bytes, as
# reported by John Wells <john@bitsmart.com>).
# Bruno also notes: "HP-UX has two different malloc() implementations.
# Both are broken. When used with CLISP, the one in the default libc.a
# leads to a SIGSEGV, the one in libmalloc.a leads to a SIGBUS. The SunOS
# 4.1.1 malloc() breaks when used by CLISP's generational GC. The IRIX
# 5.2 malloc() breaks when used by CLISP's generational GC."
# If the installer does not give a preference, we use the included GNU
# malloc if we have the slightest doubt that malloc could be broken, this
# includes cross compilation, and *all* HP/UX, SunOS or IRIX systems.
# It is crude indeed, but I just do not have enough information for truly
# benchmarking malloc in all cases, but want safe packages nevertheless.
AC_DEFUN(fp_WITH_INCLUDED_MALLOC,
[AC_MSG_CHECKING(if included GNU malloc is wanted)
AC_ARG_WITH(included-malloc,
[ --with-included-malloc use the GNU malloc which is included here], ,
[if test $cross_compiling = yes; then
withval=yes
else
case `uname -s 2> /dev/null` in
HP-UX | SunOS | IRIX* ) withval=yes ;;
*) withval=no ;;
esac
fi])
test "$withval" = yes && LIBOBJS="$LIBOBJS gmalloc.o"
AC_MSG_RESULT($withval)
])
## -------------------- ##
## Macros from Ulrich. ##
## -------------------- ##
# Search path for a program which passes the given test.
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
# serial 1
dnl AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(VARIABLE, PROG-TO-CHECK-FOR,
dnl TEST-PERFORMED-ON-FOUND_PROGRAM [, VALUE-IF-NOT-FOUND [, PATH]])
AC_DEFUN(AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST,
[# Extract the first word of "$2", so it can be a program name with args.
set dummy $2; ac_word=[$]2
AC_MSG_CHECKING([for $ac_word])
AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_path_$1,
[case "[$]$1" in
/*)
ac_cv_path_$1="[$]$1" # Let the user override the test with a path.
;;
*)
IFS="${IFS= }"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}:"
for ac_dir in ifelse([$5], , $PATH, [$5]); do
test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
if test -f $ac_dir/$ac_word; then
if [$3]; then
ac_cv_path_$1="$ac_dir/$ac_word"
break
fi
fi
done
IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
dnl If no 4th arg is given, leave the cache variable unset,
dnl so AC_PATH_PROGS will keep looking.
ifelse([$4], , , [ test -z "[$]ac_cv_path_$1" && ac_cv_path_$1="$4"
])dnl
;;
esac])dnl
$1="$ac_cv_path_$1"
if test -n "[$]$1"; then
AC_MSG_RESULT([$]$1)
else
AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
fi
AC_SUBST($1)dnl
])
# Check whether LC_MESSAGES is available in <locale.h>.
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
# serial 1
AC_DEFUN(AM_LC_MESSAGES,
[if test $ac_cv_header_locale_h = yes; then
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for LC_MESSAGES], am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES,
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <locale.h>], [return LC_MESSAGES],
am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=yes, am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=no)])
if test $am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES = yes; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LC_MESSAGES)
fi
fi])
# Macro to add for using GNU gettext.
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
# serial 1
AC_DEFUN(AM_WITH_NLS,
[AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether NLS is requested])
dnl Default is enabled NLS
AC_ARG_ENABLE(nls,
[ --disable-nls do not use Native Language Support],
USE_NLS=$enableval, USE_NLS=yes)
AC_MSG_RESULT($USE_NLS)
AC_SUBST(USE_NLS)
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
dnl If we use NLS figure out what method
if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
AC_DEFINE(ENABLE_NLS)
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether included gettext is requested])
AC_ARG_WITH(included-gettext,
[ --with-included-gettext use the GNU gettext library included here],
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=$withval,
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=no)
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext)
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext="$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext"
if test "$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext" != "yes"; then
dnl User does not insist on using GNU NLS library. Figure out what
dnl to use. If gettext or catgets are available (in this order) we
dnl use this. Else we have to fall back to GNU NLS library.
dnl catgets is only used if permitted by option --with-catgets.
nls_cv_header_intl=
nls_cv_header_libgt=
CATOBJEXT=NONE
AC_CHECK_HEADER(libintl.h,
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for gettext in libc], gt_cv_func_gettext_libc,
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>], [return (int) gettext ("")],
gt_cv_func_gettext_libc=yes, gt_cv_func_gettext_libc=no)])
if test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libc" != "yes"; then
AC_CHECK_LIB(intl, bindtextdomain,
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for gettext in libintl],
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl,
[AC_TRY_LINK([], [return (int) gettext ("")],
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl=yes,
gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl=no)])])
fi
if test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libc" = "yes" \
|| test "$gt_cv_func_gettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETTEXT)
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], no)dnl
if test "$MSGFMT" != "no"; then
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(dcgettext)
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
AC_TRY_LINK(, [extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
return _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
[CATOBJEXT=.gmo
DATADIRNAME=share],
[CATOBJEXT=.mo
DATADIRNAME=lib])
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
fi
fi
])
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether catgets can be used])
AC_ARG_WITH(catgets,
[ --with-catgets use catgets functions if available],
nls_cv_use_catgets=$withval, nls_cv_use_catgets=no)
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_use_catgets)
if test "$nls_cv_use_catgets" = "yes"; then
dnl No gettext in C library. Try catgets next.
AC_CHECK_LIB(i, main)
AC_CHECK_FUNC(catgets,
[AC_DEFINE(HAVE_CATGETS)
INTLOBJS="\$(CATOBJS)"
AC_PATH_PROG(GENCAT, gencat, no)dnl
if test "$GENCAT" != "no"; then
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, no)
if test "$GMSGFMT" = "no"; then
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(GMSGFMT, msgfmt,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], no)
fi
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
CATOBJEXT=.cat
INSTOBJEXT=.cat
DATADIRNAME=lib
INTLDEPS="../intl/libintl.a"
INTLLIBS=$INTLDEPS
LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed -e 's/-lintl//'`
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
fi])
fi
fi
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
dnl Neither gettext nor catgets in included in the C library.
dnl Fall back on GNU gettext library.
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext=yes
fi
fi
if test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
dnl Mark actions used to generate GNU NLS library.
INTLOBJS="\$(GETTOBJS)"
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep 'dv '`"], msgfmt)
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
[test -z "`$ac_dir/$ac_word -h 2>&1 | grep '(HELP)'`"], :)
AC_SUBST(MSGFMT)
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
DATADIRNAME=share
INTLDEPS="../intl/libintl.a"
INTLLIBS=$INTLDEPS
LIBS=`echo $LIBS | sed -e 's/-lintl//'`
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
fi
dnl Test whether we really found GNU xgettext.
if test "$XGETTEXT" != ":"; then
dnl If it is no GNU xgettext we define it as : so that the
dnl Makefiles still can work.
if $XGETTEXT --omit-header /dev/null 2> /dev/null; then
: ;
else
AC_MSG_RESULT(
[found xgettext programs is not GNU xgettext; ignore it])
XGETTEXT=":"
fi
fi
# We need to process the po/ directory.
POSUB=po
else
DATADIRNAME=share
nls_cv_header_intl=intl/libintl.h
nls_cv_header_libgt=intl/libgettext.h
fi
# If this is used in GNU gettext we have to set USE_NLS to `yes'
# because some of the sources are only built for this goal.
if test "$PACKAGE" = gettext; then
USE_NLS=yes
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
fi
dnl These rules are solely for the distribution goal. While doing this
dnl we only have to keep exactly one list of the available catalogs
dnl in configure.in.
for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $lang.gmo"
POFILES="$POFILES $lang.po"
done
dnl Make all variables we use known to autoconf.
AC_SUBST(USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
AC_SUBST(CATALOGS)
AC_SUBST(CATOBJEXT)
AC_SUBST(DATADIRNAME)
AC_SUBST(GMOFILES)
AC_SUBST(INSTOBJEXT)
AC_SUBST(INTLDEPS)
AC_SUBST(INTLLIBS)
AC_SUBST(INTLOBJS)
AC_SUBST(POFILES)
AC_SUBST(POSUB)
])
AC_DEFUN(AM_GNU_GETTEXT,
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_MAKE_SET])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_ISC_POSIX])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_HEADER_STDC])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_CONST])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_INLINE])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_OFF_T])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_SIZE_T])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_ALLOCA])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_MMAP])dnl
AC_CHECK_HEADERS([argz.h limits.h locale.h nl_types.h malloc.h string.h \
unistd.h values.h])
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([getcwd munmap putenv setenv setlocale strchr strcasecmp \
__argz_count __argz_stringify __argz_next])
if test "${ac_cv_func_stpcpy+set}" != "set"; then
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(stpcpy)
fi
if test "${ac_cv_func_stpcpy}" = "yes"; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_STPCPY)
fi
AM_LC_MESSAGES
AM_WITH_NLS
if test "x$CATOBJEXT" != "x"; then
if test "x$ALL_LINGUAS" = "x"; then
LINGUAS=
else
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for catalogs to be installed)
NEW_LINGUAS=
for lang in ${LINGUAS=$ALL_LINGUAS}; do
case "$ALL_LINGUAS" in
*$lang*) NEW_LINGUAS="$NEW_LINGUAS $lang" ;;
esac
done
LINGUAS=$NEW_LINGUAS
AC_MSG_RESULT($LINGUAS)
fi
dnl Construct list of names of catalog files to be constructed.
if test -n "$LINGUAS"; then
for lang in $LINGUAS; do CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang$CATOBJEXT"; done
fi
fi
dnl Determine which catalog format we have (if any is needed)
dnl For now we know about two different formats:
dnl Linux libc-5 and the normal X/Open format
test -d intl || mkdir intl
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = ".cat"; then
AC_CHECK_HEADER(linux/version.h, msgformat=linux, msgformat=xopen)
dnl Transform the SED scripts while copying because some dumb SEDs
dnl cannot handle comments.
sed -e '/^#/d' $srcdir/intl/$msgformat-msg.sed > intl/po2msg.sed
fi
dnl po2tbl.sed is always needed.
sed -e '/^#.*[^\\]$/d' -e '/^#$/d' \
$srcdir/intl/po2tbl.sed.in > intl/po2tbl.sed
dnl In the intl/Makefile.in we have a special dependency which makes
dnl only sense for gettext. We comment this out for non-gettext
dnl packages.
if test "$PACKAGE" = "gettext"; then
GT_NO="#NO#"
GT_YES=
else
GT_NO=
GT_YES="#YES#"
fi
AC_SUBST(GT_NO)
AC_SUBST(GT_YES)
dnl If the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR macro for autoconf is used we possibly
dnl find the mkinstalldirs script in another subdir but ($top_srcdir).
dnl Try to locate is.
MKINSTALLDIRS=
if test $ac_aux_dir; then
MKINSTALLDIRS="$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs"
fi
if test -z $MKINSTALLDIRS; then
MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs"
fi
AC_SUBST(MKINSTALLDIRS)
dnl Generate list of files to be processed by xgettext which will
dnl be included in po/Makefile.
test -d po || mkdir po
if test "x$srcdir" != "x."; then
if test "x`echo $srcdir | sed 's@/.*@@'`" = "x"; then
posrcprefix="$srcdir/"
else
posrcprefix="../$srcdir/"
fi
else
posrcprefix="../"
fi
sed -e "/^#/d" -e "/^\$/d" -e "s,.*, $posrcprefix& \\\\," -e "\$s/\(.*\) \\\\/\1/" \
< $srcdir/po/POTFILES.in > po/POTFILES
])

887
bootstrap
View File

@@ -1,13 +1,13 @@
#! /bin/sh
# Bootstrap 'tar' from CVS.
# Bootstrap this package from checked-out sources.
# Copyright (C) 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Copyright (C) 2003-2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# This program is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
@@ -15,73 +15,160 @@
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
# 02111-1307, USA.
# along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
# Written by Paul Eggert and Sergey Poznyakoff.
# URL of our text domain page in Translation Project
TP_URL="http://www2.iro.umontreal.ca/~gnutra/po/maint/tar/"
nl='
'
# Ensure file names are sorted consistently across platforms;
# e.g., m4/ulonglong_gl.m4 should follow m4/ulonglong.m4.
# Ensure file names are sorted consistently across platforms.
LC_ALL=C
export LC_ALL
local_gl_dir=gl
# Temporary directory names.
bt='._bootmp'
bt_regex=`echo "$bt"| sed 's/\./[.]/g'`
bt2=${bt}2
usage() {
cat <<EOF
usage: $0 [--gnulib-srcdir=DIR][--paxutils-srcdir=DIR][--cvs-auth=AUTH-METHOD][--cvs-user=USERNAME][--no-po]
Options are:
--paxutils-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where paxutils
sources reside. Use this if you already
have paxutils sources on your machine, and
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
them again.
--gnulib-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where gnulib
sources reside. Use this if you already
have gnulib sources on your machine, and
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
them again.
--cvs-auth=METHOD Set the CVS access method used for downloading
gnulib files. METHOD is one of the keywords
accepted by cvs -d option (see info cvs
repository).
--cvs-user=USERNAME Set the CVS username to be used when accessing
the gnulib repository.
--no-po Do not download po files.
--update-po[=LANG] Update po file(s) and exit.
Running without arguments will suffice in most cases. It is equivalent
to
echo >&2 "\
Usage: $0 [OPTION]...
Bootstrap this package from the checked-out sources.
./bootstrap --cvs-auth=ext --cvs-user=anoncvs
Options:
--paxutils-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where paxutils
sources reside. Use this if you already
have paxutils sources on your machine, and
do not want to waste your bandwidth dowloading
them again.
--gnulib-srcdir=DIRNAME Specify the local directory where gnulib
sources reside. Use this if you already
have gnulib sources on your machine, and
do not want to waste your bandwidth downloading
them again.
--copy Copy files instead of creating symbolic links.
--force Attempt to bootstrap even if the sources seem
not to have been checked out.
--skip-po Do not download po files.
EOF
If the file $0.conf exists in the same directory as this script, its
contents are read as shell variables to configure the bootstrap.
Running without arguments will suffice in most cases.
"
}
update_po() {
if [ $# = 1 ]; then
case $1 in
*.po) POFILE=$1;;
*) POFILE=${1}.po;;
esac
echo "$0: getting translation for $1..."
wget -r -C off $TP_URL/$POFILE
else
echo "$0: getting translations into po..."
(cd po &&
rm -f dummy `ls | sed -n '/\.gmo$/p; /\.po/p'` &&
wget -nv -nd -r -l 1 -A .po -C off $TP_URL &&
rm -f index.html index.html.[0-9]*
ls *.po | sed 's/\.po$//' >LINGUAS
) || exit
fi
}
# Configuration.
# Name of the Makefile.am
gnulib_mk=gnulib.mk
# List of gnulib modules needed.
gnulib_modules=
# Any gnulib files needed that are not in modules.
gnulib_files=
# The command to download all .po files for a specified domain into
# a specified directory. Fill in the first %s is the domain name, and
# the second with the destination directory. Use rsync's -L and -r
# options because the latest/%s directory and the .po files within are
# all symlinks.
po_download_command_format=\
"rsync -Lrtvz 'translationproject.org::tp/latest/%s/' '%s'"
extract_package_name='
/^AC_INIT(/{
/.*,.*,.*, */{
s///
s/[][]//g
s/)$//
p
q
}
s/AC_INIT(\[*//
s/]*,.*//
s/^GNU //
y/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/
s/[^A-Za-z0-9_]/-/g
p
}
'
package=`sed -n "$extract_package_name" configure.ac` || exit
gnulib_name=lib$package
build_aux=build-aux
source_base=lib
m4_base=m4
doc_base=doc
tests_base=tests
# Extra files from gnulib, which override files from other sources.
gnulib_extra_files="
$build_aux/install-sh
$build_aux/missing
$build_aux/mdate-sh
$build_aux/texinfo.tex
$build_aux/depcomp
$build_aux/config.guess
$build_aux/config.sub
doc/INSTALL
"
# Additional gnulib-tool options to use. Use "\newline" to break lines.
gnulib_tool_option_extras=
# Other locale categories that need message catalogs.
EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES=
# Additional xgettext options to use. Use "\\\newline" to break lines.
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS='\\\
--flag=_:1:pass-c-format\\\
--flag=N_:1:pass-c-format\\\
--flag=error:3:c-format --flag=error_at_line:5:c-format\\\
'
# Package bug report address for gettext files
MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS=bug-$package@gnu.org
# Files we don't want to import.
excluded_files=
# File that should exist in the top directory of a checked out hierarchy,
# but not in a distribution tarball.
checkout_only_file=README-hacking
# Whether to use copies instead of symlinks.
copy=false
# Set this to '.cvsignore .gitignore' in bootstrap.conf if you want
# those files to be generated in directories like lib/, m4/, and po/.
# Or set it to 'auto' to make this script select which to use based
# on which version control system (if any) is used in the source directory.
vc_ignore=auto
# Override the default configuration, if necessary.
# Make sure that bootstrap.conf is sourced from the current directory
# if we were invoked as "sh bootstrap".
case "$0" in
*/*) test -r "$0.conf" && . "$0.conf" ;;
*) test -r "$0.conf" && . ./"$0.conf" ;;
esac
if test "$vc_ignore" = auto; then
vc_ignore=
test -d .git && vc_ignore=.gitignore
test -d CVS && vc_ignore="$vc_ignore .cvsignore"
fi
# Translate configuration into internal form.
# Parse options.
DOWNLOAD_PO=yes
for option
do
case $option in
@@ -89,201 +176,446 @@ do
usage
exit;;
--gnulib-srcdir=*)
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`expr "$option" : '--gnulib-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`expr "X$option" : 'X--gnulib-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
--paxutils-srcdir=*)
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=`expr "$option" : '--paxutils-srcdir=\(.*\)'`;;
--cvs-auth=*)
CVS_AUTH=`expr "$option" : '--cvs-auth=\(.*\)'`;;
--cvs-user=*)
CVS_USER=`expr "$option" : '--cvs-user=\(.*\)'`;;
--no-po)
DOWNLOAD_PO=no;;
--update-po=*)
DOWNLOAD_PO=`expr "$option" : '--update-po=\(.*\)'`;;
--update-po)
DOWNLOAD_PO=only;;
--skip-po)
SKIP_PO=t;;
--force)
checkout_only_file=;;
--copy)
copy=true;;
*)
echo >&2 "$0: $option: unknown option"
exit 1;;
esac
done
case $DOWNLOAD_PO in
only) update_po
exit 0
;;
no|yes) ;;
*) update_po $DOWNLOAD_PO
exit 0
if test -n "$checkout_only_file" && test ! -r "$checkout_only_file"; then
echo "$0: Bootstrapping from a non-checked-out distribution is risky." >&2
exit 1
fi
# If $STR is not already on a line by itself in $FILE, insert it,
# sorting the new contents of the file and replacing $FILE with the result.
insert_sorted_if_absent() {
file=$1
str=$2
test -f $file || touch $file
echo "$str" | sort -u - $file | cmp -s - $file \
|| echo "$str" | sort -u - $file -o $file \
|| exit 1
}
# Die if there is no AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR($build_aux) line in configure.ac.
found_aux_dir=no
grep '^[ ]*AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR(\['"$build_aux"'\])' configure.ac \
>/dev/null && found_aux_dir=yes
grep '^[ ]*AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR('"$build_aux"')' configure.ac \
>/dev/null && found_aux_dir=yes
if test $found_aux_dir = no; then
echo "$0: expected line not found in configure.ac. Add the following:" >&2
echo " AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR([$build_aux])" >&2
exit 1
fi
# If $build_aux doesn't exist, create it now, otherwise some bits
# below will malfunction. If creating it, also mark it as ignored.
if test ! -d $build_aux; then
mkdir $build_aux
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
test $dot_ig = x && continue
insert_sorted_if_absent $dot_ig $build_aux
done
fi
echo "$0: Bootstrapping from checked-out $package sources..."
# See if we can use gnulib's git-merge-changelog merge driver.
if test -d .git && (git --version) >/dev/null 2>/dev/null ; then
if git config merge.merge-changelog.driver >/dev/null ; then
:
elif (git-merge-changelog --version) >/dev/null 2>/dev/null ; then
echo "initializing git-merge-changelog driver"
git config merge.merge-changelog.name 'GNU-style ChangeLog merge driver'
git config merge.merge-changelog.driver 'git-merge-changelog %O %A %B'
else
echo "consider installing git-merge-changelog from gnulib"
fi
fi
cleanup() {
status=$?
rm -fr $1
exit $status
}
git_modules_config () {
GIT_CONFIG_LOCAL=.gitmodules git config "$@"
}
# Get paxutils files.
case ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR--} in
-) if [ ! -d paxutils ]; then
echo "$0: getting paxutils files..."
trap "cleanup paxutils" 1 2 13 15
git clone --depth 1 git://git.sv.gnu.org/paxutils || cleanup paxutils
trap - 1 2 13 15
fi
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=paxutils
;;
esac
echo "$0: Bootstrapping CVS tar..."
build_cvs_prefix() {
CVS_PREFIX=:${1}:
if [ "${2}" != - ]; then
CVS_PREFIX=${CVS_PREFIX}${2}@
fi
if [ "$1" = "ext" ]; then
if [ -z "${CVS_RSH}" ]; then
CVS_RSH=ssh
export CVS_RSH
fi
fi
}
# checkout package
checkout() {
if [ ! -d $1 ]; then
echo "$0: getting $1 files..."
trap exit 1 2 13 15
trap 'rm -fr $1; exit 1' 0
case "${CVS_AUTH--}" in
-) build_cvs_prefix ext anoncvs
;;
pserver) build_cvs_prefix $CVS_AUTH ${CVS_USER:-anoncvs}
;;
gserver|server)
build_cvs_prefix $CVS_AUTH ${CVS_USER--}
;;
ext) build_cvs_prefix $CVS_AUTH ${CVS_USER--}
;;
*) echo "$0: Unknown CVS access method" >&2
exit 1;;
esac
if [ "${CVS_AUTH--}" = "pserver" ]; then
cvs -d ${CVS_PREFIX}subversions.gnu.org:/cvsroot/$1 login || exit
fi
cvs -q -d ${CVS_PREFIX}subversions.gnu.org:/cvsroot/$1 co $1 || exit
trap 0
fi
}
if [ -r $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules ]; then
gnulib_modules=`
(echo "$gnulib_modules"; grep '^[^#]' $PAXUTILS_SRCDIR/gnulib.modules) |
sort -u
`
fi
# Get gnulib files.
case ${GNULIB_SRCDIR--} in
-) checkout gnulib
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
-)
if git_modules_config submodule.gnulib.url >/dev/null; then
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
git submodule init || exit $?
git submodule update || exit $?
elif [ ! -d gnulib ]; then
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
trap cleanup_gnulib 1 2 13 15
git clone --help|grep depth > /dev/null && shallow='--depth 2' || shallow=
git clone $shallow git://git.sv.gnu.org/gnulib ||
"cleanup $1"
trap - 1 2 13 15
fi
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
;;
*)
# Redirect the gnulib submodule to the directory on the command line
# if possible.
if test -d "$GNULIB_SRCDIR"/.git && \
git_modules_config submodule.gnulib.url >/dev/null; then
git submodule init
GNULIB_SRCDIR=`cd $GNULIB_SRCDIR && pwd`
git config --replace-all submodule.gnulib.url $GNULIB_SRCDIR
echo "$0: getting gnulib files..."
git submodule update || exit $?
GNULIB_SRCDIR=gnulib
fi
;;
esac
<$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool || exit
gnulib_tool=$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool
<$gnulib_tool || exit
gnulib_modules='
alloca
argmatch
argp
backupfile
dirname
error
exclude
fileblocks
fnmatch-gnu
ftruncate
full-write
getdate
getline
getopt
getpagesize
gettext
gettime
hash
human
lchown
localcharset
memset
modechange
obstack
quote
quotearg
rmdir
safe-read
save-cwd
savedir
stdbool
stpcpy
strtol
strtoul
timespec
unlocked-io
utime
xalloc
xalloc-die
xgetcwd
xstrtoumax
'
# Get translations.
previous_gnulib_modules=
while [ "$gnulib_modules" != "$previous_gnulib_modules" ]; do
previous_gnulib_modules=$gnulib_modules
# In gnulib `alloca-opt' duplicates `alloca', so make sure not
# to use it.
gnulib_modules=`
(echo "$gnulib_modules"
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-dependencies $gnulib_module
done) | sed 's/alloca-opt/alloca/' | sort -u
`
done
download_po_files() {
subdir=$1
domain=$2
echo "$0: getting translations into $subdir for $domain..."
cmd=`printf "$po_download_command_format" "$domain" "$subdir"`
eval "$cmd"
}
gnulib_files=`
(for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-filelist $gnulib_module
done) | sort -u
`
# Download .po files to $po_dir/.reference and copy only the new
# or modified ones into $po_dir. Also update $po_dir/LINGUAS.
update_po_files() {
# Directory containing primary .po files.
# Overwrite them only when we're sure a .po file is new.
po_dir=$1
domain=$2
gnulib_dirs=`echo "$gnulib_files" | sed 's,/[^/]*$,,' | sort -u`
mkdir -p $gnulib_dirs || exit
# Download *.po files into this dir.
# Usually contains *.s1 checksum files.
ref_po_dir="$po_dir/.reference"
for gnulib_file in $gnulib_files; do
dest=$gnulib_file
test -d $ref_po_dir || mkdir $ref_po_dir || return
download_po_files $ref_po_dir $domain \
&& ls "$ref_po_dir"/*.po 2>/dev/null |
sed 's|.*/||; s|\.po$||' > "$po_dir/LINGUAS"
case $gnulib_file in
m4/codeset.m4) continue;;
m4/intdiv0.m4) continue;;
m4/inttypes-pri.m4) continue;;
m4/isc-posix.m4) continue;;
m4/lcmessage.m4) continue;;
m4/onceonly_2_57.m4) dest=m4/onceonly.m4;;
# These will be overwritten by autopoint, which still uses
# old jm_.* macro names, so we have to keep both copies.
m4/gettext.m4 | m4/glibc21.m4 | m4/inttypes_h.m4 | m4/lib-ld.m4 | \
m4/lib-prefix.m4 | m4/po.m4 | m4/stdint_h.m4 | m4/uintmax_t.m4 | \
m4/ulonglong.m4)
dest=`expr $gnulib_file : '\(.*\).m4'`_gl.m4;;
esac
langs=`cd $ref_po_dir && echo *.po|sed 's/\.po//g'`
test "$langs" = '*' && langs=x
for po in $langs; do
case $po in x) continue;; esac
new_po="$ref_po_dir/$po.po"
cksum_file="$ref_po_dir/$po.s1"
if ! test -f "$cksum_file" ||
! test -f "$po_dir/$po.po" ||
! sha1sum -c --status "$cksum_file" < "$new_po" > /dev/null; then
echo "updated $po_dir/$po.po..."
cp "$new_po" "$po_dir/$po.po" && sha1sum < "$new_po" > "$cksum_file"
fi
done
}
rm -f $dest &&
echo "$0: Copying file $GNULIB_SRCDIR/$gnulib_file" &&
cp -p $GNULIB_SRCDIR/$gnulib_file $dest || exit
done
case $SKIP_PO in
'')
if test -d po; then
update_po_files po $package || exit
fi
echo "$0: Creating m4/gnulib.m4"
(echo "# This file is generated automatically. Please, do not edit."
echo "#"
echo "AC_DEFUN([tar_GNULIB],["
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
echo "# $gnulib_module"
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-autoconf-snippet $gnulib_module
done | sed '/AM_GNU_GETTEXT/d'
echo "])") > ./m4/gnulib.m4
echo "$0: Creating lib/Makefile.am"
(cat lib/Makefile.tmpl
for gnulib_module in $gnulib_modules; do
echo "# $gnulib_module"
$GNULIB_SRCDIR/gnulib-tool --extract-automake-snippet $gnulib_module
done | sed 's/lib_SOURCES/libtar_a_SOURCES/g' ) > lib/Makefile.am
# Get paxutils files
case ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR--} in
-) checkout paxutils
PAXUTILS_SRCDIR=paxutils
if test -d runtime-po; then
update_po_files runtime-po $package-runtime || exit
fi;;
esac
symlink_to_dir()
{
src=$1/$2
dst=${3-$2}
test -f "$src" && {
# If the destination directory doesn't exist, create it.
# This is required at least for "lib/uniwidth/cjk.h".
dst_dir=`dirname "$dst"`
if ! test -d "$dst_dir"; then
mkdir -p "$dst_dir"
# If we've just created a directory like lib/uniwidth,
# tell version control system(s) it's ignorable.
# FIXME: for now, this does only one level
parent=`dirname "$dst_dir"`
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
test $dot_ig = x && continue
ig=$parent/$dot_ig
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig `echo "$dst_dir"|sed 's,.*/,,'`
done
fi
if $copy; then
{
test ! -h "$dst" || {
echo "$0: rm -f $dst" &&
rm -f "$dst"
}
} &&
test -f "$dst" &&
cmp -s "$src" "$dst" || {
echo "$0: cp -fp $src $dst" &&
cp -fp "$src" "$dst"
}
else
test -h "$dst" &&
src_ls=`ls -diL "$src" 2>/dev/null` && set $src_ls && src_i=$1 &&
dst_ls=`ls -diL "$dst" 2>/dev/null` && set $dst_ls && dst_i=$1 &&
test "$src_i" = "$dst_i" || {
dot_dots=
case $src in
/*) ;;
*)
case /$dst/ in
*//* | */../* | */./* | /*/*/*/*/*/)
echo >&2 "$0: invalid symlink calculation: $src -> $dst"
exit 1;;
/*/*/*/*/) dot_dots=../../../;;
/*/*/*/) dot_dots=../../;;
/*/*/) dot_dots=../;;
esac;;
esac
echo "$0: ln -fs $dot_dots$src $dst" &&
ln -fs "$dot_dots$src" "$dst"
}
fi
}
}
cp_mark_as_generated()
{
cp_src=$1
cp_dst=$2
if cmp -s "$cp_src" "$GNULIB_SRCDIR/$cp_dst"; then
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" "$cp_dst"
elif cmp -s "$cp_src" "$local_gl_dir/$cp_dst"; then
symlink_to_dir $local_gl_dir "$cp_dst"
else
case $cp_dst in
*.[ch]) c1='/* '; c2=' */';;
*.texi) c1='@c '; c2= ;;
*.m4|*/Make*|Make*) c1='# ' ; c2= ;;
*) c1= ; c2= ;;
esac
# If the destination directory doesn't exist, create it.
# This is required at least for "lib/uniwidth/cjk.h".
dst_dir=`dirname "$cp_dst"`
test -d "$dst_dir" || mkdir -p "$dst_dir"
if test -z "$c1"; then
cmp -s "$cp_src" "$cp_dst" || {
# Copy the file first to get proper permissions if it
# doesn't already exist. Then overwrite the copy.
echo "$0: cp -f $cp_src $cp_dst" &&
rm -f "$cp_dst" &&
cp "$cp_src" "$cp_dst-t" &&
sed "s!$bt_regex/!!g" "$cp_src" > "$cp_dst-t" &&
mv -f "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"
}
else
# Copy the file first to get proper permissions if it
# doesn't already exist. Then overwrite the copy.
cp "$cp_src" "$cp_dst-t" &&
(
echo "$c1-*- buffer-read-only: t -*- vi: set ro:$c2" &&
echo "${c1}DO NOT EDIT! GENERATED AUTOMATICALLY!$c2" &&
sed "s!$bt_regex/!!g" "$cp_src"
) > $cp_dst-t &&
if cmp -s "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"; then
rm -f "$cp_dst-t"
else
echo "$0: cp $cp_src $cp_dst # with edits" &&
mv -f "$cp_dst-t" "$cp_dst"
fi
fi
fi
}
version_controlled_file() {
dir=$1
file=$2
found=no
if test -d CVS; then
grep -F "/$file/" $dir/CVS/Entries 2>/dev/null |
grep '^/[^/]*/[0-9]' > /dev/null && found=yes
elif test -d .git; then
git rm -n "$dir/$file" > /dev/null 2>&1 && found=yes
elif test -d .svn; then
svn log -r HEAD "$dir/$file" > /dev/null 2>&1 && found=yes
else
echo "$0: no version control for $dir/$file?" >&2
fi
test $found = yes
}
slurp() {
for dir in . `(cd $1 && find * -type d -print)`; do
copied=
sep=
for file in `ls -a $1/$dir`; do
case $file in
.|..) continue;;
.*) continue;; # FIXME: should all file names starting with "." be ignored?
esac
test -d $1/$dir/$file && continue
for excluded_file in $excluded_files; do
test "$dir/$file" = "$excluded_file" && continue 2
done
if test $file = Makefile.am; then
copied=$copied${sep}$gnulib_mk; sep=$nl
remove_intl='/^[^#].*\/intl/s/^/#/;'"s!$bt_regex/!!g"
sed "$remove_intl" $1/$dir/$file | cmp -s - $dir/$gnulib_mk || {
echo "$0: Copying $1/$dir/$file to $dir/$gnulib_mk ..." &&
rm -f $dir/$gnulib_mk &&
sed "$remove_intl" $1/$dir/$file >$dir/$gnulib_mk
}
elif { test "${2+set}" = set && test -r $2/$dir/$file; } ||
version_controlled_file $dir $file; then
echo "$0: $dir/$file overrides $1/$dir/$file"
else
copied=$copied$sep$file; sep=$nl
if test $file = gettext.m4; then
echo "$0: patching m4/gettext.m4 to remove need for intl/* ..."
rm -f $dir/$file
sed '
/^AC_DEFUN(\[AM_INTL_SUBDIR],/,/^]/c\
AC_DEFUN([AM_INTL_SUBDIR], [
/^AC_DEFUN(\[gt_INTL_SUBDIR_CORE],/,/^]/c\
AC_DEFUN([gt_INTL_SUBDIR_CORE], [])
$a\
AC_DEFUN([gl_LOCK_EARLY], [])
' $1/$dir/$file >$dir/$file
else
cp_mark_as_generated $1/$dir/$file $dir/$file
fi
fi || exit
done
for dot_ig in x $vc_ignore; do
test $dot_ig = x && continue
ig=$dir/$dot_ig
if test -n "$copied"; then
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$copied"
# If an ignored file name ends with .in.h, then also add
# the name with just ".h". Many gnulib headers are generated,
# e.g., stdint.in.h -> stdint.h, dirent.in.h ->..., etc.
# Likewise for .gperf -> .h, .y -> .c, and .sin -> .sed
f=`echo "$copied"|sed 's/\.in\.h$/.h/;s/\.sin$/.sed/;s/\.y$/.c/;s/\.gperf$/.h/'`
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$f"
# For files like sys_stat.in.h and sys_time.in.h, record as
# ignorable the directory we might eventually create: sys/.
f=`echo "$copied"|sed 's/sys_.*\.in\.h$/sys/'`
insert_sorted_if_absent $ig "$f"
fi
done
done
}
# Create boot temporary directories to import from gnulib and gettext.
rm -fr $bt $bt2 &&
mkdir $bt $bt2 || exit
# Import from gnulib.
gnulib_tool_options="\
--import\
--no-changelog\
--aux-dir $bt/$build_aux\
--doc-base $bt/$doc_base\
--lib $gnulib_name\
--m4-base $bt/$m4_base/\
--source-base $bt/$source_base/\
--tests-base $bt/$tests_base\
--local-dir $local_gl_dir\
$gnulib_tool_option_extras\
"
echo "$0: $gnulib_tool $gnulib_tool_options --import ..."
$gnulib_tool $gnulib_tool_options --import $gnulib_modules &&
slurp $bt || exit
for file in $gnulib_files; do
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" $file || exit
done
# Import from gettext.
with_gettext=yes
grep '^[ ]*AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION(' configure.ac >/dev/null || \
with_gettext=no
if test $with_gettext = yes; then
echo "$0: (cd $bt2; autopoint) ..."
cp configure.ac $bt2 &&
(cd $bt2 && autopoint && rm configure.ac) &&
slurp $bt2 $bt || exit
fi
rm -fr $bt $bt2 || exit
# Remove any dangling symlink matching "*.m4" or "*.[ch]" in some
# gnulib-populated directories. Such .m4 files would cause aclocal to fail.
# The following requires GNU find 4.2.3 or newer. Considering the usual
# portability constraints of this script, that may seem a very demanding
# requirement, but it should be ok. Ignore any failure, which is fine,
# since this is only a convenience to help developers avoid the relatively
# unusual case in which a symlinked-to .m4 file is git-removed from gnulib
# between successive runs of this script.
find "$m4_base" "$source_base" \
-depth \( -name '*.m4' -o -name '*.[ch]' \) \
-type l -xtype l -delete > /dev/null 2>&1
# copy_files srcdir dstdir
copy_files() {
for file in `cat $1/DISTFILES`
@@ -291,12 +623,28 @@ copy_files() {
case $file in
"#*") continue;;
esac
echo "$0: Copying file $1/$file"
cp -p $1/$file $2/`expr $file : '.*/\(.*\)'`
dst=`echo $file | sed 's^.*/^^'`
if [ $# -eq 3 ]; then
case $dst in
${3}*) ;;
*) dst=${3}$dst;;
esac
fi
symlink_to_dir "$1" "$file" "$2/$dst" || exit
# FIXME ignorefile $2 $dst
done
}
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/m4 m4
# Import from paxutils
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR} .
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/am m4
echo "$0: Creating m4/paxutils.m4"
(echo "# This file is generated automatically. Please, do not edit."
echo "#"
echo "AC_DEFUN([${package}_PAXUTILS],["
cat ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/am/DISTFILES | sed '/^#/d;s/\(.*\)\.m4/pu_\1/' | tr a-z A-Z
echo "])") > ./m4/paxutils.m4
#FIXME ignorefile m4 paxutils.m4
if [ -d rmt ]; then
:
@@ -304,21 +652,82 @@ else
mkdir rmt
fi
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/rmt rmt
for dir in doc rmt lib tests
do
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/$dir $dir
done
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/lib lib
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/paxlib lib pax
copy_files ${PAXUTILS_SRCDIR}/tests tests
# Get translations.
if test "$DOWNLOAD_PO" = "yes"; then
update_po
fi
# Reconfigure, getting other files.
echo "$0: autoreconf --verbose --install --force ..."
autoreconf --verbose --install --force
for command in \
libtool \
'aclocal --force -I m4' \
'autoconf --force' \
'autoheader --force' \
'automake --add-missing --copy --force-missing';
do
if test "$command" = libtool; then
use_libtool=0
# We'd like to use grep -E, to see if any of LT_INIT,
# AC_PROG_LIBTOOL, AM_PROG_LIBTOOL is used in configure.ac,
# but that's not portable enough (e.g., for Solaris).
grep '^[ ]*A[CM]_PROG_LIBTOOL' configure.ac >/dev/null \
&& use_libtool=1
grep '^[ ]*LT_INIT' configure.ac >/dev/null \
&& use_libtool=1
test $use_libtool = 0 \
&& continue
command='libtoolize -c -f'
fi
echo "$0: $command ..."
$command || exit
done
# Get some extra files from gnulib, overriding existing files.
for file in $gnulib_extra_files; do
case $file in
*/INSTALL) dst=INSTALL;;
build-aux/*) dst=$build_aux/`expr "$file" : 'build-aux/\(.*\)'`;;
*) dst=$file;;
esac
symlink_to_dir "$GNULIB_SRCDIR" $file $dst || exit
done
if test $with_gettext = yes; then
# Create gettext configuration.
echo "$0: Creating po/Makevars from po/Makevars.template ..."
rm -f po/Makevars
sed '
/^EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES *=/s/=.*/= '"$EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES"'/
/^MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS *=/s/=.*/= '"$MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS"'/
/^XGETTEXT_OPTIONS *=/{
s/$/ \\/
a\
'"$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS"' $${end_of_xgettext_options+}
}
' po/Makevars.template >po/Makevars
if test -d runtime-po; then
# Similarly for runtime-po/Makevars, but not quite the same.
rm -f runtime-po/Makevars
sed '
/^DOMAIN *=.*/s/=.*/= '"$package"'-runtime/
/^subdir *=.*/s/=.*/= runtime-po/
/^MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS *=/s/=.*/= bug-'"$package"'@gnu.org/
/^XGETTEXT_OPTIONS *=/{
s/$/ \\/
a\
'"$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS_RUNTIME"' $${end_of_xgettext_options+}
}
' <po/Makevars.template >runtime-po/Makevars
# Copy identical files from po to runtime-po.
(cd po && cp -p Makefile.in.in *-quot *.header *.sed *.sin ../runtime-po)
fi
fi
echo "$0: done. Now you can run './configure'."

74
bootstrap.conf Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
# Bootstrap configuration for GNU tar.
# Copyright (C) 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
# 02110-1301, USA.
source_base=gnu
gnulib_name=libgnu
gnulib_mk=Makefile.am
# We don't need these modules, even though gnulib-tool mistakenly
# includes them because of gettext dependencies.
avoided_gnulib_modules='
--avoid=lock
'
# gnulib modules used by this package.
gnulib_modules="$avoided_gnulib_modules
`grep '^[^#]' gnulib.modules`
"
# Additional xgettext options to use. Use "\\\newline" to break lines.
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS=$XGETTEXT_OPTIONS'\\\
--flag=_:1:pass-c-format\\\
--flag=N_:1:pass-c-format\\\
--flag=error:3:c-format --flag=error_at_line:5:c-format\\\
--flag=asnprintf:3:c-format --flag=vasnprintf:3:c-format\\\
--flag=argp_error:2:c-format\\\
--flag=__argp_error:2:c-format\\\
--flag=argp_failure:4:c-format\\\
--flag=__argp_failure:4:c-format\\\
--flag=argp_fmtstream_printf:2:c-format\\\
--flag=__argp_fmtstream_printf:2:c-format\\\
'
# Gettext supplies these files, but we don't need them since
# we don't have an intl subdirectory.
excluded_files='
m4/glibc2.m4
m4/intdiv0.m4
m4/lcmessage.m4
m4/lock.m4
m4/printf-posix.m4
m4/uintmax_t.m4
m4/ulonglong.m4
m4/visibility.m4
'
# Read local configuration file
if [ -r .bootstrap ]; then
echo "$0: Reading configuration file .bootstrap"
eval set -- "`sed 's/#.*$//;/^$/d' .bootstrap | tr '\n' ' '` $*"
fi
test -d m4 || mkdir m4
test -d $source_base || mkdir $source_base
cat > ChangeLog <<EOT
This file is a placeholder. It will be replaced with the actual ChangeLog
by make dist. Run make ChangeLog if you wish to create it earlier.
EOT

View File

@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
# Configure template for GNU tar.
# Configure template for GNU tar. -*- autoconf -*-
# Copyright (C) 1991, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
# 2002, 2003, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -15,31 +15,32 @@
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
# 02111-1307, USA.
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
# 02110-1301, USA.
AC_INIT([GNU tar], [1.15], [bug-tar@gnu.org])
AC_INIT([GNU tar], [1.22], [bug-tar@gnu.org])
AC_CONFIG_SRCDIR([src/tar.c])
AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR([config])
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h:config.hin])
AC_PREREQ([2.59])
AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE([1.8 gnits dist-bzip2 dist-shar std-options])
AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR([build-aux])
AC_CONFIG_HEADERS([config.h])
AC_PREREQ([2.60])
AM_INIT_AUTOMAKE([1.9 gnits tar-ustar dist-bzip2 dist-shar std-options])
gl_USE_SYSTEM_EXTENSIONS
AC_PROG_CC
AC_EXEEXT
AC_PROG_RANLIB
AC_PROG_YACC
gl_EARLY
AC_SYS_LARGEFILE
AC_ISC_POSIX
AC_C_INLINE
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(fcntl.h linux/fd.h memory.h net/errno.h \
sgtty.h string.h \
sys/param.h sys/device.h sys/gentape.h \
AC_CHECK_HEADERS_ONCE(fcntl.h linux/fd.h memory.h net/errno.h \
sgtty.h string.h stropts.h \
sys/param.h sys/device.h sys/filio.h sys/gentape.h \
sys/inet.h sys/io/trioctl.h \
sys/mtio.h sys/time.h sys/tprintf.h sys/tape.h \
unistd.h)
unistd.h locale.h)
AC_CHECK_HEADERS([sys/buf.h], [], [],
[#if HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H
@@ -47,14 +48,12 @@ AC_CHECK_HEADERS([sys/buf.h], [], [],
#endif])
AC_HEADER_SYS_WAIT
AM_STDBOOL_H
AC_HEADER_DIRENT
AC_HEADER_MAJOR
AC_HEADER_STAT
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_STRUCT_ST_BLKSIZE
AC_STRUCT_ST_BLOCKS
AC_MSG_CHECKING([for st_fstype string in struct stat])
AC_CACHE_VAL(diff_cv_st_fstype_string,
[AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include <sys/types.h>
@@ -81,52 +80,17 @@ AC_CHECK_TYPE(dev_t, unsigned)
AC_CHECK_TYPE(ino_t, unsigned)
gt_TYPE_SSIZE_T
gl_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T
jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T
# gnulib modules
tar_GNULIB
gl_INIT
# paxutils modules
tar_PAXUTILS
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct stat.st_spare1, struct stat.st_atim.tv_nsec, struct stat.st_atimespec.tv_nsec, struct stat.st_atimensec], , ,
[
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>])
# Save and restore LIBS so e.g., -lrt, isn't added to it. Otherwise, *all*
# programs in the package would end up linked with that potentially-shared
# library, inducing unnecessary run-time overhead.
# Solaris 2.5.1 needs -lposix4 to get the clock_gettime function.
# Solaris 7 prefers the library name -lrt to the obsolescent name -lposix4.
tar_save_LIBS=$LIBS
LIB_CLOCK_GETTIME=
AC_SEARCH_LIBS(clock_gettime, [rt posix4])
case "$ac_cv_search_clock_gettime" in
-l*) LIB_CLOCK_GETTIME=$ac_cv_search_clock_gettime;;
esac
AC_SUBST(LIB_CLOCK_GETTIME)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(clock_gettime)
LIBS=$tar_save_LIBS
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(fsync lstat mkfifo readlink strerror symlink setlocale utimes)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(fsync getdtablesize lstat mkfifo readlink symlink setlocale utimes)
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getgrgid],,, [#include <grp.h>])
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getpwuid],,, [#include <pwd.h>])
AC_CHECK_DECLS([time],,, [#include <time.h>])
# Set LIB_SETSOCKOPT to -lnsl -lsocket if necessary.
tar_save_LIBS=$LIBS
LIB_SETSOCKOPT=
AC_SEARCH_LIBS(setsockopt, [socket], ,
[AC_SEARCH_LIBS(setsockopt, [socket], , , [-lnsl])])
AC_SEARCH_LIBS(setsockopt, [nsl])
case "$ac_cv_search_setsockopt" in
-l*) LIB_SETSOCKOPT=$ac_cv_search_setsockopt
esac
AC_SUBST(LIB_SETSOCKOPT)
LIBS=$tar_save_LIBS
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(waitpid)
AC_CACHE_CHECK(for remote shell, tar_cv_path_RSH,
@@ -189,7 +153,7 @@ else
case $DEFAULT_ARCHIVE in
*[[0-7][lmh]])
AC_DEFINE(DENSITY_LETTER, 1,
[[Define to 1 if density may be indicated by [lmh] at end of device.]])
[Define to 1 if density may be indicated by [lmh] at end of device.])
device_prefix=`echo $DEFAULT_ARCHIVE | sed 's/[0-7][lmh]$//'`
;;
*[[0-7]])
@@ -218,7 +182,22 @@ AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DEFAULT_BLOCKING, $DEFAULT_BLOCKING,
[Define to a number giving the default blocking size for archives.])
AC_MSG_RESULT($DEFAULT_BLOCKING)
PU_RMT
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for default quoting style)
m4_define([QUOTING_STYLES],dnl
[literal|shell|shell-always|c|escape|locale|clocale])
DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE="escape"
AC_ARG_VAR([DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE],
[Set the default quoting style. Allowed values are: ] m4_bpatsubst(QUOTING_STYLES,[|], [[, ]]) [. Default is "escape".])
case $DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE in
QUOTING_STYLES) ;;
*) AC_MSG_ERROR(Invalid quoting style);;
esac
AC_MSG_RESULT($DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE)
DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE=`echo ${DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE}|sed 's/-/_/g'`_quoting_style
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE, $DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE,
[Define to a default quoting style (see lib/quoteargs.c for the list)])
# Iconv
AM_ICONV
@@ -233,8 +212,8 @@ AC_CHECK_TYPE(iconv_t,:,
])
# Gettext.
AM_GNU_GETTEXT([external], [need-ngettext])
AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION(0.12.1)
AM_GNU_GETTEXT([external], [need-formatstring-macros])
AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION([0.16])
# Initialize the test suite.
AC_CONFIG_TESTDIR(tests)
@@ -259,9 +238,9 @@ else
BACKUP_SED_COND='/^\#IF_DATE_FORMAT_OK/,/^\#ELSE_DATE_FORMAT_OK/d;/^\#ENDIF_DATE_FORMAT_OK/d'
fi
AC_OUTPUT([Makefile\
doc/Makefile\
gnu/Makefile\
lib/Makefile\
po/Makefile.in\
scripts/Makefile\

View File

@@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ programs (using pipes); tar can even access remote devices or files
Jeff Bailey <jbailey@nisa.net>,
Paul Eggert <eggert@CS.UCLA.EDU>
%%updated: 20 Dec 2004
%%updated: 21 Dec 2004
%%keywords: archive, backup, tar, pax
@@ -66,7 +66,7 @@ programs (using pipes); tar can even access remote devices or files
Joy Kendall,
Francois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>
%%source-tarball: ftp://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/tar/tar-1.15.tar.gz
%%source-tarball: ftp://ftp.gnu.org/pub/gnu/tar/tar-1.15.1.tar.gz
%%source-info: http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/tar
%%repository:
@@ -79,7 +79,7 @@ programs (using pipes); tar can even access remote devices or files
%%related-programs: GNU cpio
%%version: 1.15 (stable) released on 20 Dec 2004
%%version: 1.15.1 (stable) released on 21 Dec 2004
%%bug-list: bug-tar@gnu.org bug-tar@gnu.org http://mail.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/bug-tar

View File

@@ -1,34 +0,0 @@
Makefile.in
Makefile
header.texi
tar.info
version.texi
stamp-vti
tar.html
tar.log
tar.dvi
tar.aux
tar.toc
tar.cp
tar.fn
tar.vr
tar.tp
tar.ky
tar.pg
tar.ps
tar.cps
tar.fns
tar.pgs
tar.vrs
tar.at
tar.kw
tar.ex
tar.ats
tar.exs
tar.kws
tmp-tar.*
tmp2-tar.*
html_mono
html_node
html_chapter
*.stamp

26
doc/.gitignore vendored Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
getdate.texi
manual
stamp-vti
tar.aux
tar.cp
tar.cps
tar.fl
tar.fn
tar.info
tar.info*
tar.info-*
tar.kw
tar.ky
tar.log
tar.mt
tar.op
tar.pdf
tar.pg
tar.pr
tar.t2d
tar.toc
tar.tp
tar.vr
version.texi
genfile.texi
header.texi

View File

@@ -1,11 +1,11 @@
# Makefile for GNU tar documentation.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003 Free
# Software Foundation, Inc.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2006,
# 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
## any later version.
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -15,188 +15,130 @@
## You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
## along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
## Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
## Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
info_TEXINFOS = tar.texi
tar_TEXINFOS = fdl.texi freemanuals.texi getdate.texi header.texi
EXTRA_DIST = convtexi.pl
CLEANFILES = tmp-* tmp2-* index.html
tar_TEXINFOS = \
dumpdir.texi\
tar-snapshot-edit.texi\
fdl.texi\
freemanuals.texi\
genfile.texi\
getdate.texi\
header.texi\
intern.texi\
rendition.texi\
snapshot.texi\
sparse.texi\
value.texi
EXTRA_DIST = gendocs_template mastermenu.el texify.sed untabify.el
# The rendering level is anyone of PUBLISH, DISTRIB or PROOF.
# Just call `make dvi RENDITION=PROOF' if you want PROOF rendition.
# Just call `make RENDITION=PROOF [target]' if you want PROOF rendition.
RENDITION = DISTRIB
$(srcdir)/tar.info: tar.texi fdl.texi freemanuals.texi getdate.texi \
$(srcdir)/header.texi version.texi
$(MAKEINFO) --no-split -D$(RENDITION) -I$(srcdir) tar.texi -o $@
MAKEINFOFLAGS=-D$(RENDITION)
tmp-tar.texi: tar.texi getdate.texi $(srcdir)/header.texi version.texi
$(MAKEINFO) -D$(RENDITION) -Etmp-tar.tmp -otmp-tar.info \
-I$(srcdir) tar.texi
rm -f tmp-tar.sed tmp-tar.info*
test $(RENDITION) = DISTRIB \
|| echo >>tmp-tar.sed 's/^@set DISTRIB/@set $(RENDITION)/'
test $(RENDITION) = PUBLISH \
|| echo >>tmp-tar.sed '/^@smallbook/d'
sed -f tmp-tar.sed tmp-tar.tmp > tmp-tar.texi
rm -f tmp-tar.sed tmp-tar.tmp
header.texi: $(top_srcdir)/src/tar.h
sed -f $(srcdir)/texify.sed $(top_srcdir)/src/tar.h \
| expand >$@
tar.dvi: tmp-tar.texi
TEXINPUTS=$(top_srcdir)/config:$$TEXINPUTS \
MAKEINFO='$(MAKEINFO) $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir)' \
$(TEXI2DVI) tmp-tar.texi
mv tmp-tar.dvi $@
master-menu: $(tar_TEXINFOS)
emacs -batch -l mastermenu.el -f make-master-menu $(info_TEXINFOS)
$(srcdir)/header.texi: $(top_srcdir)/src/tar.h
sed -n '/Archive Format/,/End of Format/p' $(top_srcdir)/src/tar.h \
| expand | sed 's/\([{}]\)/@\1/g' >$@
untabify:
emacs -batch -l untabify.el $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS)
##
PROJECT=$(PACKAGE_TARNAME)
BASE_URL="http://www.gnu.org/software/$(PROJECT)/manual/"
TEXI2HTML=${SHELL} `cd $(top_srcdir); pwd`/config/missing --run texi2html
INFO=${SHELL} `cd $(top_srcdir); pwd`/config/missing --run info
DVIPDF=${SHELL} `cd $(top_srcdir); pwd`/config/missing --run dvipdf
final: untabify master-menu
# Checking
check-format:
@if test -n "`cat $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS) | tr -d -c '\t'`"; then \
echo "Sources contain tabs; run make untabify"; \
false; \
fi
check-options:
@ARGP_HELP_FMT='usage-indent=0,short-opt-col=0,long-opt-col=0,\
doc-opt-col=0,opt-doc-col=0,header-col=0,rmargin=1' \
$(top_builddir)/src/tar --usage | \
sed -n 's/^\[--\([^]\=\[]*\).*/\1/p' | sort | uniq > opts.$$$$;\
$(MAKEINFO) $(AM_MAKEINFOFLAGS) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS) -I $(srcdir) -E - \
$(info_TEXINFOS) | \
sed -n '/^@macro/,/^@end macro/d;s/@opindex *\([^@,]*\).*/\1/p' \
| sort | uniq > docs.$$$$;\
(echo 'Not documented options:';\
join -v1 opts.$$$$ docs.$$$$;\
echo 'Non-existing options:';\
join -v2 opts.$$$$ docs.$$$$) > report.$$$$;\
rm opts.$$$$ docs.$$$$;\
if [ -n "`sed '1,2d' report.$$$$`" ]; then \
cat report.$$$$;\
rm report.$$$$;\
exit 1;\
fi;\
rm report.$$$$
check-refs:
@for file in $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS); \
do \
sed -e = $$file | \
sed -n 'N;/@FIXME-.*ref/{s/\(^[0-9][0-9]*\).*@FIXME-.*ref{\([^}]*\).*/'$$file':\1: \2/gp}'; \
done > $@-t; \
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
echo "Unresolved cross-references:"; \
cat $@-t;\
rm $@-t; \
else \
rm -f $@-t; \
fi
check-fixmes:
@for file in $(info_TEXINFOS); \
do \
sed -e = $$file | \
sed -n 'N;/@FIXME{/{s/\(^[0-9][0-9]*\).*@FIXME{\([^}]*\).*/'$$file':\1: \2/gp}'; \
done > $@-t; \
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
echo "Unresolved FIXMEs:"; \
cat $@-t; \
rm $@-t; \
false; \
else \
rm -f $@-t; \
fi
check-unrevised:
@grep -Hn @UNREVISED $(info_TEXINFOS) > $@-t; \
if [ -s $@-t ]; then \
echo "Unrevised nodes:"; \
cat $@-t; \
rm $@-t; \
false;\
else \
rm $@-t; \
fi
all-check-docs: check-format check-options check-refs check-fixmes check-unrevised
check-docs:
$(MAKE) -k all-check-docs
#
clean-local:
rm -rf $(WEBDOC) $(WEB_HTML_STAMPS)
rm -rf manual
html: html_mono.stamp html_node.stamp html_chapter.stamp
GENDOCS=gendocs.sh
tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi: Makefile tmp-$(PROJECT).texi
echo '/@copying/,/@end copying/{H;x;s/@copying//;s/@end copying//;x;}' > tmp2.sed
echo '/@insertcopying/{x;h;}' >> tmp2.sed
echo 's/\(.\)@ifset/\1\' >> tmp2.sed
echo '@ifset/' >> tmp2.sed
sed -f tmp2.sed tmp-$(PROJECT).texi > tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi
rm -f tmp2.sed
TEXI2DVI=texi2dvi -t '@set $(RENDITION)' -E
html_node.stamp: tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi
texi2html="$(TEXI2HTML)";\
if ! test -d html_node; then mkdir html_node; fi; \
cd html_node; \
$$texi2html -menu -split_node -prefix $(PROJECT) ../tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi; \
cd ..; \
touch html_node.stamp
html_chapter.stamp: tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi
texi2html="$(TEXI2HTML)";\
if ! test -d html_chapter; then mkdir html_chapter; fi; \
cd html_chapter; \
$$texi2html -menu -split_chapter -prefix $(PROJECT) ../tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi; \
cd ..; \
touch html_chapter.stamp
html_mono.stamp: tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi
texi2html="$(TEXI2HTML)";\
if ! test -d html_mono; then mkdir html_mono; fi; \
cd html_mono; \
$$texi2html -menu -monolithic -prefix $(PROJECT) ../tmp2-$(PROJECT).texi; \
cd ..; \
touch html_mono.stamp
ps: $(PROJECT).ps
$(PROJECT).ps: $(PROJECT).dvi
$(DVIPS) -o$(PROJECT).ps $(PROJECT).dvi
# Override the default rule. The texinfo <= 4.5 is unable to cope with
# tar docs.
$(PROJECT).pdf: $(PROJECT).dvi
$(DVIPDF) $(PROJECT).dvi
text: $(PROJECT).text
$(PROJECT).text: Makefile $(PROJECT).info
$(INFO) --node=Top --subnodes --out $(PROJECT).text -f ./$(PROJECT).info
$(PROJECT).info.tar.gz: Makefile
rm -f $(PROJECT).info.tar.gz
tar cf $(PROJECT).info.tar $(PROJECT).info*
gzip -f $(PROJECT).info.tar
$(PROJECT).dvi.gz: Makefile $(PROJECT).dvi
gzip -c $(PROJECT).dvi > $(PROJECT).dvi.gz
$(PROJECT).ps.gz: Makefile $(PROJECT).ps
gzip -c $(PROJECT).ps > $(PROJECT).ps.gz
$(PROJECT).pdf.gz: Makefile $(PROJECT).pdf
gzip -c $(PROJECT).pdf > $(PROJECT).pdf.gz
$(PROJECT).texi.tar.gz: Makefile $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS)
tar cfz $(PROJECT).texi.tar.gz $(info_TEXINFOS) $(tar_TEXINFOS)
WEB_HTML=\
html_mono\
html_node\
html_chapter
WEB_HTML_STAMPS=$(patsubst %,%.stamp,$(WEB_HTML))
WEB_BIN=\
$(PROJECT).info.tar.gz\
$(PROJECT).dvi.gz\
$(PROJECT).pdf.gz\
$(PROJECT).ps.gz\
$(PROJECT).texi.tar.gz\
$(PROJECT).text
WEBDOC=$(WEB_HTML) $(WEB_BIN)
webdocdir: $(WEB_HTML_STAMPS) $(WEB_BIN) index.html
if ! test -d $(WEBDOCDIR); then mkdir $(WEBDOCDIR); fi; \
here=`cd $(srcdir) && pwd`; \
webdocdir=`cd $(WEBDOCDIR) && pwd`; \
for file in $(WEB_HTML) index.html; do \
if test -d $$here/$$file; then \
cp -pr $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/$$file; \
else \
test -f $$webdocdir/$$file \
|| ln $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/$$file 2> /dev/null \
|| cp -p $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/$$file || :; \
fi; \
done; \
if ! test -d $(WEBDOCDIR)/other; then mkdir $(WEBDOCDIR)/other; fi;\
for file in $(WEB_BIN); do \
if test -d $$here/$$file; then \
cp -pr $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/other/$$file; \
else \
test -f $$webdocdir/other/$$file \
|| ln $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/other/$$file 2> /dev/null \
|| cp -p $$here/$$file $$webdocdir/other/$$file || :; \
fi; \
done
index.html: index.html.in $(WEBDOC)
@echo "s^%BASE_URL%^$(BASE_URL)^;" > .webdoc
@echo "s/%DATE%/`date`/;" >> .webdoc
@echo "s/%UPDATED%/`date +'%B, %d'`/;" >> .webdoc
@echo "s/%PACKAGE_NAME%/$(PACKAGE_NAME)/" >> .webdoc
@echo "s/%PACKAGE%/$(PACKAGE)/" >> .webdoc
@echo "s/%VERSION%/$(VERSION)/" >> .webdoc
@for file in `sed -n 's,.*"other/%PACKAGE%\(.*\)".*,$(PACKAGE)\1,pg;s,.*"\(.*\)%PACKAGE%\(.*\)".*,\1$(PACKAGE)\2,pg' index.html.in`; \
do\
ls -sk $$file; \
done |\
$(AWK) -vPACKAGE=$(PACKAGE) \
'BEGIN { len = length(PACKAGE) } \
{ gsub("\\.", "_", $$2); \
if (match($$2,"/")) \
$$2=substr($$2,RSTART+1); \
print "s/%" toupper(substr($$2,len+2)) "_SIZE%/" $$1 "/;" }' >> .webdoc
sed -f .webdoc index.html.in > index.html
rm -f .webdoc
webdocname=$(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)-doc
WEBDOCDIR=$(webdocname)
webdoc:
$(MAKE) RENDITION=PUBLISH WEBDOCDIR=$(top_builddir)/doc/$(webdocname) webdocdir
cd $(top_builddir)/doc &&\
tar cfz $(webdocname).tar.gz $(webdocname) &&\
rm -r $(webdocname)
## End of webdoc
# Make sure you set TEXINPUTS
# Usual value is:
# /usr/share/texmf/pdftex/plain/misc:/usr/share/texmf/pdftex/config
manual:
TEXINPUTS=$(srcdir):$(top_srcdir)/build-tex:$(TEXINPUTS) \
MAKEINFO="$(MAKEINFO) $(MAKEINFOFLAGS)" \
TEXI2DVI="$(TEXI2DVI) -t @finalout" \
$(GENDOCS) --texi2html tar 'GNU tar manual'

View File

@@ -1,134 +0,0 @@
#!/usr/local/bin/perl -- # -*-Perl-*-
eval "exec /usr/local/bin/perl -S $0 $*"
if 0;
# Copy a Texinfo file, replacing @value's, @FIXME's and other gooddies.
# Copyright (C) 1996, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
# under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the
# Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
# version.
#
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
# WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General
# Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
# with this program. If not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
# 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
# François Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1996.
$_ = <>;
while ($_)
{
if (/^\@c()$/ || /^\@c (.*)/ || /^\@(include .*)/)
{
if ($topseen)
{
print "\@format\n";
print "\@strong{\@\@c} $1\n";
$_ = <>;
while (/\@c (.*)/)
{
print "\@strong{\@\@c} $1\n";
$_ = <>;
}
print "\@end format\n";
}
else
{
$delay .= "\@format\n";
$delay .= "\@strong{\@\@c} $1\n";
$_ = <>;
while (/\@c (.*)/)
{
$delay .= "\@strong{\@\@c} $1\n";
$_ = <>;
}
$delay .= "\@end format\n";
}
}
elsif (/^\@chapter /)
{
print;
# print $delay;
$delay = '';
$topseen = 1;
$_ = <>;
}
elsif (/^\@macro /)
{
$_ = <> while ($_ && ! /^\@end macro/);
$_ = <>;
}
elsif (/^\@set ([^ ]+) (.*)/)
{
$set{$1} = $2;
$_ = <>;
}
elsif (/^\@UNREVISED/)
{
print "\@quotation\n";
print "\@emph{(This message will disappear, once this node is revised.)}\n";
print "\@end quotation\n";
$_ = <>;
}
else
{
while (/\@value{([^\}]*)}/)
{
if (defined $set{$1})
{
$_ = "$`$set{$1}$'";
}
else
{
$_ = "$`\@strong{<UNDEFINED>}$1\@strong{</UNDEFINED>}$'";
}
}
while (/\@FIXME-?([a-z]*)\{/)
{
$tag = $1 eq '' ? 'fixme' : $1;
$tag =~ y/a-z/A-Z/;
print "$`\@strong{<$tag>}";
$_ = $';
$level = 1;
while ($level > 0)
{
if (/([{}])/)
{
if ($1 eq '{')
{
$level++;
print "$`\{";
$_ = $';
}
elsif ($level > 1)
{
$level--;
print "$`\}";
$_ = $';
}
else
{
$level = 0;
print "$`\@strong{</$tag>}";
$_ = $';
}
}
else
{
print;
$_ = <>;
}
}
}
print;
$_ = <>;
}
}
exit 0;

132
doc/dumpdir.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,132 @@
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
@c Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c Written by Sergey Poznyakoff
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
Incremental archives keep information about contents of each
dumped directory in special data blocks called @dfn{dumpdirs}.
Dumpdir is a sequence of entries of the following form:
@smallexample
@var{C} @var{filename} \0
@end smallexample
@noindent
where @var{C} is one of the @dfn{control codes} described below,
@var{filename} is the name of the file @var{C} operates upon, and
@samp{\0} represents a nul character (ASCII 0). The white space
characters were added for readability, real dumpdirs do not contain
them.
Each dumpdir ends with a single nul character.
The following table describes control codes and their meanings:
@table @samp
@item Y
@var{filename} is contained in the archive.
@item N
@var{filename} was present in the directory at the time the archive
was made, yet it was not dumped to the archive, because it had not
changed since the last backup.
@item D
@var{filename} is a directory.
@item R
This code requests renaming of the @var{filename} to the name
specified with the @samp{T} command, that immediately follows it.
@item T
Specify target file name for @samp{R} command (see below).
@item X
Specify @dfn{temporary directory} name for a rename operation (see below).
@end table
Codes @samp{Y}, @samp{N} and @samp{D} require @var{filename} argument
to be a relative file name to the directory this dumpdir describes,
whereas codes @samp{R}, @samp{T} and @samp{X} require their argument
to be an absolute file name.
The three codes @samp{R}, @samp{T} and @samp{X} specify a
@dfn{renaming operation}. In the simplest case it is:
@smallexample
R@file{source}\0T@file{dest}\0
@end smallexample
@noindent
which means ``rename file @file{source} to file @file{dest}''.
However, there are cases that require using a @dfn{temporary
directory}. For example, consider the following scenario:
@enumerate 1
@item
Previous run dumped a directory @file{foo} which contained the
following three directories:
@smallexample
a
b
c
@end smallexample
@item
They were renamed @emph{cyclically}, so that:
@example
@file{a} became @file{b}
@file{b} became @file{c}
@file{c} became @file{a}
@end example
@item
New incremental dump was made.
@end enumerate
This case cannot be handled by three successive renames, since
renaming @file{a} to @file{b} will destroy the existing directory.
To correctly process it, @GNUTAR{} needs a temporary directory, so
it creates the following dumpdir (newlines have been added for
readability):
@smallexample
@group
Xfoo\0
Rfoo/a\0T\0
Rfoo/b\0Tfoo/c\0
Rfoo/c\0Tfoo/a\0
R\0Tfoo/a\0
@end group
@end smallexample
The first command, @samp{Xfoo\0}, instructs the extractor to create a
temporary directory in the directory @file{foo}. Second command,
@samp{Rfoo/aT\0}, says ``rename file @file{foo/a} to the temporary
directory that has just been created'' (empty file name after a
command means use temporary directory). Third and fourth commands
work as usual, and, finally, the last command, @samp{R\0Tfoo/a\0}
tells tar to rename the temporary directory to @file{foo/a}.
The exact placement of a dumpdir in the archive depends on the
archive format (@pxref{Formats}):
@itemize
@item PAX archives
In PAX archives, dumpdir is stored in the extended header of the
corresponding directory, in variable @code{GNU.dumpdir}.
@item GNU and old GNU archives
These formats implement special header type @samp{D}, which is similar
to ustar header @samp{5} (directory), except that it precedes a data
block containing the dumpdir.
@end itemize
@c End of dumpdir.texi

View File

@@ -7,7 +7,7 @@
@display
Copyright @copyright{} 2000,2001,2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA
51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.

125
doc/gendocs_template Executable file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,125 @@
<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8" ?>
<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
"http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
<!-- $Id: gendocs_template,v 1.5 2007/10/30 14:58:52 gray Exp $ -->
<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en">
<head>
<title>%%TITLE%% - GNU Project - Free Software Foundation (FSF)</title>
<meta http-equiv="content-type" content='text/html; charset=utf-8' />
<link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="/gnu.css" />
<link rev="made" href="mailto:gray@gnu.org" />
<link rel="icon" type="image/png" href="/graphics/gnu-head-icon.png" />
</head>
<!-- This document is in XML, and xhtml 1.0 -->
<!-- Please make sure to properly nest your tags -->
<!-- and ensure that your final document validates -->
<!-- consistent with W3C xhtml 1.0 and CSS standards -->
<!-- See validator.w3.org -->
<body>
<h3>%%TITLE%%</h3>
<address>Free Software Foundation</address>
<address>last updated %%DATE%%</address>
<p>
<a href="/graphics/gnu-head.jpg">
<img src="/graphics/gnu-head-sm.jpg"
alt=" [image of the head of a GNU] "
width="129" height="122" />
</a>
</p>
<hr />
<p>The manual for %%PACKAGE%% is available in the following formats:</p>
<ul>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html">HTML
(%%HTML_MONO_SIZE%%K bytes)</a> - entirely on one web page.</li>
<li><a href="html_node/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
node.</li>
%%IF HTML_SECTION%%
<li><a href="html_section/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
section.</li>
%%ENDIF HTML_SECTION%%
%%IF HTML_CHAPTER%%
<li><a href="html_chapter/index.html">HTML</a> - with one web page per
chapter.</li>
%%ENDIF HTML_CHAPTER%%
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html.gz">HTML compressed
(%%HTML_MONO_GZ_SIZE%%K gzipped characters)</a> - entirely on
one web page.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_node.tar.gz">HTML compressed
(%%HTML_NODE_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
with one web page per node.</li>
%%IF HTML_SECTION%%
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_section.tar.gz">HTML compressed
(%%HTML_SECTION_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
with one web page per section.</li>
%%ENDIF HTML_SECTION%%
%%IF HTML_CHAPTER%%
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.html_chapter.tar.gz">HTML compressed
(%%HTML_CHAPTER_TGZ_SIZE%%K gzipped tar file)</a> -
with one web page per chapter.</li>
%%ENDIF HTML_CHAPTER%%
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.info.tar.gz">Info document
(%%INFO_TGZ_SIZE%%K characters gzipped tar file)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.txt">ASCII text
(%%ASCII_SIZE%%K characters)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.txt.gz">ASCII text compressed
(%%ASCII_GZ_SIZE%%K gzipped characters)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.dvi.gz">TeX dvi file
(%%DVI_GZ_SIZE%%K characters gzipped)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.ps.gz">PostScript file
(%%PS_GZ_SIZE%%K characters gzipped)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.pdf">PDF file
(%%PDF_SIZE%%K characters)</a>.</li>
<li><a href="%%PACKAGE%%.texi.tar.gz">Texinfo source
(%%TEXI_TGZ_SIZE%%K characters gzipped tar file)</a></li>
</ul>
<p>(This page generated by the <a
href="%%SCRIPTURL%%">%%SCRIPTNAME%%</a> script.)
</p>
<p>
<a href="http://validator.w3.org/check?uri=referer"><img
src="http://www.w3.org/Icons/valid-xhtml10"
alt="Valid XHTML 1.0!" height="31" width="88" /></a>
</p>
<div class="copyright">
<p>
Return to the <a href="/home.html">GNU Project home page</a>.
</p>
<p>
Please send FSF &amp; GNU inquiries to
<a href="mailto:gnu@gnu.org"><em>gnu@gnu.org</em></a>.
There are also <a href="/home.html#ContactInfo">other ways to contact</a>
the FSF.
<br />
Please send broken links and other corrections (or suggestions) to
<a href="mailto:webmasters@gnu.org"><em>webmasters@gnu.org</em></a>.
</p>
<p>
Copyright (C) 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02111, USA
<br />
Verbatim copying and distribution of this entire article is
permitted in any medium, provided this notice is preserved.
</p>
<p>
Updated:
<!-- timestamp start -->
$Date: 2007/10/30 14:58:52 $ $Author: gray $
<!-- timestamp end -->
</p>
</div>
</body>
</html>

View File

@@ -1,79 +0,0 @@
<!-- X-URL: %BASE_URL% -->
<!-- Date: %DATE% -->
<!DOCTYPE HTML PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD HTML 4.01 Transitional//EN">
<HTML>
<HEAD>
<TITLE>%PACKAGE_NAME% Reference Manual - Table of Contents - GNU Project - Free Software Foundation (FSF)</TITLE>
<LINK REV="made" HREF="mailto:gray@gnu.org">
<BASE HREF="%BASE_URL%">
<META HTTP-EQUIV="Content-Type" CONTENT="text/html; CHARSET=US-ASCII">
<META NAME="keywords" CONTENT="tar rmt">
</HEAD>
<BODY BGCOLOR="#FFFFFF" TEXT="#000000" LINK="#1F00FF" ALINK="#FF0000" VLINK="#9900DD">
<H1>%PACKAGE_NAME% Reference Manual - Table of Contents</H1>
<ADDRESS>Free Software Foundation</ADDRESS>
<ADDRESS>last updated %UPDATED%</ADDRESS>
<P>
<A HREF="/graphics/gnu-head-sm.jpg"><IMG SRC="/graphics/gnu-head-sm.jpg"
ALT=" [image of the Head of a GNU] "
WIDTH="129" HEIGHT="122">&#32;(jpeg 7k)</A>
<A HREF="/graphics/gnu-head.jpg">(jpeg 21k)</A>
<A HREF="/philosophy/gif.html">no gifs due to patent problems</A>
<P>
<P>
<P><HR><P>
<P>
This manual is available in the following formats:
<P>
<UL>
<LI>formatted in <A HREF="html_mono/%PACKAGE%.html">HTML
(%HTML_SIZE%K characters)</A> entirely on one web page.</LI>
<LI> formatted in <a href="html_chapter/%PACKAGE%_toc.html">HTML</a>
with one web page per chapter.</LI>
<LI> formatted in <a href="html_node/%PACKAGE%_toc.html">HTML</a>
with one web page per node.</LI>
<LI>formatted as an
<A HREF="other/%PACKAGE%.info.tar.gz">Info document (%INFO_TAR_GZ_SIZE%K characters
gzipped tar file)</A>.</LI>
<LI>formatted as
<A HREF="other/%PACKAGE%.text">ASCII text (%TEXT_SIZE%K characters)</A>.</LI>
<LI>formatted as
<A HREF="other/%PACKAGE%.dvi.gz">a TeX dvi file (%DVI_GZ_SIZE%K characters
gzipped)</A>.</LI>
<LI>formatted as
<A href="other/%PACKAGE%.ps.gz">a PostScript file (%PS_GZ_SIZE%K characters
gzipped)</A>.</LI>
<LI>formatted as
<A href="other/%PACKAGE%.pdf.gz">a PDF file (%PDF_GZ_SIZE%K characters
gzipped)</A>.</LI>
<LI>the original
<A HREF="other/%PACKAGE%.texi.tar.gz">Texinfo source (%TEXI_TAR_GZ_SIZE%K characters
gzipped tar file)</A></LI>
</UL>
<P>
<HR>
Return to <A HREF="/home.html">GNU's home page</A>.
<P>
Send FSF &amp; GNU inquiries &amp; questions to
<A HREF="mailto:gnu@gnu.org"><EM>gnu@gnu.org</EM></A>.
Other <A HREF="/home.html#ContactInfo">ways to contact</A> the FSF.
<P>
Comments on these web pages to
<A HREF="mailto:webmasters@www.gnu.org"><EM>webmasters@www.gnu.org</EM></A>,
send other questions to
<A HREF="mailto:gnu@gnu.org"><EM>gnu@gnu.org</EM></A>.
<P>
Copyright (C) 1997, 1998 Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111, USA
<P>
Verbatim copying and distribution of this entire article is
permitted in any medium, provided this notice is preserved.<HR>
</BODY>
</HTML>
<!--
Local Variables:
mode: html
end:
-->

333
doc/intern.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,333 @@
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
@c Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
@menu
* Standard:: Basic Tar Format
* Extensions:: @acronym{GNU} Extensions to the Archive Format
* Sparse Formats:: Storing Sparse Files
* Snapshot Files::
* Dumpdir::
@end menu
@node Standard
@unnumberedsec Basic Tar Format
@UNREVISED
While an archive may contain many files, the archive itself is a
single ordinary file. Like any other file, an archive file can be
written to a storage device such as a tape or disk, sent through a
pipe or over a network, saved on the active file system, or even
stored in another archive. An archive file is not easy to read or
manipulate without using the @command{tar} utility or Tar mode in
@acronym{GNU} Emacs.
Physically, an archive consists of a series of file entries terminated
by an end-of-archive entry, which consists of two 512 blocks of zero
bytes. A file
entry usually describes one of the files in the archive (an
@dfn{archive member}), and consists of a file header and the contents
of the file. File headers contain file names and statistics, checksum
information which @command{tar} uses to detect file corruption, and
information about file types.
Archives are permitted to have more than one member with the same
member name. One way this situation can occur is if more than one
version of a file has been stored in the archive. For information
about adding new versions of a file to an archive, see @ref{update}.
In addition to entries describing archive members, an archive may
contain entries which @command{tar} itself uses to store information.
@xref{label}, for an example of such an archive entry.
A @command{tar} archive file contains a series of blocks. Each block
contains @code{BLOCKSIZE} bytes. Although this format may be thought
of as being on magnetic tape, other media are often used.
Each file archived is represented by a header block which describes
the file, followed by zero or more blocks which give the contents
of the file. At the end of the archive file there are two 512-byte blocks
filled with binary zeros as an end-of-file marker. A reasonable system
should write such end-of-file marker at the end of an archive, but
must not assume that such a block exists when reading an archive. In
particular @GNUTAR{} always issues a warning if it does not encounter it.
The blocks may be @dfn{blocked} for physical I/O operations.
Each record of @var{n} blocks (where @var{n} is set by the
@option{--blocking-factor=@var{512-size}} (@option{-b @var{512-size}}) option to @command{tar}) is written with a single
@w{@samp{write ()}} operation. On magnetic tapes, the result of
such a write is a single record. When writing an archive,
the last record of blocks should be written at the full size, with
blocks after the zero block containing all zeros. When reading
an archive, a reasonable system should properly handle an archive
whose last record is shorter than the rest, or which contains garbage
records after a zero block.
The header block is defined in C as follows. In the @GNUTAR{}
distribution, this is part of file @file{src/tar.h}:
@smallexample
@include header.texi
@end smallexample
All characters in header blocks are represented by using 8-bit
characters in the local variant of ASCII. Each field within the
structure is contiguous; that is, there is no padding used within
the structure. Each character on the archive medium is stored
contiguously.
Bytes representing the contents of files (after the header block
of each file) are not translated in any way and are not constrained
to represent characters in any character set. The @command{tar} format
does not distinguish text files from binary files, and no translation
of file contents is performed.
The @code{name}, @code{linkname}, @code{magic}, @code{uname}, and
@code{gname} are null-terminated character strings. All other fields
are zero-filled octal numbers in ASCII. Each numeric field of width
@var{w} contains @var{w} minus 1 digits, and a null.
The @code{name} field is the file name of the file, with directory names
(if any) preceding the file name, separated by slashes.
@FIXME{how big a name before field overflows?}
The @code{mode} field provides nine bits specifying file permissions
and three bits to specify the Set @acronym{UID}, Set @acronym{GID}, and Save Text
(@dfn{sticky}) modes. Values for these bits are defined above.
When special permissions are required to create a file with a given
mode, and the user restoring files from the archive does not hold such
permissions, the mode bit(s) specifying those special permissions
are ignored. Modes which are not supported by the operating system
restoring files from the archive will be ignored. Unsupported modes
should be faked up when creating or updating an archive; e.g., the
group permission could be copied from the @emph{other} permission.
The @code{uid} and @code{gid} fields are the numeric user and group
@acronym{ID} of the file owners, respectively. If the operating system does
not support numeric user or group @acronym{ID}s, these fields should
be ignored.
The @code{size} field is the size of the file in bytes; linked files
are archived with this field specified as zero.
The @code{mtime} field is the data modification time of the file at
the time it was archived. It is the ASCII representation of the octal
value of the last time the file's contents were modified, represented
as an integer number of
seconds since January 1, 1970, 00:00 Coordinated Universal Time.
The @code{chksum} field is the ASCII representation of the octal value
of the simple sum of all bytes in the header block. Each 8-bit
byte in the header is added to an unsigned integer, initialized to
zero, the precision of which shall be no less than seventeen bits.
When calculating the checksum, the @code{chksum} field is treated as
if it were all blanks.
The @code{typeflag} field specifies the type of file archived. If a
particular implementation does not recognize or permit the specified
type, the file will be extracted as if it were a regular file. As this
action occurs, @command{tar} issues a warning to the standard error.
The @code{atime} and @code{ctime} fields are used in making incremental
backups; they store, respectively, the particular file's access and
status change times.
The @code{offset} is used by the @option{--multi-volume} (@option{-M}) option, when
making a multi-volume archive. The offset is number of bytes into
the file that we need to restart at to continue the file on the next
tape, i.e., where we store the location that a continued file is
continued at.
The following fields were added to deal with sparse files. A file
is @dfn{sparse} if it takes in unallocated blocks which end up being
represented as zeros, i.e., no useful data. A test to see if a file
is sparse is to look at the number blocks allocated for it versus the
number of characters in the file; if there are fewer blocks allocated
for the file than would normally be allocated for a file of that
size, then the file is sparse. This is the method @command{tar} uses to
detect a sparse file, and once such a file is detected, it is treated
differently from non-sparse files.
Sparse files are often @code{dbm} files, or other database-type files
which have data at some points and emptiness in the greater part of
the file. Such files can appear to be very large when an @samp{ls
-l} is done on them, when in truth, there may be a very small amount
of important data contained in the file. It is thus undesirable
to have @command{tar} think that it must back up this entire file, as
great quantities of room are wasted on empty blocks, which can lead
to running out of room on a tape far earlier than is necessary.
Thus, sparse files are dealt with so that these empty blocks are
not written to the tape. Instead, what is written to the tape is a
description, of sorts, of the sparse file: where the holes are, how
big the holes are, and how much data is found at the end of the hole.
This way, the file takes up potentially far less room on the tape,
and when the file is extracted later on, it will look exactly the way
it looked beforehand. The following is a description of the fields
used to handle a sparse file:
The @code{sp} is an array of @code{struct sparse}. Each @code{struct
sparse} contains two 12-character strings which represent an offset
into the file and a number of bytes to be written at that offset.
The offset is absolute, and not relative to the offset in preceding
array element.
The header can hold four of these @code{struct sparse} at the moment;
if more are needed, they are not stored in the header.
The @code{isextended} flag is set when an @code{extended_header}
is needed to deal with a file. Note that this means that this flag
can only be set when dealing with a sparse file, and it is only set
in the event that the description of the file will not fit in the
allotted room for sparse structures in the header. In other words,
an extended_header is needed.
The @code{extended_header} structure is used for sparse files which
need more sparse structures than can fit in the header. The header can
fit 4 such structures; if more are needed, the flag @code{isextended}
gets set and the next block is an @code{extended_header}.
Each @code{extended_header} structure contains an array of 21
sparse structures, along with a similar @code{isextended} flag
that the header had. There can be an indeterminate number of such
@code{extended_header}s to describe a sparse file.
@table @asis
@item @code{REGTYPE}
@itemx @code{AREGTYPE}
These flags represent a regular file. In order to be compatible
with older versions of @command{tar}, a @code{typeflag} value of
@code{AREGTYPE} should be silently recognized as a regular file.
New archives should be created using @code{REGTYPE}. Also, for
backward compatibility, @command{tar} treats a regular file whose name
ends with a slash as a directory.
@item @code{LNKTYPE}
This flag represents a file linked to another file, of any type,
previously archived. Such files are identified in Unix by each
file having the same device and inode number. The linked-to name is
specified in the @code{linkname} field with a trailing null.
@item @code{SYMTYPE}
This represents a symbolic link to another file. The linked-to name
is specified in the @code{linkname} field with a trailing null.
@item @code{CHRTYPE}
@itemx @code{BLKTYPE}
These represent character special files and block special files
respectively. In this case the @code{devmajor} and @code{devminor}
fields will contain the major and minor device numbers respectively.
Operating systems may map the device specifications to their own
local specification, or may ignore the entry.
@item @code{DIRTYPE}
This flag specifies a directory or sub-directory. The directory
name in the @code{name} field should end with a slash. On systems where
disk allocation is performed on a directory basis, the @code{size} field
will contain the maximum number of bytes (which may be rounded to
the nearest disk block allocation unit) which the directory may
hold. A @code{size} field of zero indicates no such limiting. Systems
which do not support limiting in this manner should ignore the
@code{size} field.
@item @code{FIFOTYPE}
This specifies a FIFO special file. Note that the archiving of a
FIFO file archives the existence of this file and not its contents.
@item @code{CONTTYPE}
This specifies a contiguous file, which is the same as a normal
file except that, in operating systems which support it, all its
space is allocated contiguously on the disk. Operating systems
which do not allow contiguous allocation should silently treat this
type as a normal file.
@item @code{A} @dots{} @code{Z}
These are reserved for custom implementations. Some of these are
used in the @acronym{GNU} modified format, as described below.
@end table
Other values are reserved for specification in future revisions of
the P1003 standard, and should not be used by any @command{tar} program.
The @code{magic} field indicates that this archive was output in
the P1003 archive format. If this field contains @code{TMAGIC},
the @code{uname} and @code{gname} fields will contain the ASCII
representation of the owner and group of the file respectively.
If found, the user and group @acronym{ID}s are used rather than the values in
the @code{uid} and @code{gid} fields.
For references, see ISO/IEC 9945-1:1990 or IEEE Std 1003.1-1990, pages
169-173 (section 10.1) for @cite{Archive/Interchange File Format}; and
IEEE Std 1003.2-1992, pages 380-388 (section 4.48) and pages 936-940
(section E.4.48) for @cite{pax - Portable archive interchange}.
@node Extensions
@unnumberedsec @acronym{GNU} Extensions to the Archive Format
@UNREVISED
The @acronym{GNU} format uses additional file types to describe new types of
files in an archive. These are listed below.
@table @code
@item GNUTYPE_DUMPDIR
@itemx 'D'
This represents a directory and a list of files created by the
@option{--incremental} (@option{-G}) option. The @code{size} field gives the total
size of the associated list of files. Each file name is preceded by
either a @samp{Y} (the file should be in this archive) or an @samp{N}.
(The file is a directory, or is not stored in the archive.) Each file
name is terminated by a null. There is an additional null after the
last file name.
@item GNUTYPE_MULTIVOL
@itemx 'M'
This represents a file continued from another volume of a multi-volume
archive created with the @option{--multi-volume} (@option{-M}) option. The original
type of the file is not given here. The @code{size} field gives the
maximum size of this piece of the file (assuming the volume does
not end before the file is written out). The @code{offset} field
gives the offset from the beginning of the file where this part of
the file begins. Thus @code{size} plus @code{offset} should equal
the original size of the file.
@item GNUTYPE_SPARSE
@itemx 'S'
This flag indicates that we are dealing with a sparse file. Note
that archiving a sparse file requires special operations to find
holes in the file, which mark the positions of these holes, along
with the number of bytes of data to be found after the hole.
@item GNUTYPE_VOLHDR
@itemx 'V'
This file type is used to mark the volume header that was given with
the @option{--label=@var{archive-label}} (@option{-V @var{archive-label}}) option when the archive was created. The @code{name}
field contains the @code{name} given after the @option{--label=@var{archive-label}} (@option{-V @var{archive-label}}) option.
The @code{size} field is zero. Only the first file in each volume
of an archive should have this type.
@end table
You may have trouble reading a @acronym{GNU} format archive on a
non-@acronym{GNU} system if the options @option{--incremental} (@option{-G}),
@option{--multi-volume} (@option{-M}), @option{--sparse} (@option{-S}), or @option{--label=@var{archive-label}} (@option{-V @var{archive-label}}) were
used when writing the archive. In general, if @command{tar} does not
use the @acronym{GNU}-added fields of the header, other versions of
@command{tar} should be able to read the archive. Otherwise, the
@command{tar} program will give an error, the most likely one being a
checksum error.
@node Sparse Formats
@unnumberedsec Storing Sparse Files
@include sparse.texi
@node Snapshot Files
@unnumberedsec Format of the Incremental Snapshot Files
@include snapshot.texi
@node Dumpdir
@unnumberedsec Dumpdir
@include dumpdir.texi

91
doc/mastermenu.el Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
;;; mastermenu.el --- Redefinition of texinfo-master-menu-list
;; Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
;; Author: Sergey Poznyakoff
;; Maintainer: bug-tar@gnu.org
;; Keywords: maint, tex, docs
;; This file is part of GNU tar documentation suite
;; This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
;; it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
;; the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
;; any later version.
;; This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
;; but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
;; MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
;; GNU General Public License for more details.
;; You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
;; along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
;; Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
;;; Commentary:
;; This file redefines texinfo-master-menu-list so that it takes into
;; account included files.
;; Known bugs: @menu without previous sectioning command will inherit
;; documentation string from the previous menu. However, since such a
;; menu is illegal in a texinfo file, we can live with it.
(require 'texinfo)
(require 'texnfo-upd)
(defun texinfo-master-menu-list-recursive (title)
"Auxiliary function used by `texinfo-master-menu-list'."
(save-excursion
(let (master-menu-list)
(while (re-search-forward "\\(^@menu\\|^@include\\)" nil t)
(cond
((string= (match-string 0) "@include")
(skip-chars-forward " \t")
(let ((included-name (let ((start (point)))
(end-of-line)
(skip-chars-backward " \t")
(buffer-substring start (point)))))
(end-of-line)
(let ((prev-title (texinfo-copy-menu-title)))
(save-excursion
(set-buffer (find-file-noselect included-name))
(setq master-menu-list
(append (texinfo-master-menu-list-recursive prev-title)
master-menu-list))))))
(t
(setq master-menu-list
(cons (list
(texinfo-copy-menu)
(let ((menu-title (texinfo-copy-menu-title)))
(if (string= menu-title "")
title
menu-title)))
master-menu-list)))))
master-menu-list)))
(defun texinfo-master-menu-list ()
"Return a list of menu entries and header lines for the master menu,
recursing into included files.
Start with the menu for chapters and indices and then find each
following menu and the title of the node preceding that menu.
The master menu list has this form:
\(\(\(... \"entry-1-2\" \"entry-1\"\) \"title-1\"\)
\(\(... \"entry-2-2\" \"entry-2-1\"\) \"title-2\"\)
...\)
However, there does not need to be a title field."
(reverse (texinfo-master-menu-list-recursive "")))
(defun make-master-menu ()
"Create master menu in the first Emacs argument."
(find-file (car command-line-args-left))
(texinfo-master-menu nil)
(save-buffer))
;;; mastermenu.el ends here

99
doc/rendition.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
@c This is part of GNU tar manual.
@c Copyright (C) 1992, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001,
@c 2003, 2004, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c See file tar.texi for copying conditions.
@c This file contains support for 'renditions' by Fran@,{c}ois Pinard
@c I extended it by adding a FIXME_FOOTNOTE variable, which controls
@c whether FIXME information should be placed in footnotes or
@c inlined. --gray
@c ======================================================================
@c This document has three levels of rendition: PUBLISH, DISTRIB or PROOF,
@c as decided by @set symbols. The PUBLISH rendition does not show
@c notes or marks asking for revision. Most users will prefer having more
@c information, even if this information is not fully revised for adequacy,
@c so DISTRIB is the default for distributions. The PROOF rendition
@c show all marks to the point of ugliness, but is nevertheless useful to
@c those working on the manual itself.
@c ======================================================================
@c Set this symbol if you wish FIXMEs to appear in footnotes, instead
@c of being inserted into the text.
@c @set PROOF_FOOTNOTED
@ifclear PUBLISH
@ifclear DISTRIB
@ifclear PROOF
@set DISTRIB
@end ifclear
@end ifclear
@end ifclear
@ifset PUBLISH
@set RENDITION The book, version
@end ifset
@ifset DISTRIB
@set RENDITION FTP release, version
@end ifset
@ifset PROOF
@set RENDITION Proof reading version
@end ifset
@c Output marks for nodes needing revision, but not in PUBLISH rendition.
@macro UNREVISED
@ifclear PUBLISH
@quotation
@emph{(This message will disappear, once this node revised.)}
@end quotation
@end ifclear
@end macro
@c Output various FIXME information only in PROOF rendition.
@macro FIXME{string}
@ifset PROOF
@ifset PROOF_FOOTNOTED
@footnote{@strong{FIXME:} \string\}
@end ifset
@ifclear PROOF_FOOTNOTED
@cartouche
@strong{<FIXME>} \string\ @strong{</>}
@end cartouche
@end ifclear
@end ifset
@end macro
@macro FIXME-ref{string}
@ifset PROOF
@strong{<REF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
@end ifset
@ifclear PROOF
@cite{\string\}
@end ifclear
@end macro
@macro FIXME-pxref{string}
@ifset PROOF
See @strong{<PXREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
@end ifset
@ifclear PROOF
See @cite{\string\}
@end ifclear
@end macro
@macro FIXME-xref{string}
@ifset PROOF
See @strong{<XREF>} \string\ @strong{</>}
@end ifset
@ifclear PROOF
See @cite{\string\}
@end ifclear
@end macro
@c End of rendition.texi

141
doc/snapshot.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,141 @@
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
@c Copyright (C) 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c Written by Sergey Poznyakoff
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
A @dfn{snapshot file} (or @dfn{directory file}) is created during
incremental backups (@pxref{Incremental Dumps}). It
contains the status of the file system at the time of the dump and is
used to determine which files were modified since the last backup.
@GNUTAR{} version @value{VERSION} supports three snapshot file
formats. The first format, called @dfn{format 0}, is the one used by
@GNUTAR{} versions up to 1.15.1. The second format, called @dfn{format
1} is an extended version of this format, that contains more metadata
and allows for further extensions. It was used by version
1.15.1. Starting from version 1.16 and up to @value{VERSION}, the
@dfn{format 2} is used.
@GNUTAR{} is able to read all three formats, but will create
snapshots only in format 2.
This appendix describes all three formats in detail.
@enumerate 0
@cindex format 0, snapshot file
@cindex snapshot file, format 0
@item
@samp{Format 0} snapshot file begins with a line containing a
decimal number that represents a @acronym{UNIX} timestamp of the
beginning of the last archivation. This line is followed by directory
metadata descriptions, one per line. Each description has the
following format:
@smallexample
@var{nfs}@var{dev} @var{inode} @var{name}
@end smallexample
@noindent
where:
@table @var
@item nfs
A single plus character (@samp{+}), if this directory is located on
an @acronym{NFS}-mounted partition, or a single space otherwise;
@item dev
Device number of the directory;
@item inode
I-node number of the directory;
@item name
Name of the directory. Any special characters (white-space,
backslashes, etc.) are quoted.
@end table
@cindex format 1, snapshot file
@cindex snapshot file, format 1
@item
@samp{Format 1} snapshot file begins with a line specifying the
format of the file. This line has the following structure:
@smallexample
@samp{GNU tar-}@var{tar-version}@samp{-}@var{incr-format-version}
@end smallexample
@noindent
where @var{tar-version} is the version number of @GNUTAR{}
implementation that created this snapshot, and
@var{incr-format-version} is the version number of the snapshot format
(in this case @samp{1}).
Next line contains two decimal numbers, representing the
time of the last backup. First number is the number of seconds, the
second one is the number of nanoseconds, since the beginning of the
epoch.
Lines that follow contain directory metadata, one line per
directory. Each line is formatted as follows:
@smallexample
[@var{nfs}]@var{mtime-sec} @var{mtime-nsec} @var{dev} @var{inode} @var{name}
@end smallexample
@noindent
where @var{mtime-sec} and @var{mtime-nsec} represent last
modification time of this directory with nanosecond precision;
@var{nfs}, @var{dev}, @var{inode} and @var{name} have the same meaning
as with @samp{format 0}.
@cindex format 2, snapshot file
@cindex snapshot file, format 2
@item
@FIXME{}
A snapshot file begins with a format identifier, as described for
version 1, e.g.:
@smallexample
GNU tar-@value{VERSION}-2
@end smallexample
This line is followed by newline. Rest of file consists of
records, separated by null (@acronym{ASCII} 0)
characters. Thus, in contrast to the previous formats, format 2
snapshot is a binary file.
First two records are decimal numbers, representing the
time of the last backup. First number is the number of seconds, the
second one is the number of nanoseconds, since the beginning of the
epoch. These are followed by arbitrary number of directory records.
Each @dfn{directory record} contains a set of metadata describing a
particular directory. Parts of a directory record are delimited with
@acronym{ASCII} 0 characters. The following table describes each
part. The @dfn{Number} type in this table stands for a decimal number
in @acronym{ASCII} notation.
@multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.2 0.6
@headitem Field @tab Type @tab Description
@item nfs @tab Character @tab @samp{1} if the directory is located on
an @acronym{NFS}-mounted partition, or @samp{0} otherwise;
@item mtime-sec @tab Number @tab Modification time, seconds;
@item mtime-nano @tab Number @tab Modification time, nanoseconds;
@item dev-no @tab Number @tab Device number;
@item i-no @tab Number @tab I-node number;
@item name @tab String @tab Directory name; In contrast to the
previous versions it is not quoted.
@item contents @tab Dumpdir @tab Contents of the directory;
@xref{Dumpdir}, for a description of its format.
@item
@end multitable
Dumpdirs stored in snapshot files contain only records of types
@samp{Y}, @samp{N} and @samp{D}.
@end enumerate
@c End of snapshot.texi

235
doc/sparse.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,235 @@
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
@c Copyright (C) 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
@cindex sparse formats
@cindex sparse versions
The notion of sparse file, and the ways of handling it from the point
of view of @GNUTAR{} user have been described in detail in
@ref{sparse}. This chapter describes the internal format @GNUTAR{}
uses to store such files.
The support for sparse files in @GNUTAR{} has a long history. The
earliest version featuring this support that I was able to find was 1.09,
released in November, 1990. The format introduced back then is called
@dfn{old GNU} sparse format and in spite of the fact that its design
contained many flaws, it was the only format @GNUTAR{} supported
until version 1.14 (May, 2004), which introduced initial support for
sparse archives in @acronym{PAX} archives (@pxref{posix}). This
format was not free from design flows, either and it was subsequently
improved in versions 1.15.2 (November, 2005) and 1.15.92 (June,
2006).
In addition to GNU sparse format, @GNUTAR{} is able to read and
extract sparse files archived by @command{star}.
The following subsections describe each format in detail.
@menu
* Old GNU Format::
* PAX 0:: PAX Format, Versions 0.0 and 0.1
* PAX 1:: PAX Format, Version 1.0
@end menu
@node Old GNU Format
@appendixsubsec Old GNU Format
@cindex sparse formats, Old GNU
@cindex Old GNU sparse format
The format introduced some time around 1990 (v. 1.09). It was
designed on top of standard @code{ustar} headers in such an
unfortunate way that some of its fields overwrote fields required by
POSIX.
An old GNU sparse header is designated by type @samp{S}
(@code{GNUTYPE_SPARSE}) and has the following layout:
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.20 0.40
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Name @tab Data type @tab Contents
@item 0 @tab 345 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
@item 345 @tab 12 @tab atime @tab Number @tab @code{atime} of the file.
@item 357 @tab 12 @tab ctime @tab Number @tab @code{ctime} of the file .
@item 369 @tab 12 @tab offset @tab Number @tab For
multivolume archives: the offset of the start of this volume.
@item 381 @tab 4 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
@item 385 @tab 1 @tab @tab N/A @tab Not used.
@item 386 @tab 96 @tab sp @tab @code{sparse_header} @tab (4 entries) File map.
@item 482 @tab 1 @tab isextended @tab Bool @tab @code{1} if an
extension sparse header follows, @code{0} otherwise.
@item 483 @tab 12 @tab realsize @tab Number @tab Real size of the file.
@end multitable
Each of @code{sparse_header} object at offset 386 describes a single
data chunk. It has the following structure:
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.60
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Data type @tab Contents
@item 0 @tab 12 @tab Number @tab Offset of the
beginning of the chunk.
@item 12 @tab 12 @tab Number @tab Size of the chunk.
@end multitable
If the member contains more than four chunks, the @code{isextended}
field of the header has the value @code{1} and the main header is
followed by one or more @dfn{extension headers}. Each such header has
the following structure:
@multitable @columnfractions 0.10 0.10 0.20 0.20 0.40
@headitem Offset @tab Size @tab Name @tab Data type @tab Contents
@item 0 @tab 21 @tab sp @tab @code{sparse_header} @tab
(21 entires) File map.
@item 504 @tab 1 @tab isextended @tab Bool @tab @code{1} if an
extension sparse header follows, or @code{0} otherwise.
@end multitable
A header with @code{isextended=0} ends the map.
@node PAX 0
@appendixsubsec PAX Format, Versions 0.0 and 0.1
@cindex sparse formats, v.0.0
There are two formats available in this branch. The version @code{0.0}
is the initial version of sparse format used by @command{tar}
versions 1.14--1.15.1. The sparse file map is kept in extended
(@code{x}) PAX header variables:
@table @code
@vrindex GNU.sparse.size, extended header variable
@item GNU.sparse.size
Real size of the stored file
@item GNU.sparse.numblocks
@vrindex GNU.sparse.numblocks, extended header variable
Number of blocks in the sparse map
@item GNU.sparse.offset
@vrindex GNU.sparse.offset, extended header variable
Offset of the data block
@item GNU.sparse.numbytes
@vrindex GNU.sparse.numbytes, extended header variable
Size of the data block
@end table
The latter two variables repeat for each data block, so the overall
structure is like this:
@smallexample
@group
GNU.sparse.size=@var{size}
GNU.sparse.numblocks=@var{numblocks}
repeat @var{numblocks} times
GNU.sparse.offset=@var{offset}
GNU.sparse.numbytes=@var{numbytes}
end repeat
@end group
@end smallexample
This format presented the following two problems:
@enumerate 1
@item
Whereas the POSIX specification allows a variable to appear multiple
times in a header, it requires that only the last occurrence be
meaningful. Thus, multiple occurrences of @code{GNU.sparse.offset} and
@code{GNU.sparse.numbytes} are conflicting with the POSIX specs.
@item
Attempting to extract such archives using a third-party @command{tar}s
results in extraction of sparse files in @emph{compressed form}. If
the @command{tar} implementation in question does not support POSIX
format, it will also extract a file containing extension header
attributes. This file can be used to expand the file to its original
state. However, posix-aware @command{tar}s will usually ignore the
unknown variables, which makes restoring the file more
difficult. @xref{extracting sparse v.0.x, Extraction of sparse
members in v.0.0 format}, for the detailed description of how to
restore such members using non-GNU @command{tar}s.
@end enumerate
@cindex sparse formats, v.0.1
@GNUTAR{} 1.15.2 introduced sparse format version @code{0.1}, which
attempted to solve these problems. As its predecessor, this format
stores sparse map in the extended POSIX header. It retains
@code{GNU.sparse.size} and @code{GNU.sparse.numblocks} variables, but
instead of @code{GNU.sparse.offset}/@code{GNU.sparse.numbytes} pairs
it uses a single variable:
@table @code
@item GNU.sparse.map
@vrindex GNU.sparse.map, extended header variable
Map of non-null data chunks. It is a string consisting of
comma-separated values "@var{offset},@var{size}[,@var{offset-1},@var{size-1}...]"
@end table
To address the 2nd problem, the @code{name} field in @code{ustar}
is replaced with a special name, constructed using the following pattern:
@smallexample
%d/GNUSparseFile.%p/%f
@end smallexample
@vrindex GNU.sparse.name, extended header variable
The real name of the sparse file is stored in the variable
@code{GNU.sparse.name}. Thus, those @command{tar} implementations
that are not aware of GNU extensions will at least extract the files
into separate directories, giving the user a possibility to expand it
afterwards. @xref{extracting sparse v.0.x, Extraction of sparse
members in v.0.1 format}, for the detailed description of how to
restore such members using non-GNU @command{tar}s.
The resulting @code{GNU.sparse.map} string can be @emph{very} long.
Although POSIX does not impose any limit on the length of a @code{x}
header variable, this possibly can confuse some tars.
@node PAX 1
@appendixsubsec PAX Format, Version 1.0
@cindex sparse formats, v.1.0
The version @code{1.0} of sparse format was introduced with @GNUTAR{}
1.15.92. Its main objective was to make the resulting file
extractable with little effort even by non-posix aware @command{tar}
implementations. Starting from this version, the extended header
preceding a sparse member always contains the following variables that
identify the format being used:
@table @code
@item GNU.sparse.major
@vrindex GNU.sparse.major, extended header variable
Major version
@item GNU.sparse.minor
@vrindex GNU.sparse.minor, extended header variable
Minor version
@end table
The @code{name} field in @code{ustar} header contains a special name,
constructed using the following pattern:
@smallexample
%d/GNUSparseFile.%p/%f
@end smallexample
@vrindex GNU.sparse.name, extended header variable, in v.1.0
@vrindex GNU.sparse.realsize, extended header variable
The real name of the sparse file is stored in the variable
@code{GNU.sparse.name}. The real size of the file is stored in the
variable @code{GNU.sparse.realsize}.
The sparse map itself is stored in the file data block, preceding the actual
file data. It consists of a series of octal numbers of arbitrary length, delimited
by newlines. The map is padded with nulls to the nearest block boundary.
The first number gives the number of entries in the map. Following are map entries,
each one consisting of two numbers giving the offset and size of the
data block it describes.
The format is designed in such a way that non-posix aware tars and tars not
supporting @code{GNU.sparse.*} keywords will extract each sparse file
in its condensed form with the file map prepended and will place it
into a separate directory. Then, using a simple program it would be
possible to expand the file to its original form even without @GNUTAR{}.
@xref{Sparse Recovery}, for the detailed information on how to extract
sparse members without @GNUTAR{}.

View File

@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
@c This is part of the paxutils manual.
@c Copyright (C) 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c This file is distributed under GFDL 1.1 or any later version
@c published by the Free Software Foundation.
@cindex Device numbers, changing
@cindex snapshot files, editing
@cindex snapshot files, fixing device numbers
Sometimes device numbers can change after upgrading your kernel
version or recofiguring the harvare. Reportedly this is the case with
some newer @i{Linux} kernels, when using @acronym{LVM}. In majority of
cases this change is unnoticed by the users. However, it influences
@command{tar} incremental backups: the device number is stored in tar
snapshot files (@pxref{Snapshot Files}) and is used to determine whether
the file has changed since the last backup. If the device numbers
change for some reason, the next backup you run will be a full backup.
@pindex tar-snapshot-edit
To minimize the impact in these cases, GNU @command{tar} comes with
the @command{tar-snapshot-edit} utility for inspecting and updating
device numbers in snapshot files. The utility, written by
Dustin J.@: Mitchell, is available from
@uref{http://www.gnu.org/@/software/@/tar/@/utils/@/tar-snapshot-edit.html,
@GNUTAR{} home page}.
To obtain the device numbers used in the snapshot file, run
@smallexample
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit @var{snapfile}}
@end smallexample
@noindent
where @var{snapfile} is the name of the snapshot file (you can supply as many
files as you wish in a single command line ).
To update all occurrences of the given device number in the file, use
@option{-r} option. It takes a single argument of the form
@samp{@var{olddev}-@var{newdev}}, where @var{olddev} is the device number
used in the snapshot file, and @var{newdev} is the corresponding new device
number. Both numbers may be specified in hex (e.g., @samp{0xfe01}),
decimal (e.g., @samp{65025}), or as a major:minor number pair (e.g.,
@samp{254:1}). To change several device numbers at once, specify them
in a single comma-separated list, as in
@option{-r 0x3060-0x4500,0x307-0x4600}.
Before updating the snapshot file, it is a good idea to create a backup
copy of it. This is accomplished by @samp{-b} option. The name of the
backup file is obtained by appending @samp{~} to the original file name.
An example session:
@smallexample
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit /var/backup/snap.a}
file version 2
/tmp/snap: Device 0x0306 occurs 634 times.
$ @kbd{tar-snapshot-edit -b -r 0x0306-0x4500 /var/backup/snap.a}
file version 2
@end smallexample

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

26
doc/texify.sed Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
# Copyright (C) 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
#
# GNU tar is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at
# your option) any later version.
#
# GNU tar is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
# WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
# General Public License for more details.
#
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with GNU tar; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc. 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
1{s,/\*,@comment ,
b
}
2,/.*\*\//{s,\*/,,;s/^/@comment/
b
}
/\/* END \*\//,$d
s/\([{}]\)/@\1/g
s,/\*,&@r{,
s,\*/,}&,

13
doc/untabify.el Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
;;;; Untabify the sources.
;;;; Usage: emacs -batch -l untabify.el [file ...]
(defun global-untabify (buflist)
(mapcar
(lambda (bufname)
(set-buffer (find-file bufname))
(untabify (point-min) (point-max))
(save-buffer)
(kill-buffer (current-buffer)))
buflist))
(global-untabify command-line-args-left)

22
doc/value.texi Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
@c This is part of GNU tar manual.
@c Copyright (C) 1992, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001,
@c 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
@c See file tar.texi for copying conditions.
@macro GNUTAR
@acronym{GNU} @command{tar}
@end macro
@macro xopindex{option,text}
@opindex \option\@r{, \text\}
@end macro
@macro opsummary{option}
@ifclear ANCHOR--\option\
@set ANCHOR--\option\ 1
@anchor{--\option\}
@end ifclear
@xopindex{\option\, summary}
@end macro

59
gnulib.modules Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
# List of gnulib modules needed for GNU tar.
# A module name per line. Empty lines and comments are ignored.
alloca
argmatch
argp
backupfile
closeout
configmake
dirname
error
exclude
exitfail
fileblocks
fnmatch-gnu
fseeko
ftruncate
full-write
getdate
getline
getopt
getpagesize
gettext
gettime
gitlog-to-changelog
hash
human
inttypes
lchown
localcharset
mkdtemp
modechange
obstack
quote
quotearg
rpmatch
safe-read
save-cwd
savedir
setenv
snprintf
stat-time
stdbool
stdint
stpcpy
strdup-posix
strerror
strtol
strtoul
timespec
unlinkdir
unlocked-io
utime
utimens
version-etc-fsf
xalloc
xalloc-die
xgetcwd
xstrtoumax

View File

@@ -1,143 +0,0 @@
.deps
Makefile
Makefile.am
Makefile.in
alloca.c
alloca.h
alloca_.h
allocsa.c
allocsa.h
allocsa.valgrind
argmatch.c
argmatch.h
argp-ba.c
argp-eexst.c
argp-fmtstream.c
argp-fmtstream.h
argp-fs-xinl.c
argp-help.c
argp-namefrob.h
argp-parse.c
argp-pv.c
argp-pvh.c
argp-xinl.c
argp.h
backupfile.c
backupfile.h
basename.c
charset.alias
chown.c
config.charset
dirname.c
dirname.h
error.c
error.h
exclude.c
exclude.h
exit.h
exitfail.c
exitfail.h
fchown-stub.c
fileblocks.c
fnmatch.c
fnmatch.h
fnmatch_.h
fnmatch_loop.c
ftruncate.c
full-write.c
full-write.h
getcwd.c
getcwd.h
getdate.c
getdate.h
getdate.y
getline.c
getline.h
getndelim2.c
getndelim2.h
getopt.c
getopt.h
getopt1.c
getopt_.h
getopt_int.h
getpagesize.h
gettext.h
gettime.c
gettimeofday.c
hash.c
hash.h
human.c
human.h
lchown.c
lchown.h
localcharset.c
localcharset.h
localedir.h
mempcpy.c
mempcpy.h
memset.c
mktime.c
modechange.c
modechange.h
obstack.c
obstack.h
quote.c
quote.h
quotearg.c
quotearg.h
ref-add.sed
ref-add.sin
ref-del.sed
ref-del.sin
rmdir.c
rmt.h
rtapelib.c
safe-read.c
safe-read.h
safe-write.c
safe-write.h
save-cwd.c
save-cwd.h
savedir.c
savedir.h
setenv.c
setenv.h
stat-macros.h
stdbool.h
stdbool_.h
stpcpy.c
stpcpy.h
strcase.h
strcasecmp.c
strchrnul.c
strchrnul.h
stripslash.c
strncasecmp.c
strndup.c
strndup.h
strnlen.c
strtoimax.c
strtol.c
strtoll.c
strtoul.c
strtoull.c
strtoumax.c
sysexit.h
sysexit_.h
sysexits.h
system.h
time_r.c
time_r.h
timespec.h
unlocked-io.h
unsetenv.c
utime.c
xalloc-die.c
xalloc.h
xgetcwd.c
xgetcwd.h
xmalloc.c
xstrtol.c
xstrtol.h
xstrtoul.c
xstrtoumax.c

39
lib/Makefile.am Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
# Makefile for GNU tar library. -*- Makefile -*-
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004,
# 2005, 2006, 2007, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
# (at your option) any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
# with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc.,
# 51 Franklin St, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA
noinst_LIBRARIES=libtar.a
rmt-command.h : Makefile
rm -f $@-t $@
echo "#ifndef DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND" >> $@-t
echo "# define DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND \"$(DEFAULT_RMT_DIR)/`echo rmt | sed '$(transform)'`$(EXEEXT)\"" >> $@-t
echo "#endif" >> $@-t
mv $@-t $@
BUILT_SOURCES = rmt-command.h
CLEANFILES = rmt-command.h rmt-command.h-t
INCLUDES = -I$(top_srcdir)/gnu -I../ -I../gnu
noinst_HEADERS = system.h system-ioctl.h rmt.h paxlib.h stdopen.h
libtar_a_SOURCES = \
paxerror.c paxexit.c paxlib.h paxnames.c \
prepargs.c prepargs.h \
rtapelib.c \
rmt.h \
stdopen.c stdopen.h \
system.h system-ioctl.h

View File

@@ -1,56 +0,0 @@
# Makefile for GNU tar library.
# Copyright (C) 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004
# Free Software Foundation, Inc.
## This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
## it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
## the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
## any later version.
## This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
## but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
## MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
## GNU General Public License for more details.
## You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
## along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
## Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
## 02111-1307, USA.
noinst_LIBRARIES = libtar.a
noinst_HEADERS = system.h localedir.h rmt.h
libtar_a_SOURCES = prepargs.c prepargs.h rtapelib.c
localedir = $(datadir)/locale
DISTCLEANFILES = localedir.h
localedir.h : Makefile
echo '#define LOCALEDIR "$(localedir)"' >$@
echo "#ifndef DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND" >> $@
echo "# define DEFAULT_RMT_COMMAND \"$(DEFAULT_RMT_DIR)/`echo \"rmt\" | sed 's,^.*/,,;$(transform)'`$(EXEEXT)\"" >> $@
echo "#endif" >> $@
rtapelib.o: localedir.h
libtar_a_LIBADD = $(LIBOBJS) $(ALLOCA)
libtar_a_DEPENDENCIES = $(libtar_a_LIBADD)
BUILT_SOURCES =
EXTRA_DIST = Makefile.tmpl
MAINTAINERCLEANFILES =
MOSTLYCLEANFILES =
lib_OBJECTS = $(libtar_a_OBJECTS)
# Special rule for getdate
#
# Say $(srcdir), so GNU make does not report an ambiguity with the .y.c rule.
$(srcdir)/getdate.c: getdate.y
cd $(srcdir) && \
$(YACC) $(YFLAGS) getdate.y && \
mv -f y.tab.c getdate.c
SUFFIXES = .o .c .h
CLEANFILES =
# gnulib modules

View File

@@ -1,508 +0,0 @@
/* alloca.c -- allocate automatically reclaimed memory
(Mostly) portable public-domain implementation -- D A Gwyn
This implementation of the PWB library alloca function,
which is used to allocate space off the run-time stack so
that it is automatically reclaimed upon procedure exit,
was inspired by discussions with J. Q. Johnson of Cornell.
J.Otto Tennant <jot@cray.com> contributed the Cray support.
There are some preprocessor constants that can
be defined when compiling for your specific system, for
improved efficiency; however, the defaults should be okay.
The general concept of this implementation is to keep
track of all alloca-allocated blocks, and reclaim any
that are found to be deeper in the stack than the current
invocation. This heuristic does not reclaim storage as
soon as it becomes invalid, but it will do so eventually.
As a special case, alloca(0) reclaims storage without
allocating any. It is a good idea to use alloca(0) in
your main control loop, etc. to force garbage collection. */
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#ifdef emacs
# include "lisp.h"
# include "blockinput.h"
# define xalloc_die() memory_full ()
# ifdef EMACS_FREE
# undef free
# define free EMACS_FREE
# endif
#else
# include <xalloc.h>
#endif
/* If compiling with GCC 2, this file's not needed. */
#if !defined (__GNUC__) || __GNUC__ < 2
/* If someone has defined alloca as a macro,
there must be some other way alloca is supposed to work. */
# ifndef alloca
# ifdef emacs
# ifdef static
/* actually, only want this if static is defined as ""
-- this is for usg, in which emacs must undefine static
in order to make unexec workable
*/
# ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
you
lose
-- must know STACK_DIRECTION at compile-time
/* Using #error here is not wise since this file should work for
old and obscure compilers. */
# endif /* STACK_DIRECTION undefined */
# endif /* static */
# endif /* emacs */
/* If your stack is a linked list of frames, you have to
provide an "address metric" ADDRESS_FUNCTION macro. */
# if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
long i00afunc ();
# define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) (char *) i00afunc (&(arg))
# else
# define ADDRESS_FUNCTION(arg) &(arg)
# endif
# ifndef POINTER_TYPE
# ifdef __STDC__
# define POINTER_TYPE void
# else
# define POINTER_TYPE char
# endif
# endif
typedef POINTER_TYPE *pointer;
# ifndef NULL
# define NULL 0
# endif
/* Define STACK_DIRECTION if you know the direction of stack
growth for your system; otherwise it will be automatically
deduced at run-time.
STACK_DIRECTION > 0 => grows toward higher addresses
STACK_DIRECTION < 0 => grows toward lower addresses
STACK_DIRECTION = 0 => direction of growth unknown */
# ifndef STACK_DIRECTION
# define STACK_DIRECTION 0 /* Direction unknown. */
# endif
# if STACK_DIRECTION != 0
# define STACK_DIR STACK_DIRECTION /* Known at compile-time. */
# else /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0; need run-time code. */
static int stack_dir; /* 1 or -1 once known. */
# define STACK_DIR stack_dir
static void
find_stack_direction ()
{
static char *addr = NULL; /* Address of first `dummy', once known. */
auto char dummy; /* To get stack address. */
if (addr == NULL)
{ /* Initial entry. */
addr = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy);
find_stack_direction (); /* Recurse once. */
}
else
{
/* Second entry. */
if (ADDRESS_FUNCTION (dummy) > addr)
stack_dir = 1; /* Stack grew upward. */
else
stack_dir = -1; /* Stack grew downward. */
}
}
# endif /* STACK_DIRECTION == 0 */
/* An "alloca header" is used to:
(a) chain together all alloca'ed blocks;
(b) keep track of stack depth.
It is very important that sizeof(header) agree with malloc
alignment chunk size. The following default should work okay. */
# ifndef ALIGN_SIZE
# define ALIGN_SIZE sizeof(double)
# endif
typedef union hdr
{
char align[ALIGN_SIZE]; /* To force sizeof(header). */
struct
{
union hdr *next; /* For chaining headers. */
char *deep; /* For stack depth measure. */
} h;
} header;
static header *last_alloca_header = NULL; /* -> last alloca header. */
/* Return a pointer to at least SIZE bytes of storage,
which will be automatically reclaimed upon exit from
the procedure that called alloca. Originally, this space
was supposed to be taken from the current stack frame of the
caller, but that method cannot be made to work for some
implementations of C, for example under Gould's UTX/32. */
pointer
alloca (size)
size_t size;
{
auto char probe; /* Probes stack depth: */
register char *depth = ADDRESS_FUNCTION (probe);
# if STACK_DIRECTION == 0
if (STACK_DIR == 0) /* Unknown growth direction. */
find_stack_direction ();
# endif
/* Reclaim garbage, defined as all alloca'd storage that
was allocated from deeper in the stack than currently. */
{
register header *hp; /* Traverses linked list. */
# ifdef emacs
BLOCK_INPUT;
# endif
for (hp = last_alloca_header; hp != NULL;)
if ((STACK_DIR > 0 && hp->h.deep > depth)
|| (STACK_DIR < 0 && hp->h.deep < depth))
{
register header *np = hp->h.next;
free ((pointer) hp); /* Collect garbage. */
hp = np; /* -> next header. */
}
else
break; /* Rest are not deeper. */
last_alloca_header = hp; /* -> last valid storage. */
# ifdef emacs
UNBLOCK_INPUT;
# endif
}
if (size == 0)
return NULL; /* No allocation required. */
/* Allocate combined header + user data storage. */
{
/* Address of header. */
register pointer new;
size_t combined_size = sizeof (header) + size;
if (combined_size < sizeof (header))
xalloc_die ();
new = xmalloc (combined_size);
if (new == 0)
abort();
((header *) new)->h.next = last_alloca_header;
((header *) new)->h.deep = depth;
last_alloca_header = (header *) new;
/* User storage begins just after header. */
return (pointer) ((char *) new + sizeof (header));
}
}
# if defined (CRAY) && defined (CRAY_STACKSEG_END)
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
# include <stdio.h>
# endif
# ifndef CRAY_STACK
# define CRAY_STACK
# ifndef CRAY2
/* Stack structures for CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, and CRAY Y-MP */
struct stack_control_header
{
long shgrow:32; /* Number of times stack has grown. */
long shaseg:32; /* Size of increments to stack. */
long shhwm:32; /* High water mark of stack. */
long shsize:32; /* Current size of stack (all segments). */
};
/* The stack segment linkage control information occurs at
the high-address end of a stack segment. (The stack
grows from low addresses to high addresses.) The initial
part of the stack segment linkage control information is
0200 (octal) words. This provides for register storage
for the routine which overflows the stack. */
struct stack_segment_linkage
{
long ss[0200]; /* 0200 overflow words. */
long sssize:32; /* Number of words in this segment. */
long ssbase:32; /* Offset to stack base. */
long:32;
long sspseg:32; /* Offset to linkage control of previous
segment of stack. */
long:32;
long sstcpt:32; /* Pointer to task common address block. */
long sscsnm; /* Private control structure number for
microtasking. */
long ssusr1; /* Reserved for user. */
long ssusr2; /* Reserved for user. */
long sstpid; /* Process ID for pid based multi-tasking. */
long ssgvup; /* Pointer to multitasking thread giveup. */
long sscray[7]; /* Reserved for Cray Research. */
long ssa0;
long ssa1;
long ssa2;
long ssa3;
long ssa4;
long ssa5;
long ssa6;
long ssa7;
long sss0;
long sss1;
long sss2;
long sss3;
long sss4;
long sss5;
long sss6;
long sss7;
};
# else /* CRAY2 */
/* The following structure defines the vector of words
returned by the STKSTAT library routine. */
struct stk_stat
{
long now; /* Current total stack size. */
long maxc; /* Amount of contiguous space which would
be required to satisfy the maximum
stack demand to date. */
long high_water; /* Stack high-water mark. */
long overflows; /* Number of stack overflow ($STKOFEN) calls. */
long hits; /* Number of internal buffer hits. */
long extends; /* Number of block extensions. */
long stko_mallocs; /* Block allocations by $STKOFEN. */
long underflows; /* Number of stack underflow calls ($STKRETN). */
long stko_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKRETN. */
long stkm_free; /* Number of deallocations by $STKMRET. */
long segments; /* Current number of stack segments. */
long maxs; /* Maximum number of stack segments so far. */
long pad_size; /* Stack pad size. */
long current_address; /* Current stack segment address. */
long current_size; /* Current stack segment size. This
number is actually corrupted by STKSTAT to
include the fifteen word trailer area. */
long initial_address; /* Address of initial segment. */
long initial_size; /* Size of initial segment. */
};
/* The following structure describes the data structure which trails
any stack segment. I think that the description in 'asdef' is
out of date. I only describe the parts that I am sure about. */
struct stk_trailer
{
long this_address; /* Address of this block. */
long this_size; /* Size of this block (does not include
this trailer). */
long unknown2;
long unknown3;
long link; /* Address of trailer block of previous
segment. */
long unknown5;
long unknown6;
long unknown7;
long unknown8;
long unknown9;
long unknown10;
long unknown11;
long unknown12;
long unknown13;
long unknown14;
};
# endif /* CRAY2 */
# endif /* not CRAY_STACK */
# ifdef CRAY2
/* Determine a "stack measure" for an arbitrary ADDRESS.
I doubt that "lint" will like this much. */
static long
i00afunc (long *address)
{
struct stk_stat status;
struct stk_trailer *trailer;
long *block, size;
long result = 0;
/* We want to iterate through all of the segments. The first
step is to get the stack status structure. We could do this
more quickly and more directly, perhaps, by referencing the
$LM00 common block, but I know that this works. */
STKSTAT (&status);
/* Set up the iteration. */
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) (status.current_address
+ status.current_size
- 15);
/* There must be at least one stack segment. Therefore it is
a fatal error if "trailer" is null. */
if (trailer == 0)
abort ();
/* Discard segments that do not contain our argument address. */
while (trailer != 0)
{
block = (long *) trailer->this_address;
size = trailer->this_size;
if (block == 0 || size == 0)
abort ();
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
if ((block <= address) && (address < (block + size)))
break;
}
/* Set the result to the offset in this segment and add the sizes
of all predecessor segments. */
result = address - block;
if (trailer == 0)
{
return result;
}
do
{
if (trailer->this_size <= 0)
abort ();
result += trailer->this_size;
trailer = (struct stk_trailer *) trailer->link;
}
while (trailer != 0);
/* We are done. Note that if you present a bogus address (one
not in any segment), you will get a different number back, formed
from subtracting the address of the first block. This is probably
not what you want. */
return (result);
}
# else /* not CRAY2 */
/* Stack address function for a CRAY-1, CRAY X-MP, or CRAY Y-MP.
Determine the number of the cell within the stack,
given the address of the cell. The purpose of this
routine is to linearize, in some sense, stack addresses
for alloca. */
static long
i00afunc (long address)
{
long stkl = 0;
long size, pseg, this_segment, stack;
long result = 0;
struct stack_segment_linkage *ssptr;
/* Register B67 contains the address of the end of the
current stack segment. If you (as a subprogram) store
your registers on the stack and find that you are past
the contents of B67, you have overflowed the segment.
B67 also points to the stack segment linkage control
area, which is what we are really interested in. */
stkl = CRAY_STACKSEG_END ();
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
/* If one subtracts 'size' from the end of the segment,
one has the address of the first word of the segment.
If this is not the first segment, 'pseg' will be
nonzero. */
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
size = ssptr->sssize;
this_segment = stkl - size;
/* It is possible that calling this routine itself caused
a stack overflow. Discard stack segments which do not
contain the target address. */
while (!(this_segment <= address && address <= stkl))
{
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o %011o\n", this_segment, address, stkl);
# endif
if (pseg == 0)
break;
stkl = stkl - pseg;
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
size = ssptr->sssize;
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
this_segment = stkl - size;
}
result = address - this_segment;
/* If you subtract pseg from the current end of the stack,
you get the address of the previous stack segment's end.
This seems a little convoluted to me, but I'll bet you save
a cycle somewhere. */
while (pseg != 0)
{
# ifdef DEBUG_I00AFUNC
fprintf (stderr, "%011o %011o\n", pseg, size);
# endif
stkl = stkl - pseg;
ssptr = (struct stack_segment_linkage *) stkl;
size = ssptr->sssize;
pseg = ssptr->sspseg;
result += size;
}
return (result);
}
# endif /* not CRAY2 */
# endif /* CRAY */
# endif /* no alloca */
#endif /* not GCC version 2 */

View File

@@ -1,280 +0,0 @@
/* argmatch.c -- find a match for a string in an array
Copyright (C) 1990, 1998, 1999, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software
Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@ai.mit.edu>
Modified by Akim Demaille <demaille@inf.enst.fr> */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
/* Specification. */
#include "argmatch.h"
#include <stdio.h>
#include <stdlib.h>
#include <string.h>
#include "gettext.h"
#define _(msgid) gettext (msgid)
#include "error.h"
#include "quotearg.h"
#include "quote.h"
#include "unlocked-io.h"
/* When reporting an invalid argument, show nonprinting characters
by using the quoting style ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE. Do not use
literal_quoting_style. */
#ifndef ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE
# define ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE locale_quoting_style
#endif
#ifndef EXIT_FAILURE
# define EXIT_FAILURE 1
#endif
/* Non failing version of argmatch call this function after failing. */
#ifndef ARGMATCH_DIE
# define ARGMATCH_DIE exit (EXIT_FAILURE)
#endif
#ifdef ARGMATCH_DIE_DECL
ARGMATCH_DIE_DECL;
#endif
static void
__argmatch_die (void)
{
ARGMATCH_DIE;
}
/* Used by XARGMATCH and XARGCASEMATCH. See description in argmatch.h.
Default to __argmatch_die, but allow caller to change this at run-time. */
argmatch_exit_fn argmatch_die = __argmatch_die;
/* If ARG is an unambiguous match for an element of the
null-terminated array ARGLIST, return the index in ARGLIST
of the matched element, else -1 if it does not match any element
or -2 if it is ambiguous (is a prefix of more than one element).
If VALLIST is none null, use it to resolve ambiguities limited to
synonyms, i.e., for
"yes", "yop" -> 0
"no", "nope" -> 1
"y" is a valid argument, for `0', and "n" for `1'. */
int
argmatch (const char *arg, const char *const *arglist,
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
{
int i; /* Temporary index in ARGLIST. */
size_t arglen; /* Length of ARG. */
int matchind = -1; /* Index of first nonexact match. */
int ambiguous = 0; /* If nonzero, multiple nonexact match(es). */
arglen = strlen (arg);
/* Test all elements for either exact match or abbreviated matches. */
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
{
if (!strncmp (arglist[i], arg, arglen))
{
if (strlen (arglist[i]) == arglen)
/* Exact match found. */
return i;
else if (matchind == -1)
/* First nonexact match found. */
matchind = i;
else
{
/* Second nonexact match found. */
if (vallist == NULL
|| memcmp (vallist + valsize * matchind,
vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
{
/* There is a real ambiguity, or we could not
disambiguate. */
ambiguous = 1;
}
}
}
}
if (ambiguous)
return -2;
else
return matchind;
}
/* Error reporting for argmatch.
CONTEXT is a description of the type of entity that was being matched.
VALUE is the invalid value that was given.
PROBLEM is the return value from argmatch. */
void
argmatch_invalid (const char *context, const char *value, int problem)
{
char const *format = (problem == -1
? _("invalid argument %s for %s")
: _("ambiguous argument %s for %s"));
error (0, 0, format, quotearg_n_style (0, ARGMATCH_QUOTING_STYLE, value),
quote_n (1, context));
}
/* List the valid arguments for argmatch.
ARGLIST is the same as in argmatch.
VALLIST is a pointer to an array of values.
VALSIZE is the size of the elements of VALLIST */
void
argmatch_valid (const char *const *arglist,
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
{
int i;
const char *last_val = NULL;
/* We try to put synonyms on the same line. The assumption is that
synonyms follow each other */
fprintf (stderr, _("Valid arguments are:"));
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
if ((i == 0)
|| memcmp (last_val, vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
{
fprintf (stderr, "\n - `%s'", arglist[i]);
last_val = vallist + valsize * i;
}
else
{
fprintf (stderr, ", `%s'", arglist[i]);
}
putc ('\n', stderr);
}
/* Never failing versions of the previous functions.
CONTEXT is the context for which argmatch is called (e.g.,
"--version-control", or "$VERSION_CONTROL" etc.). Upon failure,
calls the (supposed never to return) function EXIT_FN. */
int
__xargmatch_internal (const char *context,
const char *arg, const char *const *arglist,
const char *vallist, size_t valsize,
argmatch_exit_fn exit_fn)
{
int res = argmatch (arg, arglist, vallist, valsize);
if (res >= 0)
/* Success. */
return res;
/* We failed. Explain why. */
argmatch_invalid (context, arg, res);
argmatch_valid (arglist, vallist, valsize);
(*exit_fn) ();
return -1; /* To please the compilers. */
}
/* Look for VALUE in VALLIST, an array of objects of size VALSIZE and
return the first corresponding argument in ARGLIST */
const char *
argmatch_to_argument (const char *value,
const char *const *arglist,
const char *vallist, size_t valsize)
{
int i;
for (i = 0; arglist[i]; i++)
if (!memcmp (value, vallist + valsize * i, valsize))
return arglist[i];
return NULL;
}
#ifdef TEST
/*
* Based on "getversion.c" by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>
*/
char *program_name;
extern const char *getenv ();
/* When to make backup files. */
enum backup_type
{
/* Never make backups. */
none,
/* Make simple backups of every file. */
simple,
/* Make numbered backups of files that already have numbered backups,
and simple backups of the others. */
numbered_existing,
/* Make numbered backups of every file. */
numbered
};
/* Two tables describing arguments (keys) and their corresponding
values */
static const char *const backup_args[] =
{
"no", "none", "off",
"simple", "never",
"existing", "nil",
"numbered", "t",
0
};
static const enum backup_type backup_vals[] =
{
none, none, none,
simple, simple,
numbered_existing, numbered_existing,
numbered, numbered
};
int
main (int argc, const char *const *argv)
{
const char *cp;
enum backup_type backup_type = none;
program_name = (char *) argv[0];
if (argc > 2)
{
fprintf (stderr, "Usage: %s [VERSION_CONTROL]\n", program_name);
exit (1);
}
if ((cp = getenv ("VERSION_CONTROL")))
backup_type = XARGMATCH ("$VERSION_CONTROL", cp,
backup_args, backup_vals);
if (argc == 2)
backup_type = XARGMATCH (program_name, argv[1],
backup_args, backup_vals);
printf ("The version control is `%s'\n",
ARGMATCH_TO_ARGUMENT (backup_type, backup_args, backup_vals));
return 0;
}
#endif

View File

@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
#ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
#endif
char *base_name PARAMS ((char const *name));

View File

@@ -1,407 +0,0 @@
/* Error handler for noninteractive utilities
Copyright (C) 1990-1998, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along
with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <stdio.h>
#ifdef _LIBC
# include <libintl.h>
#else
# include "gettext.h"
#endif
#ifdef _LIBC
# include <wchar.h>
# define mbsrtowcs __mbsrtowcs
#endif
#if HAVE_VPRINTF || HAVE_DOPRNT || _LIBC
# if __STDC__
# include <stdarg.h>
# define VA_START(args, lastarg) va_start(args, lastarg)
# else
# include <varargs.h>
# define VA_START(args, lastarg) va_start(args)
# endif
#else
# define va_alist a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8
# define va_dcl char *a1, *a2, *a3, *a4, *a5, *a6, *a7, *a8;
#endif
#if STDC_HEADERS || _LIBC
# include <stdlib.h>
# include <string.h>
#else
void exit ();
#endif
#include "error.h"
#if !_LIBC
# include "unlocked-io.h"
#endif
#ifndef _
# define _(String) String
#endif
/* If NULL, error will flush stdout, then print on stderr the program
name, a colon and a space. Otherwise, error will call this
function without parameters instead. */
void (*error_print_progname) (
#if __STDC__ - 0
void
#endif
);
/* This variable is incremented each time `error' is called. */
unsigned int error_message_count;
#ifdef _LIBC
/* In the GNU C library, there is a predefined variable for this. */
# define program_name program_invocation_name
# include <errno.h>
# include <libio/libioP.h>
/* In GNU libc we want do not want to use the common name `error' directly.
Instead make it a weak alias. */
extern void __error (int status, int errnum, const char *message, ...)
__attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 3, 4)));
extern void __error_at_line (int status, int errnum, const char *file_name,
unsigned int line_number, const char *message,
...)
__attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 5, 6)));;
# define error __error
# define error_at_line __error_at_line
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
# include <libio/iolibio.h>
# define fflush(s) INTUSE(_IO_fflush) (s)
# undef putc
# define putc(c, fp) INTUSE(_IO_putc) (c, fp)
# endif
#else /* not _LIBC */
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRERROR_R && STRERROR_R_CHAR_P
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRERROR_R
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
char *strerror_r ();
# endif
/* The calling program should define program_name and set it to the
name of the executing program. */
extern char *program_name;
# if HAVE_STRERROR_R || defined strerror_r
# define __strerror_r strerror_r
# else
# if HAVE_STRERROR
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRERROR
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRERROR
char *strerror ();
# endif
# else
static char *
private_strerror (int errnum)
{
extern char *sys_errlist[];
extern int sys_nerr;
if (errnum > 0 && errnum <= sys_nerr)
return _(sys_errlist[errnum]);
return _("Unknown system error");
}
# define strerror private_strerror
# endif /* HAVE_STRERROR */
# endif /* HAVE_STRERROR_R || defined strerror_r */
#endif /* not _LIBC */
static void
print_errno_message (int errnum)
{
char const *s;
#if defined HAVE_STRERROR_R || _LIBC
char errbuf[1024];
# if STRERROR_R_CHAR_P || _LIBC
s = __strerror_r (errnum, errbuf, sizeof errbuf);
# else
if (__strerror_r (errnum, errbuf, sizeof errbuf) == 0)
s = errbuf;
else
s = 0;
# endif
#else
s = strerror (errnum);
#endif
#if !_LIBC
if (! s)
s = _("Unknown system error");
#endif
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
{
__fwprintf (stderr, L": %s", s);
return;
}
#endif
fprintf (stderr, ": %s", s);
}
#ifdef VA_START
static void
error_tail (int status, int errnum, const char *message, va_list args)
{
# if HAVE_VPRINTF || _LIBC
# if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
{
# define ALLOCA_LIMIT 2000
size_t len = strlen (message) + 1;
wchar_t *wmessage = NULL;
mbstate_t st;
size_t res;
const char *tmp;
do
{
if (len < ALLOCA_LIMIT)
wmessage = (wchar_t *) alloca (len * sizeof (wchar_t));
else
{
if (wmessage != NULL && len / 2 < ALLOCA_LIMIT)
wmessage = NULL;
wmessage = (wchar_t *) realloc (wmessage,
len * sizeof (wchar_t));
if (wmessage == NULL)
{
fputws_unlocked (L"out of memory\n", stderr);
return;
}
}
memset (&st, '\0', sizeof (st));
tmp =message;
}
while ((res = mbsrtowcs (wmessage, &tmp, len, &st)) == len);
if (res == (size_t) -1)
/* The string cannot be converted. */
wmessage = (wchar_t *) L"???";
__vfwprintf (stderr, wmessage, args);
}
else
# endif
vfprintf (stderr, message, args);
# else
_doprnt (message, args, stderr);
# endif
va_end (args);
++error_message_count;
if (errnum)
print_errno_message (errnum);
# if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
putwc (L'\n', stderr);
else
# endif
putc ('\n', stderr);
fflush (stderr);
if (status)
exit (status);
}
#endif
/* Print the program name and error message MESSAGE, which is a printf-style
format string with optional args.
If ERRNUM is nonzero, print its corresponding system error message.
Exit with status STATUS if it is nonzero. */
/* VARARGS */
void
#if defined VA_START && __STDC__
error (int status, int errnum, const char *message, ...)
#else
error (status, errnum, message, va_alist)
int status;
int errnum;
char *message;
va_dcl
#endif
{
#ifdef VA_START
va_list args;
#endif
fflush (stdout);
#ifdef _LIBC
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
_IO_flockfile (stderr);
# else
__flockfile (stderr);
# endif
#endif
if (error_print_progname)
(*error_print_progname) ();
else
{
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s: ", program_name);
else
#endif
fprintf (stderr, "%s: ", program_name);
}
#ifdef VA_START
VA_START (args, message);
error_tail (status, errnum, message, args);
#else
fprintf (stderr, message, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8);
++error_message_count;
if (errnum)
print_errno_message (errnum);
putc ('\n', stderr);
fflush (stderr);
if (status)
exit (status);
#endif
#ifdef _LIBC
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
_IO_funlockfile (stderr);
# else
__funlockfile (stderr);
# endif
#endif
}
/* Sometimes we want to have at most one error per line. This
variable controls whether this mode is selected or not. */
int error_one_per_line;
void
#if defined VA_START && __STDC__
error_at_line (int status, int errnum, const char *file_name,
unsigned int line_number, const char *message, ...)
#else
error_at_line (status, errnum, file_name, line_number, message, va_alist)
int status;
int errnum;
const char *file_name;
unsigned int line_number;
char *message;
va_dcl
#endif
{
#ifdef VA_START
va_list args;
#endif
if (error_one_per_line)
{
static const char *old_file_name;
static unsigned int old_line_number;
if (old_line_number == line_number
&& (file_name == old_file_name
|| strcmp (old_file_name, file_name) == 0))
/* Simply return and print nothing. */
return;
old_file_name = file_name;
old_line_number = line_number;
}
fflush (stdout);
#ifdef _LIBC
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
_IO_flockfile (stderr);
# else
__flockfile (stderr);
# endif
#endif
if (error_print_progname)
(*error_print_progname) ();
else
{
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s: ", program_name);
else
#endif
fprintf (stderr, "%s:", program_name);
}
if (file_name != NULL)
{
#if _LIBC && USE_IN_LIBIO
if (_IO_fwide (stderr, 0) > 0)
__fwprintf (stderr, L"%s:%d: ", file_name, line_number);
else
#endif
fprintf (stderr, "%s:%d: ", file_name, line_number);
}
#ifdef VA_START
VA_START (args, message);
error_tail (status, errnum, message, args);
#else
fprintf (stderr, message, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8);
++error_message_count;
if (errnum)
print_errno_message (errnum);
putc ('\n', stderr);
fflush (stderr);
if (status)
exit (status);
#endif
#ifdef _LIBC
# ifdef USE_IN_LIBIO
_IO_funlockfile (stderr);
# else
__funlockfile (stderr);
# endif
#endif
}
#ifdef _LIBC
/* Make the weak alias. */
# undef error
# undef error_at_line
weak_alias (__error, error)
weak_alias (__error_at_line, error_at_line)
#endif

View File

@@ -1,267 +0,0 @@
/* exclude.c -- exclude file names
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free
Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <stdbool.h>
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#include <stddef.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRINGS_H
# include <strings.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
# include <inttypes.h>
#else
# if HAVE_STDINT_H
# include <stdint.h>
# endif
#endif
#include "exclude.h"
#include "fnmatch.h"
#include "unlocked-io.h"
#include "xalloc.h"
#ifndef SIZE_MAX
# define SIZE_MAX ((size_t) -1)
#endif
/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
/* Non-GNU systems lack these options, so we don't need to check them. */
#ifndef FNM_CASEFOLD
# define FNM_CASEFOLD 0
#endif
#ifndef FNM_LEADING_DIR
# define FNM_LEADING_DIR 0
#endif
verify (EXCLUDE_macros_do_not_collide_with_FNM_macros,
(((EXCLUDE_ANCHORED | EXCLUDE_INCLUDE | EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS)
& (FNM_PATHNAME | FNM_NOESCAPE | FNM_PERIOD | FNM_LEADING_DIR
| FNM_CASEFOLD))
== 0));
/* An exclude pattern-options pair. The options are fnmatch options
ORed with EXCLUDE_* options. */
struct patopts
{
char const *pattern;
int options;
};
/* An exclude list, of pattern-options pairs. */
struct exclude
{
struct patopts *exclude;
size_t exclude_alloc;
size_t exclude_count;
};
/* Return a newly allocated and empty exclude list. */
struct exclude *
new_exclude (void)
{
struct exclude *ex = xmalloc (sizeof *ex);
ex->exclude_count = 0;
ex->exclude_alloc = (1 << 6); /* This must be a power of 2. */
ex->exclude = xmalloc (ex->exclude_alloc * sizeof ex->exclude[0]);
return ex;
}
/* Free the storage associated with an exclude list. */
void
free_exclude (struct exclude *ex)
{
free (ex->exclude);
free (ex);
}
/* Return zero if PATTERN matches F, obeying OPTIONS, except that
(unlike fnmatch) wildcards are disabled in PATTERN. */
static int
fnmatch_no_wildcards (char const *pattern, char const *f, int options)
{
if (! (options & FNM_LEADING_DIR))
return ((options & FNM_CASEFOLD)
? strcasecmp (pattern, f)
: strcmp (pattern, f));
else
{
size_t patlen = strlen (pattern);
int r = ((options & FNM_CASEFOLD)
? strncasecmp (pattern, f, patlen)
: strncmp (pattern, f, patlen));
if (! r)
{
r = f[patlen];
if (r == '/')
r = 0;
}
return r;
}
}
/* Return true if EX excludes F. */
bool
excluded_filename (struct exclude const *ex, char const *f)
{
size_t exclude_count = ex->exclude_count;
/* If no options are given, the default is to include. */
if (exclude_count == 0)
return false;
else
{
struct patopts const *exclude = ex->exclude;
size_t i;
/* Otherwise, the default is the opposite of the first option. */
bool excluded = !! (exclude[0].options & EXCLUDE_INCLUDE);
/* Scan through the options, seeing whether they change F from
excluded to included or vice versa. */
for (i = 0; i < exclude_count; i++)
{
char const *pattern = exclude[i].pattern;
int options = exclude[i].options;
if (excluded == !! (options & EXCLUDE_INCLUDE))
{
int (*matcher) (char const *, char const *, int) =
(options & EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS
? fnmatch
: fnmatch_no_wildcards);
bool matched = ((*matcher) (pattern, f, options) == 0);
char const *p;
if (! (options & EXCLUDE_ANCHORED))
for (p = f; *p && ! matched; p++)
if (*p == '/' && p[1] != '/')
matched = ((*matcher) (pattern, p + 1, options) == 0);
excluded ^= matched;
}
}
return excluded;
}
}
/* Append to EX the exclusion PATTERN with OPTIONS. */
void
add_exclude (struct exclude *ex, char const *pattern, int options)
{
struct patopts *patopts;
if (ex->exclude_alloc <= ex->exclude_count)
{
size_t s = 2 * ex->exclude_alloc;
if (! (0 < s && s <= SIZE_MAX / sizeof ex->exclude[0]))
xalloc_die ();
ex->exclude_alloc = s;
ex->exclude = xrealloc (ex->exclude, s * sizeof ex->exclude[0]);
}
patopts = &ex->exclude[ex->exclude_count++];
patopts->pattern = pattern;
patopts->options = options;
}
/* Use ADD_FUNC to append to EX the patterns in FILENAME, each with
OPTIONS. LINE_END terminates each pattern in the file. Return -1
on failure, 0 on success. */
int
add_exclude_file (void (*add_func) (struct exclude *, char const *, int),
struct exclude *ex, char const *filename, int options,
char line_end)
{
bool use_stdin = filename[0] == '-' && !filename[1];
FILE *in;
char *buf;
char *p;
char const *pattern;
char const *lim;
size_t buf_alloc = (1 << 10); /* This must be a power of two. */
size_t buf_count = 0;
int c;
int e = 0;
if (use_stdin)
in = stdin;
else if (! (in = fopen (filename, "r")))
return -1;
buf = xmalloc (buf_alloc);
while ((c = getc (in)) != EOF)
{
buf[buf_count++] = c;
if (buf_count == buf_alloc)
{
buf_alloc *= 2;
if (! buf_alloc)
xalloc_die ();
buf = xrealloc (buf, buf_alloc);
}
}
if (ferror (in))
e = errno;
if (!use_stdin && fclose (in) != 0)
e = errno;
buf = xrealloc (buf, buf_count + 1);
for (pattern = p = buf, lim = buf + buf_count; p <= lim; p++)
if (p < lim ? *p == line_end : buf < p && p[-1])
{
*p = '\0';
(*add_func) (ex, pattern, options);
pattern = p + 1;
}
errno = e;
return e ? -1 : 0;
}

View File

@@ -1,43 +0,0 @@
/* exclude.h -- declarations for excluding file names
Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free
Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
/* Exclude options, which can be ORed with fnmatch options. */
/* Patterns must match the start of file names, instead of matching
anywhere after a '/'. */
#define EXCLUDE_ANCHORED (1 << 30)
/* Include instead of exclude. */
#define EXCLUDE_INCLUDE (1 << 29)
/* '?', '*', '[', and '\\' are special in patterns. Without this
option, these characters are ordinary and fnmatch is not used. */
#define EXCLUDE_WILDCARDS (1 << 28)
struct exclude;
struct exclude *new_exclude (void);
void free_exclude (struct exclude *);
void add_exclude (struct exclude *, char const *, int);
int add_exclude_file (void (*) (struct exclude *, char const *, int),
struct exclude *, char const *, int, char);
bool excluded_filename (struct exclude const *, char const *);

View File

@@ -1,385 +0,0 @@
/* Copyright (C) 1991, 1992, 1993, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
/* Enable GNU extensions in fnmatch.h. */
#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
# define _GNU_SOURCE 1
#endif
#ifdef __GNUC__
# define alloca __builtin_alloca
# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
#else
# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
# include <alloca.h>
# else
# ifdef _AIX
# pragma alloca
# else
# ifndef alloca
char *alloca ();
# endif
# endif
# endif
#endif
#if ! defined __builtin_expect && __GNUC__ < 3
# define __builtin_expect(expr, expected) (expr)
#endif
#include <assert.h>
#include <errno.h>
#include <fnmatch.h>
#include <ctype.h>
#if HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
# include <string.h>
#else
# if HAVE_STRINGS_H
# include <strings.h>
# endif
#endif
#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
# include <stddef.h>
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#define WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT (HAVE_WCTYPE_H && HAVE_WCHAR_H && HAVE_BTOWC)
/* For platform which support the ISO C amendement 1 functionality we
support user defined character classes. */
#if defined _LIBC || WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT
/* Solaris 2.5 has a bug: <wchar.h> must be included before <wctype.h>. */
# include <wchar.h>
# include <wctype.h>
#endif
/* We need some of the locale data (the collation sequence information)
but there is no interface to get this information in general. Therefore
we support a correct implementation only in glibc. */
#ifdef _LIBC
# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
# include "../locale/elem-hash.h"
# include "../locale/coll-lookup.h"
# include <shlib-compat.h>
# define CONCAT(a,b) __CONCAT(a,b)
# define mbsinit __mbsinit
# define mbsrtowcs __mbsrtowcs
# define fnmatch __fnmatch
extern int fnmatch (const char *pattern, const char *string, int flags);
#endif
/* We often have to test for FNM_FILE_NAME and FNM_PERIOD being both set. */
#define NO_LEADING_PERIOD(flags) \
((flags & (FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_PERIOD)) == (FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_PERIOD))
/* Comment out all this code if we are using the GNU C Library, are not
actually compiling the library itself, and have not detected a bug
in the library. This code is part of the GNU C
Library, but also included in many other GNU distributions. Compiling
and linking in this code is a waste when using the GNU C library
(especially if it is a shared library). Rather than having every GNU
program understand `configure --with-gnu-libc' and omit the object files,
it is simpler to just do this in the source for each such file. */
#if defined _LIBC || !defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ || !HAVE_FNMATCH_GNU
# if defined STDC_HEADERS || !defined isascii
# define ISASCII(c) 1
# else
# define ISASCII(c) isascii(c)
# endif
# ifdef isblank
# define ISBLANK(c) (ISASCII (c) && isblank (c))
# else
# define ISBLANK(c) ((c) == ' ' || (c) == '\t')
# endif
# ifdef isgraph
# define ISGRAPH(c) (ISASCII (c) && isgraph (c))
# else
# define ISGRAPH(c) (ISASCII (c) && isprint (c) && !isspace (c))
# endif
# define ISPRINT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isprint (c))
# define ISDIGIT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isdigit (c))
# define ISALNUM(c) (ISASCII (c) && isalnum (c))
# define ISALPHA(c) (ISASCII (c) && isalpha (c))
# define ISCNTRL(c) (ISASCII (c) && iscntrl (c))
# define ISLOWER(c) (ISASCII (c) && islower (c))
# define ISPUNCT(c) (ISASCII (c) && ispunct (c))
# define ISSPACE(c) (ISASCII (c) && isspace (c))
# define ISUPPER(c) (ISASCII (c) && isupper (c))
# define ISXDIGIT(c) (ISASCII (c) && isxdigit (c))
# define STREQ(s1, s2) ((strcmp (s1, s2) == 0))
# if defined _LIBC || WIDE_CHAR_SUPPORT
/* The GNU C library provides support for user-defined character classes
and the functions from ISO C amendement 1. */
# ifdef CHARCLASS_NAME_MAX
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH CHARCLASS_NAME_MAX
# else
/* This shouldn't happen but some implementation might still have this
problem. Use a reasonable default value. */
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH 256
# endif
# ifdef _LIBC
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) __wctype (string)
# else
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) wctype (string)
# endif
# ifdef _LIBC
# define ISWCTYPE(WC, WT) __iswctype (WC, WT)
# else
# define ISWCTYPE(WC, WT) iswctype (WC, WT)
# endif
# if (HAVE_MBSTATE_T && HAVE_MBSRTOWCS) || _LIBC
/* In this case we are implementing the multibyte character handling. */
# define HANDLE_MULTIBYTE 1
# endif
# else
# define CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH 6 /* Namely, `xdigit'. */
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) \
(STREQ (string, "alpha") || STREQ (string, "upper") \
|| STREQ (string, "lower") || STREQ (string, "digit") \
|| STREQ (string, "alnum") || STREQ (string, "xdigit") \
|| STREQ (string, "space") || STREQ (string, "print") \
|| STREQ (string, "punct") || STREQ (string, "graph") \
|| STREQ (string, "cntrl") || STREQ (string, "blank"))
# endif
/* Avoid depending on library functions or files
whose names are inconsistent. */
# if !defined _LIBC && !defined getenv && !HAVE_DECL_GETENV
extern char *getenv ();
# endif
# ifndef errno
extern int errno;
# endif
/* Global variable. */
static int posixly_correct;
# ifndef internal_function
/* Inside GNU libc we mark some function in a special way. In other
environments simply ignore the marking. */
# define internal_function
# endif
/* Note that this evaluates C many times. */
# ifdef _LIBC
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) ? tolower (c) : (c))
# else
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) && ISUPPER (c) ? tolower (c) : (c))
# endif
# define CHAR char
# define UCHAR unsigned char
# define INT int
# define FCT internal_fnmatch
# define EXT ext_match
# define END end_pattern
# define L(CS) CS
# ifdef _LIBC
# define BTOWC(C) __btowc (C)
# else
# define BTOWC(C) btowc (C)
# endif
# define STRLEN(S) strlen (S)
# define STRCAT(D, S) strcat (D, S)
# ifdef _LIBC
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) __mempcpy (D, S, N)
# else
# if HAVE_MEMPCPY
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) mempcpy (D, S, N)
# else
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) ((void *) ((char *) memcpy (D, S, N) + (N)))
# endif
# endif
# define MEMCHR(S, C, N) memchr (S, C, N)
# define STRCOLL(S1, S2) strcoll (S1, S2)
# include "fnmatch_loop.c"
# if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
# define FOLD(c) ((flags & FNM_CASEFOLD) ? towlower (c) : (c))
# define CHAR wchar_t
# define UCHAR wint_t
# define INT wint_t
# define FCT internal_fnwmatch
# define EXT ext_wmatch
# define END end_wpattern
# define L(CS) L##CS
# define BTOWC(C) (C)
# ifdef _LIBC
# define STRLEN(S) __wcslen (S)
# define STRCAT(D, S) __wcscat (D, S)
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) __wmempcpy (D, S, N)
# else
# define STRLEN(S) wcslen (S)
# define STRCAT(D, S) wcscat (D, S)
# if HAVE_WMEMPCPY
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) wmempcpy (D, S, N)
# else
# define MEMPCPY(D, S, N) (wmemcpy (D, S, N) + (N))
# endif
# endif
# define MEMCHR(S, C, N) wmemchr (S, C, N)
# define STRCOLL(S1, S2) wcscoll (S1, S2)
# define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
# undef IS_CHAR_CLASS
/* We have to convert the wide character string in a multibyte string. But
we know that the character class names consist of alphanumeric characters
from the portable character set, and since the wide character encoding
for a member of the portable character set is the same code point as
its single-byte encoding, we can use a simplified method to convert the
string to a multibyte character string. */
static wctype_t
is_char_class (const wchar_t *wcs)
{
char s[CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH + 1];
char *cp = s;
do
{
/* Test for a printable character from the portable character set. */
# ifdef _LIBC
if (*wcs < 0x20 || *wcs > 0x7e
|| *wcs == 0x24 || *wcs == 0x40 || *wcs == 0x60)
return (wctype_t) 0;
# else
switch (*wcs)
{
case L' ': case L'!': case L'"': case L'#': case L'%':
case L'&': case L'\'': case L'(': case L')': case L'*':
case L'+': case L',': case L'-': case L'.': case L'/':
case L'0': case L'1': case L'2': case L'3': case L'4':
case L'5': case L'6': case L'7': case L'8': case L'9':
case L':': case L';': case L'<': case L'=': case L'>':
case L'?':
case L'A': case L'B': case L'C': case L'D': case L'E':
case L'F': case L'G': case L'H': case L'I': case L'J':
case L'K': case L'L': case L'M': case L'N': case L'O':
case L'P': case L'Q': case L'R': case L'S': case L'T':
case L'U': case L'V': case L'W': case L'X': case L'Y':
case L'Z':
case L'[': case L'\\': case L']': case L'^': case L'_':
case L'a': case L'b': case L'c': case L'd': case L'e':
case L'f': case L'g': case L'h': case L'i': case L'j':
case L'k': case L'l': case L'm': case L'n': case L'o':
case L'p': case L'q': case L'r': case L's': case L't':
case L'u': case L'v': case L'w': case L'x': case L'y':
case L'z': case L'{': case L'|': case L'}': case L'~':
break;
default:
return (wctype_t) 0;
}
# endif
/* Avoid overrunning the buffer. */
if (cp == s + CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH)
return (wctype_t) 0;
*cp++ = (char) *wcs++;
}
while (*wcs != L'\0');
*cp = '\0';
# ifdef _LIBC
return __wctype (s);
# else
return wctype (s);
# endif
}
# define IS_CHAR_CLASS(string) is_char_class (string)
# include "fnmatch_loop.c"
# endif
int
fnmatch (pattern, string, flags)
const char *pattern;
const char *string;
int flags;
{
# if HANDLE_MULTIBYTE
if (__builtin_expect (MB_CUR_MAX, 1) != 1)
{
mbstate_t ps;
size_t n;
wchar_t *wpattern;
wchar_t *wstring;
/* Convert the strings into wide characters. */
memset (&ps, '\0', sizeof (ps));
n = mbsrtowcs (NULL, &pattern, 0, &ps);
if (__builtin_expect (n, 0) == (size_t) -1)
/* Something wrong.
XXX Do we have to set `errno' to something which mbsrtows hasn't
already done? */
return -1;
wpattern = (wchar_t *) alloca ((n + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
(void) mbsrtowcs (wpattern, &pattern, n + 1, &ps);
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
n = mbsrtowcs (NULL, &string, 0, &ps);
if (__builtin_expect (n, 0) == (size_t) -1)
/* Something wrong.
XXX Do we have to set `errno' to something which mbsrtows hasn't
already done? */
return -1;
wstring = (wchar_t *) alloca ((n + 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));
assert (mbsinit (&ps));
(void) mbsrtowcs (wstring, &string, n + 1, &ps);
return internal_fnwmatch (wpattern, wstring, wstring + n,
flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags);
}
# endif /* mbstate_t and mbsrtowcs or _LIBC. */
return internal_fnmatch (pattern, string, string + strlen (string),
flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags);
}
# ifdef _LIBC
# undef fnmatch
versioned_symbol (libc, __fnmatch, fnmatch, GLIBC_2_2_3);
# if SHLIB_COMPAT(libc, GLIBC_2_0, GLIBC_2_2_3)
strong_alias (__fnmatch, __fnmatch_old)
compat_symbol (libc, __fnmatch_old, fnmatch, GLIBC_2_0);
# endif
# endif
#endif /* _LIBC or not __GNU_LIBRARY__. */

View File

@@ -1,84 +0,0 @@
/* Copyright (C) 1991, 92, 93, 96, 97, 98 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of the GNU C Library.
The GNU C Library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
License, or (at your option) any later version.
The GNU C Library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not,
write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#ifndef _FNMATCH_H
#define _FNMATCH_H 1
#ifdef __cplusplus
extern "C" {
#endif
#if defined __cplusplus || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__) || defined WINDOWS32
# if !defined __GLIBC__ || !defined __P
# undef __P
# define __P(protos) protos
# endif
#else /* Not C++ or ANSI C. */
# undef __P
# define __P(protos) ()
/* We can get away without defining `const' here only because in this file
it is used only inside the prototype for `fnmatch', which is elided in
non-ANSI C where `const' is problematical. */
#endif /* C++ or ANSI C. */
#ifndef const
# if (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__) || defined __cplusplus
# define __const const
# else
# define __const
# endif
#endif
/* We #undef these before defining them because some losing systems
(HP-UX A.08.07 for example) define these in <unistd.h>. */
#undef FNM_PATHNAME
#undef FNM_NOESCAPE
#undef FNM_PERIOD
/* Bits set in the FLAGS argument to `fnmatch'. */
#define FNM_PATHNAME (1 << 0) /* No wildcard can ever match `/'. */
#define FNM_NOESCAPE (1 << 1) /* Backslashes don't quote special chars. */
#define FNM_PERIOD (1 << 2) /* Leading `.' is matched only explicitly. */
#if !defined _POSIX_C_SOURCE || _POSIX_C_SOURCE < 2 || defined _GNU_SOURCE
# define FNM_FILE_NAME FNM_PATHNAME /* Preferred GNU name. */
# define FNM_LEADING_DIR (1 << 3) /* Ignore `/...' after a match. */
# define FNM_CASEFOLD (1 << 4) /* Compare without regard to case. */
#endif
/* Value returned by `fnmatch' if STRING does not match PATTERN. */
#define FNM_NOMATCH 1
/* This value is returned if the implementation does not support
`fnmatch'. Since this is not the case here it will never be
returned but the conformance test suites still require the symbol
to be defined. */
#ifdef _XOPEN_SOURCE
# define FNM_NOSYS (-1)
#endif
/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN,
returning zero if it matches, FNM_NOMATCH if not. */
extern int fnmatch __P ((__const char *__pattern, __const char *__string,
int __flags));
#ifdef __cplusplus
}
#endif
#endif /* fnmatch.h */

View File

@@ -1,474 +0,0 @@
/* Copyright (C) 1991-1993, 1996-1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This file is part of the GNU C Library.
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
modify it under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as
published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the
License, or (at your option) any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
License along with this library; see the file COPYING.LIB. If not,
write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Match STRING against the filename pattern PATTERN, returning zero if
it matches, nonzero if not. */
static int FCT (const CHAR *pattern, const CHAR *string,
int no_leading_period, int flags) internal_function;
static int
internal_function
FCT (pattern, string, no_leading_period, flags)
const CHAR *pattern;
const CHAR *string;
int no_leading_period;
int flags;
{
register const CHAR *p = pattern, *n = string;
register UCHAR c;
#ifdef _LIBC
const UCHAR *collseq = (const UCHAR *)
_NL_CURRENT(LC_COLLATE, CONCAT(_NL_COLLATE_COLLSEQ,SUFFIX));
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
const wint_t *names = (const wint_t *)
_NL_CURRENT (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_NAMES);
size_t size = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_HASH_SIZE);
size_t layers = _NL_CURRENT_WORD (LC_COLLATE, _NL_COLLATE_HASH_LAYERS);
# endif
#endif
while ((c = *p++) != L('\0'))
{
c = FOLD (c);
switch (c)
{
case L('?'):
if (*n == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
else if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
else if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
&& (n == string
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
break;
case L('\\'):
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE))
{
c = *p++;
if (c == L('\0'))
/* Trailing \ loses. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
c = FOLD (c);
}
if (FOLD ((UCHAR) *n) != c)
return FNM_NOMATCH;
break;
case L('*'):
if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
&& (n == string
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
for (c = *p++; c == L('?') || c == L('*'); c = *p++)
{
if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
/* A slash does not match a wildcard under FNM_FILE_NAME. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
else if (c == L('?'))
{
/* A ? needs to match one character. */
if (*n == L('\0'))
/* There isn't another character; no match. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
else
/* One character of the string is consumed in matching
this ? wildcard, so *??? won't match if there are
less than three characters. */
++n;
}
}
if (c == L('\0'))
/* The wildcard(s) is/are the last element of the pattern.
If the name is a file name and contains another slash
this does mean it cannot match. If the FNM_LEADING_DIR
flag is set and exactly one slash is following, we have
a match. */
{
int result = (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME) == 0 ? 0 : FNM_NOMATCH;
if (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
{
const CHAR *slashp = STRCHR (n, L('/'));
if (flags & FNM_LEADING_DIR)
{
if (slashp != NULL
&& STRCHR (slashp + 1, L('/')) == NULL)
result = 0;
}
else
{
if (slashp == NULL)
result = 0;
}
}
return result;
}
else
{
const CHAR *endp;
endp = STRCHRNUL (n, (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME) ? L('/') : L('\0'));
if (c == L('['))
{
int flags2 = ((flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
? flags : (flags & ~FNM_PERIOD));
for (--p; n < endp; ++n)
if (FCT (p, n, (no_leading_period
&& (n == string
|| (n[-1] == L('/')
&& (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)))),
flags2) == 0)
return 0;
}
else if (c == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
{
while (*n != L('\0') && *n != L('/'))
++n;
if (*n == L('/')
&& (FCT (p, n + 1, flags & FNM_PERIOD, flags) == 0))
return 0;
}
else
{
int flags2 = ((flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)
? flags : (flags & ~FNM_PERIOD));
if (c == L('\\') && !(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE))
c = *p;
c = FOLD (c);
for (--p; n < endp; ++n)
if (FOLD ((UCHAR) *n) == c
&& (FCT (p, n, (no_leading_period
&& (n == string
|| (n[-1] == L('/')
&& (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME)))),
flags2) == 0))
return 0;
}
}
/* If we come here no match is possible with the wildcard. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
case L('['):
{
/* Nonzero if the sense of the character class is inverted. */
static int posixly_correct;
register int not;
CHAR cold;
if (posixly_correct == 0)
posixly_correct = getenv ("POSIXLY_CORRECT") != NULL ? 1 : -1;
if (*n == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
if (*n == L('.') && no_leading_period
&& (n == string
|| (n[-1] == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
if (*n == L('/') && (flags & FNM_FILE_NAME))
/* `/' cannot be matched. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
not = (*p == L('!') || (posixly_correct < 0 && *p == L('^')));
if (not)
++p;
c = *p++;
for (;;)
{
UCHAR fn = FOLD ((UCHAR) *n);
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
{
if (*p == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
c = FOLD ((UCHAR) *p);
++p;
if (c == fn)
goto matched;
}
else if (c == L('[') && *p == L(':'))
{
/* Leave room for the null. */
CHAR str[CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH + 1];
size_t c1 = 0;
#if defined _LIBC || (defined HAVE_WCTYPE_H && defined HAVE_WCHAR_H)
wctype_t wt;
#endif
const CHAR *startp = p;
for (;;)
{
if (c1 == CHAR_CLASS_MAX_LENGTH)
/* The name is too long and therefore the pattern
is ill-formed. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
c = *++p;
if (c == L(':') && p[1] == L(']'))
{
p += 2;
break;
}
if (c < L('a') || c >= L('z'))
{
/* This cannot possibly be a character class name.
Match it as a normal range. */
p = startp;
c = L('[');
goto normal_bracket;
}
str[c1++] = c;
}
str[c1] = L('\0');
#if defined _LIBC || (defined HAVE_WCTYPE_H && defined HAVE_WCHAR_H)
wt = IS_CHAR_CLASS (str);
if (wt == 0)
/* Invalid character class name. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
if (ISWCTYPE (BTOWC ((UCHAR) *n), wt))
goto matched;
#else
if ((STREQ (str, L("alnum")) && ISALNUM ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("alpha")) && ISALPHA ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("blank")) && ISBLANK ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("cntrl")) && ISCNTRL ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("digit")) && ISDIGIT ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("graph")) && ISGRAPH ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("lower")) && ISLOWER ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("print")) && ISPRINT ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("punct")) && ISPUNCT ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("space")) && ISSPACE ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("upper")) && ISUPPER ((UCHAR) *n))
|| (STREQ (str, L("xdigit")) && ISXDIGIT ((UCHAR) *n)))
goto matched;
#endif
}
else if (c == L('\0'))
/* [ (unterminated) loses. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
else
{
c = FOLD (c);
normal_bracket:
if (c == fn)
goto matched;
cold = c;
c = *p++;
if (c == L('-') && *p != L(']'))
{
#if _LIBC
/* We have to find the collation sequence
value for C. Collation sequence is nothing
we can regularly access. The sequence
value is defined by the order in which the
definitions of the collation values for the
various characters appear in the source
file. A strange concept, nowhere
documented. */
int32_t fseqidx;
int32_t lseqidx;
UCHAR cend = *p++;
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
size_t cnt;
# endif
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && cend == L('\\'))
cend = *p++;
if (cend == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
/* Search in the `names' array for the characters. */
fseqidx = fn % size;
cnt = 0;
while (names[fseqidx] != fn)
{
if (++cnt == layers)
/* XXX We don't know anything about
the character we are supposed to
match. This means we are failing. */
goto range_not_matched;
fseqidx += size;
}
lseqidx = cold % size;
cnt = 0;
while (names[lseqidx] != cold)
{
if (++cnt == layers)
{
lseqidx = -1;
break;
}
lseqidx += size;
}
# else
fseqidx = fn;
lseqidx = cold;
# endif
/* XXX It is not entirely clear to me how to handle
characters which are not mentioned in the
collation specification. */
if (
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
lseqidx == -1 ||
# endif
collseq[lseqidx] <= collseq[fseqidx])
{
/* We have to look at the upper bound. */
int32_t hseqidx;
cend = FOLD (cend);
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
hseqidx = cend % size;
cnt = 0;
while (names[hseqidx] != cend)
{
if (++cnt == layers)
{
/* Hum, no information about the upper
bound. The matching succeeds if the
lower bound is matched exactly. */
if (lseqidx == -1 || cold != fn)
goto range_not_matched;
goto matched;
}
}
# else
hseqidx = cend;
# endif
if (
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
(lseqidx == -1
&& collseq[fseqidx] == collseq[hseqidx]) ||
# endif
collseq[fseqidx] <= collseq[hseqidx])
goto matched;
}
# ifdef WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
range_not_matched:
# endif
#else
/* We use a boring value comparison of the character
values. This is better than comparing using
`strcoll' since the latter would have surprising
and sometimes fatal consequences. */
UCHAR cend = *p++;
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && cend == L('\\'))
cend = *p++;
if (cend == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
/* It is a range. */
if (cold <= fc && fc <= c)
goto matched;
#endif
c = *p++;
}
}
if (c == L(']'))
break;
}
if (!not)
return FNM_NOMATCH;
break;
matched:
/* Skip the rest of the [...] that already matched. */
while (c != L(']'))
{
if (c == L('\0'))
/* [... (unterminated) loses. */
return FNM_NOMATCH;
c = *p++;
if (!(flags & FNM_NOESCAPE) && c == L('\\'))
{
if (*p == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
/* XXX 1003.2d11 is unclear if this is right. */
++p;
}
else if (c == L('[') && *p == L(':'))
{
do
if (*++p == L('\0'))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
while (*p != L(':') || p[1] == L(']'));
p += 2;
c = *p;
}
}
if (not)
return FNM_NOMATCH;
}
break;
default:
if (c != FOLD ((UCHAR) *n))
return FNM_NOMATCH;
}
++n;
}
if (*n == '\0')
return 0;
if ((flags & FNM_LEADING_DIR) && *n == L('/'))
/* The FNM_LEADING_DIR flag says that "foo*" matches "foobar/frobozz". */
return 0;
return FNM_NOMATCH;
}
#undef FOLD
#undef CHAR
#undef UCHAR
#undef FCT
#undef STRCHR
#undef STRCHRNUL
#undef STRCOLL
#undef L
#undef BTOWC
#undef SUFFIX

View File

@@ -1,50 +0,0 @@
/* full-read.c -- an interface to read that retries after interrupts
Copyright (C) 1993, 1994, 1997, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
*/
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
# include <unistd.h>
#endif
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
/* Read LEN bytes at PTR from descriptor DESC, retrying if interrupted.
Return the actual number of bytes read, zero for EOF, or negative
for an error. */
ssize_t
full_read (int desc, char *ptr, size_t len)
{
for (;;)
{
ssize_t n = read (desc, ptr, len);
#ifdef EINTR
if (n < 0 && errno == EINTR)
continue;
#endif
return n;
}
}

View File

@@ -1,85 +0,0 @@
/* An interface to read and write that retries (if necessary) until complete.
Copyright (C) 1993, 1994, 1997-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
/* Specification. */
#ifdef FULL_READ
# include "full-read.h"
#else
# include "full-write.h"
#endif
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#ifdef FULL_READ
# include "safe-read.h"
# define safe_rw safe_read
# define full_rw full_read
# undef const
# define const /* empty */
#else
# include "safe-write.h"
# define safe_rw safe_write
# define full_rw full_write
#endif
#ifdef FULL_READ
/* Set errno to zero upon EOF. */
# define ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO 0
#else
/* Some buggy drivers return 0 when one tries to write beyond
a device's end. (Example: Linux 1.2.13 on /dev/fd0.)
Set errno to ENOSPC so they get a sensible diagnostic. */
# define ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO ENOSPC
#endif
/* Write(read) COUNT bytes at BUF to(from) descriptor FD, retrying if
interrupted or if a partial write(read) occurs. Return the number
of bytes transferred.
When writing, set errno if fewer than COUNT bytes are written.
When reading, if fewer than COUNT bytes are read, you must examine
errno to distinguish failure from EOF (errno == 0). */
size_t
full_rw (int fd, const void *buf, size_t count)
{
size_t total = 0;
const char *ptr = buf;
while (count > 0)
{
size_t n_rw = safe_rw (fd, ptr, count);
if (n_rw == (size_t) -1)
break;
if (n_rw == 0)
{
errno = ZERO_BYTE_TRANSFER_ERRNO;
break;
}
total += n_rw;
ptr += n_rw;
count -= n_rw;
}
return total;
}

View File

@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
/* An interface to write() that writes all it is asked to write.
Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#include <stddef.h>
/* Write COUNT bytes at BUF to descriptor FD, retrying if interrupted
or if partial writes occur. Return the number of bytes successfully
written, setting errno if that is less than COUNT. */
extern size_t full_write (int fd, const void *buf, size_t count);

File diff suppressed because it is too large Load Diff

View File

@@ -1,366 +0,0 @@
/* human.c -- print human readable file size
Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software
Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Originally contributed by lm@sgi.com;
--si, output block size selection, and large file support
added by eggert@twinsun.com. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
# include <limits.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#else
# include <strings.h>
#endif
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
# define CHAR_BIT 8
#endif
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#ifndef HAVE_DECL_GETENV
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
#endif
#if !HAVE_DECL_GETENV
char *getenv ();
#endif
#if ENABLE_NLS
# include <libintl.h>
# define _(Text) gettext (Text)
#else
# define _(Text) Text
#endif
#include <argmatch.h>
#include <error.h>
#include <xstrtol.h>
#include "human.h"
static const char suffixes[] =
{
0, /* not used */
'K', /* kibi ('k' for kilo is a special case) */
'M', /* mega or mebi */
'G', /* giga or gibi */
'T', /* tera or tebi */
'P', /* peta or pebi */
'E', /* exa or exbi */
'Z', /* zetta or 2**70 */
'Y' /* yotta or 2**80 */
};
/* Generate into P[-1] (and possibly P[-2]) the proper suffix for
POWER and BASE. Return the address of the generated suffix. */
static char *
generate_suffix_backwards (char *p, int power, int base)
{
char letter = suffixes[power];
if (base == 1000)
{
*--p = 'B';
if (power == 1)
letter = 'k';
}
*--p = letter;
return p;
}
/* If INEXACT_STYLE is not human_round_to_even, and if easily
possible, adjust VALUE according to the style. */
static double
adjust_value (enum human_inexact_style inexact_style, double value)
{
/* Do not use the floor or ceil functions, as that would mean
linking with the standard math library, which is a porting pain.
So leave the value alone if it is too large to easily round. */
if (inexact_style != human_round_to_even && value < (uintmax_t) -1)
{
uintmax_t u = value;
value = u + (inexact_style == human_ceiling && u != value);
}
return value;
}
/* Like human_readable_inexact, except always round to even. */
char *
human_readable (uintmax_t n, char *buf,
int from_block_size, int output_block_size)
{
return human_readable_inexact (n, buf, from_block_size, output_block_size,
human_round_to_even);
}
/* Convert N to a human readable format in BUF.
N is expressed in units of FROM_BLOCK_SIZE. FROM_BLOCK_SIZE must
be nonnegative.
OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE must be nonzero. If it is positive, use units of
OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE in the output number.
Use INEXACT_STYLE to determine whether to take the ceiling or floor
of any result that cannot be expressed exactly.
If OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is negative, use a format like "127K" if
possible, using powers of -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE; otherwise, use
ordinary decimal format. Normally -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is either
1000 or 1024; it must be at least 2. Most people visually process
strings of 3-4 digits effectively, but longer strings of digits are
more prone to misinterpretation. Hence, converting to an
abbreviated form usually improves readability. Use a suffix
indicating which power is being used. For example, assuming
-OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is 1024, 8500 would be converted to 8.3K,
133456345 to 127M, 56990456345 to 53G, and so on. Numbers smaller
than -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE aren't modified. If -OUTPUT_BLOCK_SIZE is
1024, append a "B" after any size letter. */
char *
human_readable_inexact (uintmax_t n, char *buf,
int from_block_size, int output_block_size,
enum human_inexact_style inexact_style)
{
uintmax_t amt;
int base;
int to_block_size;
int tenths = 0;
int power;
char *p;
/* 0 means adjusted N == AMT.TENTHS;
1 means AMT.TENTHS < adjusted N < AMT.TENTHS + 0.05;
2 means adjusted N == AMT.TENTHS + 0.05;
3 means AMT.TENTHS + 0.05 < adjusted N < AMT.TENTHS + 0.1. */
int rounding = 0;
if (output_block_size < 0)
{
base = -output_block_size;
to_block_size = 1;
}
else
{
base = 0;
to_block_size = output_block_size;
}
p = buf + LONGEST_HUMAN_READABLE;
*p = '\0';
#ifdef lint
/* Suppress `used before initialized' warning. */
power = 0;
#endif
/* Adjust AMT out of FROM_BLOCK_SIZE units and into TO_BLOCK_SIZE units. */
{
int multiplier;
int divisor;
int r2;
int r10;
if (to_block_size <= from_block_size
? (from_block_size % to_block_size != 0
|| (multiplier = from_block_size / to_block_size,
(amt = n * multiplier) / multiplier != n))
: (from_block_size == 0
|| to_block_size % from_block_size != 0
|| (divisor = to_block_size / from_block_size,
r10 = (n % divisor) * 10,
r2 = (r10 % divisor) * 2,
amt = n / divisor,
tenths = r10 / divisor,
rounding = r2 < divisor ? 0 < r2 : 2 + (divisor < r2),
0)))
{
/* Either the result cannot be computed easily using uintmax_t,
or from_block_size is zero. Fall back on floating point.
FIXME: This can yield answers that are slightly off. */
double damt = n * (from_block_size / (double) to_block_size);
if (! base)
sprintf (buf, "%.0f", adjust_value (inexact_style, damt));
else
{
char suffix[3];
char const *psuffix;
double e = 1;
power = 0;
do
{
e *= base;
power++;
}
while (e * base <= damt && power < sizeof suffixes - 1);
damt /= e;
suffix[2] = '\0';
psuffix = generate_suffix_backwards (suffix + 2, power, base);
sprintf (buf, "%.1f%s",
adjust_value (inexact_style, damt), psuffix);
if (4 + (base == 1000) < strlen (buf))
sprintf (buf, "%.0f%s",
adjust_value (inexact_style, damt * 10) / 10, psuffix);
}
return buf;
}
}
/* Use power of BASE notation if adjusted AMT is large enough. */
if (base && base <= amt)
{
power = 0;
do
{
int r10 = (amt % base) * 10 + tenths;
int r2 = (r10 % base) * 2 + (rounding >> 1);
amt /= base;
tenths = r10 / base;
rounding = (r2 < base
? 0 < r2 + rounding
: 2 + (base < r2 + rounding));
power++;
}
while (base <= amt && power < sizeof suffixes - 1);
p = generate_suffix_backwards (p, power, base);
if (amt < 10)
{
if (2 * (1 - (int) inexact_style)
< rounding + (tenths & (inexact_style == human_round_to_even)))
{
tenths++;
rounding = 0;
if (tenths == 10)
{
amt++;
tenths = 0;
}
}
if (amt < 10)
{
*--p = '0' + tenths;
*--p = '.';
tenths = rounding = 0;
}
}
}
if (inexact_style == human_ceiling
? 0 < tenths + rounding
: inexact_style == human_round_to_even
? 5 < tenths + (2 < rounding + (amt & 1))
: /* inexact_style == human_floor */ 0)
{
amt++;
if (amt == base && power < sizeof suffixes - 1)
{
*p = suffixes[power + 1];
*--p = '0';
*--p = '.';
amt = 1;
}
}
do
*--p = '0' + (int) (amt % 10);
while ((amt /= 10) != 0);
return p;
}
/* The default block size used for output. This number may change in
the future as disks get larger. */
#ifndef DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE
# define DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE 1024
#endif
static char const *const block_size_args[] = { "human-readable", "si", 0 };
static int const block_size_types[] = { -1024, -1000 };
static int
default_block_size (void)
{
return getenv ("POSIXLY_CORRECT") ? 512 : DEFAULT_BLOCK_SIZE;
}
static strtol_error
humblock (char const *spec, int *block_size)
{
int i;
if (! spec && ! (spec = getenv ("BLOCK_SIZE")))
*block_size = default_block_size ();
else if (0 <= (i = ARGMATCH (spec, block_size_args, block_size_types)))
*block_size = block_size_types[i];
else
{
char *ptr;
unsigned long val;
strtol_error e = xstrtoul (spec, &ptr, 0, &val, "eEgGkKmMpPtTyYzZ0");
if (e != LONGINT_OK)
return e;
if (*ptr)
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
if ((int) val < 0 || val != (int) val)
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
*block_size = (int) val;
}
return LONGINT_OK;
}
void
human_block_size (char const *spec, int report_errors, int *block_size)
{
strtol_error e = humblock (spec, block_size);
if (*block_size == 0)
{
*block_size = default_block_size ();
e = LONGINT_INVALID;
}
if (e != LONGINT_OK && report_errors)
STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR (spec, _("block size"), e);
}

View File

@@ -1,46 +0,0 @@
#ifndef HUMAN_H_
# define HUMAN_H_ 1
# if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
# endif
# if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
# include <inttypes.h>
# endif
# if HAVE_LIMITS_H
# include <limits.h>
# endif
# ifndef CHAR_BIT
# define CHAR_BIT 8
# endif
/* A conservative bound on the maximum length of a human-readable string.
The output can be the product of the largest uintmax_t and the largest int,
so add their sizes before converting to a bound on digits. */
# define LONGEST_HUMAN_READABLE ((sizeof (uintmax_t) + sizeof (int)) \
* CHAR_BIT / 3)
# ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
# endif
enum human_inexact_style
{
human_floor = -1,
human_round_to_even = 0,
human_ceiling = 1
};
char *human_readable PARAMS ((uintmax_t, char *, int, int));
char *human_readable_inexact PARAMS ((uintmax_t, char *, int, int,
enum human_inexact_style));
void human_block_size PARAMS ((char const *, int, int *));
#endif /* HUMAN_H_ */

View File

@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
/* Some systems don't have ENOSYS. */
#ifndef ENOSYS
# ifdef ENOTSUP
# define ENOSYS ENOTSUP
# else
/* Some systems don't have ENOTSUP either. */
# define ENOSYS ENOMSG
# endif
#endif

View File

@@ -1,9 +1,9 @@
/* Parse arguments from a string and prepend them to an argv.
Copyright 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
Copyright 1999, 2000, 2001, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -13,8 +13,8 @@
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
02111-1307, USA. */
Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
02110-1301, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com>. */

View File

@@ -1,57 +0,0 @@
/* Print a copyright notice suitable for the current locale.
Copyright (C) 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include "print-copyr.h"
#include <stdio.h>
#if ENABLE_NLS
# include "unicodeio.h"
#else
# define unicode_to_mb(code, callback, error_callback, callback_arg) \
error_callback (code, callback_arg)
#endif
#define COPYRIGHT_SIGN 0x00A9
/* Print "(C)". */
static int
print_parenthesized_c (unsigned int code, void *callback_arg)
{
FILE *stream = callback_arg;
return fputs ("(C)", stream);
}
/* Print "Copyright (C) " followed by NOTICE and then a newline,
transliterating "(C)" to an actual copyright sign (C-in-a-circle)
if possible. */
void
print_copyright (char const *notice)
{
fputs ("Copyright ", stdout);
unicode_to_mb (COPYRIGHT_SIGN, print_unicode_char, print_parenthesized_c,
stdout);
fputc (' ', stdout);
puts (notice);
}

View File

@@ -1,9 +0,0 @@
# ifndef PARAMS
# if PROTOTYPES || (defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(args) args
# else
# define PARAMS(args) ()
# endif
# endif
void print_copyright PARAMS((char const *));

View File

@@ -1,658 +0,0 @@
/* quotearg.c - quote arguments for output
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
# include <stddef.h> /* For the definition of size_t on windows w/MSVC. */
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <quotearg.h>
#include <xalloc.h>
#include <ctype.h>
#if ENABLE_NLS
# include <libintl.h>
# define _(text) gettext (text)
#else
# define _(text) text
#endif
#define N_(text) text
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
# include <limits.h>
#endif
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
# define CHAR_BIT 8
#endif
#ifndef SIZE_MAX
# define SIZE_MAX ((size_t) -1)
#endif
#ifndef UCHAR_MAX
# define UCHAR_MAX ((unsigned char) -1)
#endif
#ifndef UINT_MAX
# define UINT_MAX ((unsigned int) -1)
#endif
#if HAVE_C_BACKSLASH_A
# define ALERT_CHAR '\a'
#else
# define ALERT_CHAR '\7'
#endif
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_WCHAR_H
/* BSD/OS 4.1 wchar.h requires FILE and struct tm to be declared. */
# include <stdio.h>
# include <time.h>
# include <wchar.h>
#endif
#if !HAVE_MBRTOWC
/* Disable multibyte processing entirely. Since MB_CUR_MAX is 1, the
other macros are defined only for documentation and to satisfy C
syntax. */
# undef MB_CUR_MAX
# define MB_CUR_MAX 1
# define mbrtowc(pwc, s, n, ps) ((*(pwc) = *(s)) != 0)
# define mbsinit(ps) 1
# define iswprint(wc) ISPRINT ((unsigned char) (wc))
#endif
#ifndef iswprint
# if HAVE_WCTYPE_H
# include <wctype.h>
# endif
# if !defined iswprint && !HAVE_ISWPRINT
# define iswprint(wc) 1
# endif
#endif
#define INT_BITS (sizeof (int) * CHAR_BIT)
#if defined (STDC_HEADERS) || (!defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII))
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
#else
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
#endif
/* Undefine to protect against the definition in wctype.h of solaris2.6. */
#undef ISPRINT
#define ISPRINT(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isprint (c))
struct quoting_options
{
/* Basic quoting style. */
enum quoting_style style;
/* Quote the characters indicated by this bit vector even if the
quoting style would not normally require them to be quoted. */
int quote_these_too[(UCHAR_MAX / INT_BITS) + 1];
};
/* Names of quoting styles. */
char const *const quoting_style_args[] =
{
"literal",
"shell",
"shell-always",
"c",
"escape",
"locale",
"clocale",
0
};
/* Correspondences to quoting style names. */
enum quoting_style const quoting_style_vals[] =
{
literal_quoting_style,
shell_quoting_style,
shell_always_quoting_style,
c_quoting_style,
escape_quoting_style,
locale_quoting_style,
clocale_quoting_style
};
/* The default quoting options. */
static struct quoting_options default_quoting_options;
/* Allocate a new set of quoting options, with contents initially identical
to O if O is not null, or to the default if O is null.
It is the caller's responsibility to free the result. */
struct quoting_options *
clone_quoting_options (struct quoting_options *o)
{
struct quoting_options *p
= (struct quoting_options *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct quoting_options));
*p = *(o ? o : &default_quoting_options);
return p;
}
/* Get the value of O's quoting style. If O is null, use the default. */
enum quoting_style
get_quoting_style (struct quoting_options *o)
{
return (o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->style;
}
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
set the value of the quoting style to S. */
void
set_quoting_style (struct quoting_options *o, enum quoting_style s)
{
(o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->style = s;
}
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
set the value of the quoting options for character C to I.
Return the old value. Currently, the only values defined for I are
0 (the default) and 1 (which means to quote the character even if
it would not otherwise be quoted). */
int
set_char_quoting (struct quoting_options *o, char c, int i)
{
unsigned char uc = c;
int *p = (o ? o : &default_quoting_options)->quote_these_too + uc / INT_BITS;
int shift = uc % INT_BITS;
int r = (*p >> shift) & 1;
*p ^= ((i & 1) ^ r) << shift;
return r;
}
/* MSGID approximates a quotation mark. Return its translation if it
has one; otherwise, return either it or "\"", depending on S. */
static char const *
gettext_quote (char const *msgid, enum quoting_style s)
{
char const *translation = _(msgid);
if (translation == msgid && s == clocale_quoting_style)
translation = "\"";
return translation;
}
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using QUOTING_STYLE and the
non-quoting-style part of O to control quoting.
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE.
This function acts like quotearg_buffer (BUFFER, BUFFERSIZE, ARG,
ARGSIZE, O), except it uses QUOTING_STYLE instead of the quoting
style specified by O, and O may not be null. */
static size_t
quotearg_buffer_restyled (char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
enum quoting_style quoting_style,
struct quoting_options const *o)
{
size_t i;
size_t len = 0;
char const *quote_string = 0;
size_t quote_string_len = 0;
int backslash_escapes = 0;
int unibyte_locale = MB_CUR_MAX == 1;
#define STORE(c) \
do \
{ \
if (len < buffersize) \
buffer[len] = (c); \
len++; \
} \
while (0)
switch (quoting_style)
{
case c_quoting_style:
STORE ('"');
backslash_escapes = 1;
quote_string = "\"";
quote_string_len = 1;
break;
case escape_quoting_style:
backslash_escapes = 1;
break;
case locale_quoting_style:
case clocale_quoting_style:
{
/* Get translations for open and closing quotation marks.
The message catalog should translate "`" to a left
quotation mark suitable for the locale, and similarly for
"'". If the catalog has no translation,
locale_quoting_style quotes `like this', and
clocale_quoting_style quotes "like this".
For example, an American English Unicode locale should
translate "`" to U+201C (LEFT DOUBLE QUOTATION MARK), and
should translate "'" to U+201D (RIGHT DOUBLE QUOTATION
MARK). A British English Unicode locale should instead
translate these to U+2018 (LEFT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK) and
U+2019 (RIGHT SINGLE QUOTATION MARK), respectively. */
char const *left = gettext_quote (N_("`"), quoting_style);
char const *right = gettext_quote (N_("'"), quoting_style);
for (quote_string = left; *quote_string; quote_string++)
STORE (*quote_string);
backslash_escapes = 1;
quote_string = right;
quote_string_len = strlen (quote_string);
}
break;
case shell_always_quoting_style:
STORE ('\'');
quote_string = "'";
quote_string_len = 1;
break;
default:
break;
}
for (i = 0; ! (argsize == (size_t) -1 ? arg[i] == '\0' : i == argsize); i++)
{
unsigned char c;
unsigned char esc;
if (backslash_escapes
&& quote_string_len
&& i + quote_string_len <= argsize
&& memcmp (arg + i, quote_string, quote_string_len) == 0)
STORE ('\\');
c = arg[i];
switch (c)
{
case '\0':
if (backslash_escapes)
{
STORE ('\\');
STORE ('0');
STORE ('0');
c = '0';
}
break;
case '?':
switch (quoting_style)
{
case shell_quoting_style:
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
case c_quoting_style:
if (i + 2 < argsize && arg[i + 1] == '?')
switch (arg[i + 2])
{
case '!': case '\'':
case '(': case ')': case '-': case '/':
case '<': case '=': case '>':
/* Escape the second '?' in what would otherwise be
a trigraph. */
i += 2;
c = arg[i + 2];
STORE ('?');
STORE ('\\');
STORE ('?');
break;
}
break;
default:
break;
}
break;
case ALERT_CHAR: esc = 'a'; goto c_escape;
case '\b': esc = 'b'; goto c_escape;
case '\f': esc = 'f'; goto c_escape;
case '\n': esc = 'n'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
case '\r': esc = 'r'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
case '\t': esc = 't'; goto c_and_shell_escape;
case '\v': esc = 'v'; goto c_escape;
case '\\': esc = c; goto c_and_shell_escape;
c_and_shell_escape:
if (quoting_style == shell_quoting_style)
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
c_escape:
if (backslash_escapes)
{
c = esc;
goto store_escape;
}
break;
case '#': case '~':
if (i != 0)
break;
/* Fall through. */
case ' ':
case '!': /* special in bash */
case '"': case '$': case '&':
case '(': case ')': case '*': case ';':
case '<': case '>': case '[':
case '^': /* special in old /bin/sh, e.g. SunOS 4.1.4 */
case '`': case '|':
/* A shell special character. In theory, '$' and '`' could
be the first bytes of multibyte characters, which means
we should check them with mbrtowc, but in practice this
doesn't happen so it's not worth worrying about. */
if (quoting_style == shell_quoting_style)
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
break;
case '\'':
switch (quoting_style)
{
case shell_quoting_style:
goto use_shell_always_quoting_style;
case shell_always_quoting_style:
STORE ('\'');
STORE ('\\');
STORE ('\'');
break;
default:
break;
}
break;
case '%': case '+': case ',': case '-': case '.': case '/':
case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4': case '5':
case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9': case ':': case '=':
case 'A': case 'B': case 'C': case 'D': case 'E': case 'F':
case 'G': case 'H': case 'I': case 'J': case 'K': case 'L':
case 'M': case 'N': case 'O': case 'P': case 'Q': case 'R':
case 'S': case 'T': case 'U': case 'V': case 'W': case 'X':
case 'Y': case 'Z': case ']': case '_': case 'a': case 'b':
case 'c': case 'd': case 'e': case 'f': case 'g': case 'h':
case 'i': case 'j': case 'k': case 'l': case 'm': case 'n':
case 'o': case 'p': case 'q': case 'r': case 's': case 't':
case 'u': case 'v': case 'w': case 'x': case 'y': case 'z':
case '{': case '}':
/* These characters don't cause problems, no matter what the
quoting style is. They cannot start multibyte sequences. */
break;
default:
/* If we have a multibyte sequence, copy it until we reach
its end, find an error, or come back to the initial shift
state. For C-like styles, if the sequence has
unprintable characters, escape the whole sequence, since
we can't easily escape single characters within it. */
{
/* Length of multibyte sequence found so far. */
size_t m;
int printable;
if (unibyte_locale)
{
m = 1;
printable = ISPRINT (c);
}
else
{
mbstate_t mbstate;
memset (&mbstate, 0, sizeof mbstate);
m = 0;
printable = 1;
if (argsize == (size_t) -1)
argsize = strlen (arg);
do
{
wchar_t w;
size_t bytes = mbrtowc (&w, &arg[i + m],
argsize - (i + m), &mbstate);
if (bytes == 0)
break;
else if (bytes == (size_t) -1)
{
printable = 0;
break;
}
else if (bytes == (size_t) -2)
{
printable = 0;
while (i + m < argsize && arg[i + m])
m++;
break;
}
else
{
if (! iswprint (w))
printable = 0;
m += bytes;
}
}
while (! mbsinit (&mbstate));
}
if (1 < m || (backslash_escapes && ! printable))
{
/* Output a multibyte sequence, or an escaped
unprintable unibyte character. */
size_t ilim = i + m;
for (;;)
{
if (backslash_escapes && ! printable)
{
STORE ('\\');
STORE ('0' + (c >> 6));
STORE ('0' + ((c >> 3) & 7));
c = '0' + (c & 7);
}
if (ilim <= i + 1)
break;
STORE (c);
c = arg[++i];
}
goto store_c;
}
}
}
if (! (backslash_escapes
&& o->quote_these_too[c / INT_BITS] & (1 << (c % INT_BITS))))
goto store_c;
store_escape:
STORE ('\\');
store_c:
STORE (c);
}
if (quote_string)
for (; *quote_string; quote_string++)
STORE (*quote_string);
if (len < buffersize)
buffer[len] = '\0';
return len;
use_shell_always_quoting_style:
return quotearg_buffer_restyled (buffer, buffersize, arg, argsize,
shell_always_quoting_style, o);
}
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using O to control quoting.
If O is null, use the default.
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE. */
size_t
quotearg_buffer (char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
struct quoting_options const *o)
{
struct quoting_options const *p = o ? o : &default_quoting_options;
return quotearg_buffer_restyled (buffer, buffersize, arg, argsize,
p->style, p);
}
/* Use storage slot N to return a quoted version of argument ARG.
ARG is of size ARGSIZE, but if that is -1, ARG is a null-terminated string.
OPTIONS specifies the quoting options.
The returned value points to static storage that can be
reused by the next call to this function with the same value of N.
N must be nonnegative. N is deliberately declared with type "int"
to allow for future extensions (using negative values). */
static char *
quotearg_n_options (int n, char const *arg, size_t argsize,
struct quoting_options const *options)
{
/* Preallocate a slot 0 buffer, so that the caller can always quote
one small component of a "memory exhausted" message in slot 0. */
static char slot0[256];
static unsigned int nslots = 1;
unsigned int n0 = n;
struct slotvec
{
size_t size;
char *val;
};
static struct slotvec slotvec0 = {sizeof slot0, slot0};
static struct slotvec *slotvec = &slotvec0;
if (n < 0)
abort ();
if (nslots <= n0)
{
unsigned int n1 = n0 + 1;
size_t s = n1 * sizeof *slotvec;
if (SIZE_MAX / UINT_MAX <= sizeof *slotvec
&& n1 != s / sizeof *slotvec)
xalloc_die ();
if (slotvec == &slotvec0)
{
slotvec = (struct slotvec *) xmalloc (sizeof *slotvec);
*slotvec = slotvec0;
}
slotvec = (struct slotvec *) xrealloc (slotvec, s);
memset (slotvec + nslots, 0, (n1 - nslots) * sizeof *slotvec);
nslots = n1;
}
{
size_t size = slotvec[n].size;
char *val = slotvec[n].val;
size_t qsize = quotearg_buffer (val, size, arg, argsize, options);
if (size <= qsize)
{
slotvec[n].size = size = qsize + 1;
slotvec[n].val = val = xrealloc (val == slot0 ? 0 : val, size);
quotearg_buffer (val, size, arg, argsize, options);
}
return val;
}
}
char *
quotearg_n (int n, char const *arg)
{
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, (size_t) -1, &default_quoting_options);
}
char *
quotearg (char const *arg)
{
return quotearg_n (0, arg);
}
/* Return quoting options for STYLE, with no extra quoting. */
static struct quoting_options
quoting_options_from_style (enum quoting_style style)
{
struct quoting_options o;
o.style = style;
memset (o.quote_these_too, 0, sizeof o.quote_these_too);
return o;
}
char *
quotearg_n_style (int n, enum quoting_style s, char const *arg)
{
struct quoting_options const o = quoting_options_from_style (s);
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, (size_t) -1, &o);
}
char *
quotearg_n_style_mem (int n, enum quoting_style s,
char const *arg, size_t argsize)
{
struct quoting_options const o = quoting_options_from_style (s);
return quotearg_n_options (n, arg, argsize, &o);
}
char *
quotearg_style (enum quoting_style s, char const *arg)
{
return quotearg_n_style (0, s, arg);
}
char *
quotearg_char (char const *arg, char ch)
{
struct quoting_options options;
options = default_quoting_options;
set_char_quoting (&options, ch, 1);
return quotearg_n_options (0, arg, (size_t) -1, &options);
}
char *
quotearg_colon (char const *arg)
{
return quotearg_char (arg, ':');
}

View File

@@ -1,100 +0,0 @@
/* quotearg.h - quote arguments for output
Copyright (C) 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert <eggert@twinsun.com> */
/* Basic quoting styles. */
enum quoting_style
{
literal_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=literal */
shell_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=shell */
shell_always_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=shell-always */
c_quoting_style, /* --quoting-style=c */
escape_quoting_style /* --quoting-style=escape */
};
/* For now, --quoting-style=literal is the default, but
this is planned to change to --quoting-style=shell in the future. */
#ifndef DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE
# define DEFAULT_QUOTING_STYLE literal_quoting_style
#endif
/* Names of quoting styles and their corresponding values. */
extern char const *const quoting_style_args[];
extern enum quoting_style const quoting_style_vals[];
struct quoting_options;
#ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || defined __STDC__
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
#endif
/* The functions listed below set and use a hidden variable
that contains the default quoting style options. */
/* Allocate a new set of quoting options, with contents initially identical
to O if O is not null, or to the default if O is null.
It is the caller's responsibility to free the result. */
struct quoting_options *clone_quoting_options
PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o));
/* Get the value of O's quoting style. If O is null, use the default. */
enum quoting_style get_quoting_style PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o));
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
set the value of the quoting style to S. */
void set_quoting_style PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o,
enum quoting_style s));
/* In O (or in the default if O is null),
set the value of the quoting options for character C to I.
Return the old value. Currently, the only values defined for I are
0 (the default) and 1 (which means to quote the character even if
it would not otherwise be quoted). */
int set_char_quoting PARAMS ((struct quoting_options *o, char c, int i));
/* Place into buffer BUFFER (of size BUFFERSIZE) a quoted version of
argument ARG (of size ARGSIZE), using O to control quoting.
If O is null, use the default.
Terminate the output with a null character, and return the written
size of the output, not counting the terminating null.
If BUFFERSIZE is too small to store the output string, return the
value that would have been returned had BUFFERSIZE been large enough.
If ARGSIZE is -1, use the string length of the argument for ARGSIZE. */
size_t quotearg_buffer PARAMS ((char *buffer, size_t buffersize,
char const *arg, size_t argsize,
struct quoting_options const *o));
/* Use storage slot N to return a quoted version of the string ARG.
Use the default quoting options.
The returned value points to static storage that can be
reused by the next call to this function with the same value of N.
N must be nonnegative. */
char *quotearg_n PARAMS ((unsigned int n, char const *arg));
/* Equivalent to quotearg_n (0, ARG). */
char *quotearg PARAMS ((char const *arg));
/* Like quotearg (ARG), except also quote any instances of CH. */
char *quotearg_char PARAMS ((char const *arg, char ch));
/* Equivalent to quotearg_char (ARG, ':'). */
char *quotearg_colon PARAMS ((char const *arg));

View File

@@ -1,10 +0,0 @@
#ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
#endif
ssize_t full_write PARAMS ((int desc, const char *ptr, size_t len));
ssize_t safe_read PARAMS ((int desc, void *ptr, size_t len));

View File

@@ -1,129 +0,0 @@
/* savedir.c -- save the list of files in a directory in a string
Copyright 1990, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001 Free Software
Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#if HAVE_DIRENT_H
# include <dirent.h>
#else
# define dirent direct
# if HAVE_SYS_NDIR_H
# include <sys/ndir.h>
# endif
# if HAVE_SYS_DIR_H
# include <sys/dir.h>
# endif
# if HAVE_NDIR_H
# include <ndir.h>
# endif
#endif
#ifdef CLOSEDIR_VOID
/* Fake a return value. */
# define CLOSEDIR(d) (closedir (d), 0)
#else
# define CLOSEDIR(d) closedir (d)
#endif
#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
# include <stdlib.h>
# include <string.h>
#endif
#ifndef NULL
# define NULL 0
#endif
#include "savedir.h"
#include "xalloc.h"
/* Return a freshly allocated string containing the filenames
in directory DIR, separated by '\0' characters;
the end is marked by two '\0' characters in a row.
Return NULL (setting errno) if DIR cannot be opened, read, or closed. */
#ifndef NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT
# define NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT 512
#endif
char *
savedir (const char *dir)
{
DIR *dirp;
struct dirent *dp;
char *name_space;
size_t allocated = NAME_SIZE_DEFAULT;
size_t used = 0;
int save_errno;
dirp = opendir (dir);
if (dirp == NULL)
return NULL;
name_space = xmalloc (allocated);
errno = 0;
while ((dp = readdir (dirp)) != NULL)
{
/* Skip "", ".", and "..". "" is returned by at least one buggy
implementation: Solaris 2.4 readdir on NFS filesystems. */
char const *entry = dp->d_name;
if (entry[entry[0] != '.' ? 0 : entry[1] != '.' ? 1 : 2] != '\0')
{
size_t entry_size = strlen (entry) + 1;
if (used + entry_size < used)
xalloc_die ();
if (allocated <= used + entry_size)
{
do
{
if (2 * allocated < allocated)
xalloc_die ();
allocated *= 2;
}
while (allocated <= used + entry_size);
name_space = xrealloc (name_space, allocated);
}
memcpy (name_space + used, entry, entry_size);
used += entry_size;
}
}
name_space[used] = '\0';
save_errno = errno;
if (CLOSEDIR (dirp) != 0)
save_errno = errno;
if (save_errno != 0)
{
free (name_space);
errno = save_errno;
return NULL;
}
return name_space;
}

View File

@@ -1,14 +0,0 @@
#if !defined SAVEDIR_H_
# define SAVEDIR_H_
# ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
# endif
char *savedir PARAMS ((const char *dir));
#endif

77
lib/stdopen.c Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
/* stdopen.c - ensure that the three standard file descriptors are in use
Copyright (C) 2005, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert and Jim Meyering. */
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include "stdopen.h"
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <fcntl.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include <errno.h>
/* Try to ensure that all of the standard file numbers (0, 1, 2)
are in use. Without this, each application would have to guard
every call to open, dup, fopen, etc. with tests to ensure they
don't use one of the special file numbers when opening a file.
Return false if at least one of the file descriptors is initially
closed and an attempt to reopen it fails. Otherwise, return true. */
bool
stdopen (void)
{
int fd;
bool ok = true;
for (fd = 0; fd <= 2; fd++)
{
if (fcntl (fd, F_GETFD) < 0)
{
if (errno != EBADF)
ok = false;
else
{
static const int contrary_mode[]
= { O_WRONLY, O_RDONLY, O_RDONLY };
int mode = contrary_mode[fd];
int new_fd;
/* Open /dev/null with the contrary mode so that the typical
read (stdin) or write (stdout, stderr) operation will fail.
With descriptor 0, we can do even better on systems that
have /dev/full, by opening that write-only instead of
/dev/null. The only drawback is that a write-provoked
failure comes with a misleading errno value, ENOSPC. */
if (mode == O_RDONLY
|| (new_fd = open ("/dev/full", mode) != fd))
new_fd = open ("/dev/null", mode);
if (new_fd != fd)
{
if (0 <= new_fd)
close (new_fd);
ok = false;
}
}
}
}
return ok;
}

16
lib/stdopen.h Normal file
View File

@@ -0,0 +1,16 @@
#ifndef STDOPEN_H
# define STDOPEN_H 1
# include <stdbool.h>
# ifdef __cplusplus
extern "C" {
# endif
bool stdopen (void);
# ifdef __cplusplus
}
# endif
#endif

View File

@@ -1,101 +0,0 @@
/* Convert string representation of a number into an intmax_t value.
Copyright (C) 1999, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Paul Eggert. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
# include <inttypes.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || defined __STDC__
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
#endif
/* Verify a requirement at compile-time (unlike assert, which is runtime). */
#define verify(name, assertion) struct name { char a[(assertion) ? 1 : -1]; }
#ifdef UNSIGNED
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL
unsigned long strtoul PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
# endif
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOULL && HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
unsigned long long strtoull PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
# endif
#else
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOL
long strtol PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
# endif
# ifndef HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL
"this configure-time declaration test was not run"
# endif
# if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOLL && HAVE_LONG_LONG
long long strtoll PARAMS ((char const *, char **, int));
# endif
#endif
#ifdef UNSIGNED
# undef HAVE_LONG_LONG
# define HAVE_LONG_LONG HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG
# define INT uintmax_t
# define strtoimax strtoumax
# define strtol strtoul
# define strtoll strtoull
#else
# define INT intmax_t
#endif
INT
strtoimax (char const *ptr, char **endptr, int base)
{
#if HAVE_LONG_LONG
verify (size_is_that_of_long_or_long_long,
(sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long)
|| sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long long)));
if (sizeof (INT) != sizeof (long))
return strtoll (ptr, endptr, base);
#else
verify (size_is_that_of_long,
sizeof (INT) == sizeof (long));
#endif
return strtol (ptr, endptr, base);
}

View File

@@ -1,2 +0,0 @@
#define UNSIGNED 1
#include "strtoimax.c"

View File

@@ -1,263 +0,0 @@
/* Unicode character output to streams with locale dependent encoding.
Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
USA. */
/* Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>. */
/* Note: This file requires the locale_charset() function. See in
libiconv-1.7/libcharset/INTEGRATE for how to obtain it. */
#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
# include <stddef.h>
#endif
#include <stdio.h>
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#else
# include <strings.h>
#endif
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#if HAVE_ICONV
# include <iconv.h>
#endif
#include <error.h>
#if ENABLE_NLS
# include <libintl.h>
#else
# define gettext(Text) Text
#endif
#define _(Text) gettext (Text)
#define N_(Text) Text
/* Specification. */
#include "unicodeio.h"
/* When we pass a Unicode character to iconv(), we must pass it in a
suitable encoding. The standardized Unicode encodings are
UTF-8, UCS-2, UCS-4, UTF-16, UTF-16BE, UTF-16LE, UTF-7.
UCS-2 supports only characters up to \U0000FFFF.
UTF-16 and variants support only characters up to \U0010FFFF.
UTF-7 is way too complex and not supported by glibc-2.1.
UCS-4 specification leaves doubts about endianness and byte order
mark. glibc currently interprets it as big endian without byte order
mark, but this is not backed by an RFC.
So we use UTF-8. It supports characters up to \U7FFFFFFF and is
unambiguously defined. */
/* Stores the UTF-8 representation of the Unicode character wc in r[0..5].
Returns the number of bytes stored, or -1 if wc is out of range. */
static int
utf8_wctomb (unsigned char *r, unsigned int wc)
{
int count;
if (wc < 0x80)
count = 1;
else if (wc < 0x800)
count = 2;
else if (wc < 0x10000)
count = 3;
else if (wc < 0x200000)
count = 4;
else if (wc < 0x4000000)
count = 5;
else if (wc <= 0x7fffffff)
count = 6;
else
return -1;
switch (count)
{
/* Note: code falls through cases! */
case 6: r[5] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x4000000;
case 5: r[4] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x200000;
case 4: r[3] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x10000;
case 3: r[2] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0x800;
case 2: r[1] = 0x80 | (wc & 0x3f); wc = wc >> 6; wc |= 0xc0;
case 1: r[0] = wc;
}
return count;
}
/* Luckily, the encoding's name is platform independent. */
#define UTF8_NAME "UTF-8"
/* Converts the Unicode character CODE to its multibyte representation
in the current locale and calls the SUCCESS callback on the resulting
byte sequence. If an error occurs, invokes the FAILURE callback instead,
passing it CODE and an English error string.
Returns whatever the callback returned.
Assumes that the locale doesn't change between two calls. */
long
unicode_to_mb (unsigned int code,
long (*success) PARAMS ((const char *buf, size_t buflen,
void *callback_arg)),
long (*failure) PARAMS ((unsigned int code, const char *msg,
void *callback_arg)),
void *callback_arg)
{
static int initialized;
static int is_utf8;
#if HAVE_ICONV
static iconv_t utf8_to_local;
#endif
char inbuf[6];
int count;
if (!initialized)
{
extern const char *locale_charset PARAMS ((void));
const char *charset = locale_charset ();
is_utf8 = !strcmp (charset, UTF8_NAME);
#if HAVE_ICONV
if (!is_utf8)
{
utf8_to_local = iconv_open (charset, UTF8_NAME);
if (utf8_to_local == (iconv_t)(-1))
/* For an unknown encoding, assume ASCII. */
utf8_to_local = iconv_open ("ASCII", UTF8_NAME);
}
#endif
initialized = 1;
}
/* Test whether the utf8_to_local converter is available at all. */
if (!is_utf8)
{
#if HAVE_ICONV
if (utf8_to_local == (iconv_t)(-1))
return failure (code, N_("iconv function not usable"), callback_arg);
#else
return failure (code, N_("iconv function not available"), callback_arg);
#endif
}
/* Convert the character to UTF-8. */
count = utf8_wctomb ((unsigned char *) inbuf, code);
if (count < 0)
return failure (code, N_("character out of range"), callback_arg);
#if HAVE_ICONV
if (!is_utf8)
{
char outbuf[25];
const char *inptr;
size_t inbytesleft;
char *outptr;
size_t outbytesleft;
size_t res;
inptr = inbuf;
inbytesleft = count;
outptr = outbuf;
outbytesleft = sizeof (outbuf);
/* Convert the character from UTF-8 to the locale's charset. */
res = iconv (utf8_to_local,
(ICONV_CONST char **)&inptr, &inbytesleft,
&outptr, &outbytesleft);
if (inbytesleft > 0 || res == (size_t)(-1)
/* Irix iconv() inserts a NUL byte if it cannot convert. */
# if !defined _LIBICONV_VERSION && (defined sgi || defined __sgi)
|| (res > 0 && code != 0 && outptr - outbuf == 1 && *outbuf == '\0')
# endif
)
return failure (code, NULL, callback_arg);
/* Avoid glibc-2.1 bug and Solaris 2.7 bug. */
# if defined _LIBICONV_VERSION \
|| !((__GLIBC__ - 0 == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ - 0 <= 1) || defined __sun)
/* Get back to the initial shift state. */
res = iconv (utf8_to_local, NULL, NULL, &outptr, &outbytesleft);
if (res == (size_t)(-1))
return failure (code, NULL, callback_arg);
# endif
return success (outbuf, outptr - outbuf, callback_arg);
}
#endif
/* At this point, is_utf8 is true, so no conversion is needed. */
return success (inbuf, count, callback_arg);
}
/* Simple success callback that outputs the converted string.
The STREAM is passed as callback_arg. */
long
fwrite_success_callback (const char *buf, size_t buflen, void *callback_arg)
{
FILE *stream = (FILE *) callback_arg;
fwrite (buf, 1, buflen, stream);
return 0;
}
/* Simple failure callback that displays an error and exits. */
static long
exit_failure_callback (unsigned int code, const char *msg, void *callback_arg)
{
if (msg == NULL)
error (1, 0, _("cannot convert U+%04X to local character set"), code);
else
error (1, 0, _("cannot convert U+%04X to local character set: %s"), code,
gettext (msg));
return -1;
}
/* Simple failure callback that displays a fallback representation in plain
ASCII, using the same notation as ISO C99 strings. */
static long
fallback_failure_callback (unsigned int code, const char *msg, void *callback_arg)
{
FILE *stream = (FILE *) callback_arg;
if (code < 0x10000)
fprintf (stream, "\\u%04X", code);
else
fprintf (stream, "\\U%08X", code);
return -1;
}
/* Outputs the Unicode character CODE to the output stream STREAM.
Upon failure, exit if exit_on_error is true, otherwise output a fallback
notation. */
void
print_unicode_char (FILE *stream, unsigned int code, int exit_on_error)
{
unicode_to_mb (code, fwrite_success_callback,
exit_on_error
? exit_failure_callback
: fallback_failure_callback,
stream);
}

View File

@@ -1,44 +0,0 @@
/* Unicode character output to streams with locale dependent encoding.
Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
Library General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
USA. */
#ifndef UNICODEIO_H
# define UNICODEIO_H
# include <stdio.h>
# ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
# endif
/* Outputs the Unicode character CODE to the output stream STREAM.
Upon failure, exit if exit_on_error is true, otherwise output a fallback
notation. */
extern void print_unicode_char PARAMS ((FILE *stream, unsigned int code,
int exit_on_error));
/* Simple success callback that outputs the converted string.
The STREAM is passed as callback_arg. */
extern long fwrite_success_callback PARAMS ((const char *buf, size_t buflen,
void *callback_arg));
#endif

View File

@@ -1,75 +0,0 @@
/* Emulate waitpid on systems that just have wait.
Copyright 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; see the file COPYING.
If not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#define WAITPID_CHILDREN 8
static pid_t waited_pid[WAITPID_CHILDREN];
static int waited_status[WAITPID_CHILDREN];
pid_t
waitpid (pid_t pid, int *stat_loc, int options)
{
int i;
pid_t p;
if (!options && (pid == -1 || 0 < pid))
{
/* If we have already waited for this child, return it immediately. */
for (i = 0; i < WAITPID_CHILDREN; i++)
{
p = waited_pid[i];
if (p && (p == pid || pid == -1))
{
waited_pid[i] = 0;
goto success;
}
}
/* The child has not returned yet; wait for it, accumulating status. */
for (i = 0; i < WAITPID_CHILDREN; i++)
if (! waited_pid[i])
{
p = wait (&waited_status[i]);
if (p < 0)
return p;
if (p == pid || pid == -1)
goto success;
waited_pid[i] = p;
}
}
/* We cannot emulate this wait call, e.g. because of too many children. */
errno = EINVAL;
return -1;
success:
if (stat_loc)
*stat_loc = waited_status[i];
return p;
}

View File

@@ -1,87 +0,0 @@
/* xalloc.h -- malloc with out-of-memory checking
Copyright (C) 1990-1998, 1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#ifndef XALLOC_H_
# define XALLOC_H_
# ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
# endif
# ifndef __attribute__
# if __GNUC__ < 2 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 8) || __STRICT_ANSI__
# define __attribute__(x)
# endif
# endif
# ifndef ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
# define ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN __attribute__ ((__noreturn__))
# endif
/* Exit value when the requested amount of memory is not available.
It is initialized to EXIT_FAILURE, but the caller may set it to
some other value. */
extern int xalloc_exit_failure;
/* If this pointer is non-zero, run the specified function upon each
allocation failure. It is initialized to zero. */
extern void (*xalloc_fail_func) PARAMS ((void));
/* If XALLOC_FAIL_FUNC is undefined or a function that returns, this
message is output. It is translated via gettext.
Its value is "memory exhausted". */
extern char const xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted[];
/* This function is always triggered when memory is exhausted. It is
in charge of honoring the three previous items. This is the
function to call when one wants the program to die because of a
memory allocation failure. */
extern void xalloc_die PARAMS ((void)) ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN;
void *xmalloc PARAMS ((size_t n));
void *xcalloc PARAMS ((size_t n, size_t s));
void *xrealloc PARAMS ((void *p, size_t n));
char *xstrdup PARAMS ((const char *str));
# define XMALLOC(Type, N_items) ((Type *) xmalloc (sizeof (Type) * (N_items)))
# define XCALLOC(Type, N_items) ((Type *) xcalloc (sizeof (Type), (N_items)))
# define XREALLOC(Ptr, Type, N_items) \
((Type *) xrealloc ((void *) (Ptr), sizeof (Type) * (N_items)))
/* Declare and alloc memory for VAR of type TYPE. */
# define NEW(Type, Var) Type *(Var) = XMALLOC (Type, 1)
/* Free VAR only if non NULL. */
# define XFREE(Var) \
do { \
if (Var) \
free (Var); \
} while (0)
/* Return a pointer to a malloc'ed copy of the array SRC of NUM elements. */
# define CCLONE(Src, Num) \
(memcpy (xmalloc (sizeof (*Src) * (Num)), (Src), sizeof (*Src) * (Num)))
/* Return a malloc'ed copy of SRC. */
# define CLONE(Src) CCLONE (Src, 1)
#endif /* !XALLOC_H_ */

View File

@@ -1,79 +0,0 @@
/* xgetcwd.c -- return current directory with unlimited length
Copyright (C) 1992, 1996, 2000, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by David MacKenzie <djm@gnu.ai.mit.edu>. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <stdio.h>
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_UNISTD_H
# include <unistd.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_GETCWD
char *getcwd ();
#else
char *getwd ();
# define getcwd(Buf, Max) getwd (Buf)
#endif
#include "xalloc.h"
/* Return the current directory, newly allocated, arbitrarily long.
Return NULL and set errno on error. */
char *
xgetcwd ()
{
#if defined __GLIBC__ && __GLIBC__ >= 2
return getcwd (NULL, 0);
#else
size_t buf_size = 128; /* must be a power of 2 */
char *buf = NULL;
while (1)
{
char *cwd;
buf = (char *) xrealloc (buf, buf_size);
cwd = getcwd (buf, buf_size);
if (cwd != NULL)
return cwd;
if (errno != ERANGE)
{
free (buf);
return NULL;
}
buf_size *= 2;
if (buf_size == 0)
xalloc_die ();
}
#endif
}

View File

@@ -1,116 +0,0 @@
/* xmalloc.c -- malloc with out of memory checking
Copyright (C) 1990-1999, 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#include <sys/types.h>
#if STDC_HEADERS
# include <stdlib.h>
#else
void *calloc ();
void *malloc ();
void *realloc ();
void free ();
#endif
#if ENABLE_NLS
# include <libintl.h>
# define _(Text) gettext (Text)
#else
# define textdomain(Domain)
# define _(Text) Text
#endif
#define N_(Text) Text
#include "error.h"
#include "xalloc.h"
#ifndef EXIT_FAILURE
# define EXIT_FAILURE 1
#endif
#ifndef HAVE_DONE_WORKING_MALLOC_CHECK
"you must run the autoconf test for a properly working malloc -- see malloc.m4"
#endif
#ifndef HAVE_DONE_WORKING_REALLOC_CHECK
"you must run the autoconf test for a properly working realloc --see realloc.m4"
#endif
/* Exit value when the requested amount of memory is not available.
The caller may set it to some other value. */
int xalloc_exit_failure = EXIT_FAILURE;
/* If non NULL, call this function when memory is exhausted. */
void (*xalloc_fail_func) PARAMS ((void)) = 0;
/* If XALLOC_FAIL_FUNC is NULL, or does return, display this message
before exiting when memory is exhausted. Goes through gettext. */
char const xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted[] = N_("memory exhausted");
void
xalloc_die (void)
{
if (xalloc_fail_func)
(*xalloc_fail_func) ();
error (xalloc_exit_failure, 0, "%s", _(xalloc_msg_memory_exhausted));
/* The `noreturn' cannot be given to error, since it may return if
its first argument is 0. To help compilers understand the
xalloc_die does terminate, call exit. */
exit (EXIT_FAILURE);
}
/* Allocate N bytes of memory dynamically, with error checking. */
void *
xmalloc (size_t n)
{
void *p;
p = malloc (n);
if (p == 0)
xalloc_die ();
return p;
}
/* Change the size of an allocated block of memory P to N bytes,
with error checking. */
void *
xrealloc (void *p, size_t n)
{
p = realloc (p, n);
if (p == 0)
xalloc_die ();
return p;
}
/* Allocate memory for N elements of S bytes, with error checking. */
void *
xcalloc (size_t n, size_t s)
{
void *p;
p = calloc (n, s);
if (p == 0)
xalloc_die ();
return p;
}

View File

@@ -1,288 +0,0 @@
/* A more useful interface to strtol.
Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1998-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
/* Written by Jim Meyering. */
#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
# include <config.h>
#endif
#ifndef __strtol
# define __strtol strtol
# define __strtol_t long int
# define __xstrtol xstrtol
#endif
/* Some pre-ANSI implementations (e.g. SunOS 4)
need stderr defined if assertion checking is enabled. */
#include <stdio.h>
#if STDC_HEADERS
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
#else
# include <strings.h>
# ifndef strchr
# define strchr index
# endif
#endif
#include <assert.h>
#include <ctype.h>
#include <errno.h>
#ifndef errno
extern int errno;
#endif
#if HAVE_LIMITS_H
# include <limits.h>
#endif
#ifndef CHAR_BIT
# define CHAR_BIT 8
#endif
/* The extra casts work around common compiler bugs. */
#define TYPE_SIGNED(t) (! ((t) 0 < (t) -1))
/* The outer cast is needed to work around a bug in Cray C 5.0.3.0.
It is necessary at least when t == time_t. */
#define TYPE_MINIMUM(t) ((t) (TYPE_SIGNED (t) \
? ~ (t) 0 << (sizeof (t) * CHAR_BIT - 1) : (t) 0))
#define TYPE_MAXIMUM(t) (~ (t) 0 - TYPE_MINIMUM (t))
#if defined (STDC_HEADERS) || (!defined (isascii) && !defined (HAVE_ISASCII))
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) 1
#else
# define IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN(c) isascii(c)
#endif
#define ISSPACE(c) (IN_CTYPE_DOMAIN (c) && isspace (c))
#include "xstrtol.h"
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOL && !defined strtol
long int strtol ();
#endif
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUL && !defined strtoul
unsigned long int strtoul ();
#endif
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOIMAX && !defined strtoimax
intmax_t strtoimax ();
#endif
#if !HAVE_DECL_STRTOUMAX && !defined strtoumax
uintmax_t strtoumax ();
#endif
static int
bkm_scale (__strtol_t *x, int scale_factor)
{
__strtol_t product = *x * scale_factor;
if (*x != product / scale_factor)
return 1;
*x = product;
return 0;
}
static int
bkm_scale_by_power (__strtol_t *x, int base, int power)
{
while (power--)
if (bkm_scale (x, base))
return 1;
return 0;
}
/* FIXME: comment. */
strtol_error
__xstrtol (const char *s, char **ptr, int strtol_base,
__strtol_t *val, const char *valid_suffixes)
{
char *t_ptr;
char **p;
__strtol_t tmp;
assert (0 <= strtol_base && strtol_base <= 36);
p = (ptr ? ptr : &t_ptr);
if (! TYPE_SIGNED (__strtol_t))
{
const char *q = s;
while (ISSPACE ((unsigned char) *q))
++q;
if (*q == '-')
return LONGINT_INVALID;
}
errno = 0;
tmp = __strtol (s, p, strtol_base);
if (errno != 0)
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
if (*p == s)
return LONGINT_INVALID;
/* Let valid_suffixes == NULL mean `allow any suffix'. */
/* FIXME: update all callers except the ones that allow suffixes
after the number, changing last parameter NULL to `""'. */
if (!valid_suffixes)
{
*val = tmp;
return LONGINT_OK;
}
if (**p != '\0')
{
int base = 1024;
int suffixes = 1;
int overflow;
if (!strchr (valid_suffixes, **p))
{
*val = tmp;
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
}
if (strchr (valid_suffixes, '0'))
{
/* The ``valid suffix'' '0' is a special flag meaning that
an optional second suffix is allowed, which can change
the base, e.g. "100MD" for 100 megabytes decimal. */
switch (p[0][1])
{
case 'B':
suffixes++;
break;
case 'D':
base = 1000;
suffixes++;
break;
}
}
switch (**p)
{
case 'b':
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 512);
break;
case 'B':
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 1024);
break;
case 'c':
overflow = 0;
break;
case 'E': /* Exa */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 6);
break;
case 'G': /* Giga */
case 'g': /* 'g' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 3);
break;
case 'k': /* kilo */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 1);
break;
case 'M': /* Mega */
case 'm': /* 'm' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 2);
break;
case 'P': /* Peta */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 5);
break;
case 'T': /* Tera */
case 't': /* 't' is undocumented; for compatibility only */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 4);
break;
case 'w':
overflow = bkm_scale (&tmp, 2);
break;
case 'Y': /* Yotta */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 8);
break;
case 'Z': /* Zetta */
overflow = bkm_scale_by_power (&tmp, base, 7);
break;
default:
*val = tmp;
return LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR;
break;
}
if (overflow)
return LONGINT_OVERFLOW;
(*p) += suffixes;
}
*val = tmp;
return LONGINT_OK;
}
#ifdef TESTING_XSTRTO
# include <stdio.h>
# include "error.h"
char *program_name;
int
main (int argc, char** argv)
{
strtol_error s_err;
int i;
program_name = argv[0];
for (i=1; i<argc; i++)
{
char *p;
__strtol_t val;
s_err = __xstrtol (argv[i], &p, 0, &val, "bckmw");
if (s_err == LONGINT_OK)
{
printf ("%s->%lu (%s)\n", argv[i], val, p);
}
else
{
STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR (argv[i], "arg", s_err);
}
}
exit (0);
}
#endif /* TESTING_XSTRTO */

View File

@@ -1,82 +0,0 @@
/* A more useful interface to strtol.
Copyright 1995, 1996, 1998, 1999, 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
any later version.
This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
GNU General Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
#ifndef XSTRTOL_H_
# define XSTRTOL_H_ 1
# if HAVE_INTTYPES_H
# include <inttypes.h> /* for uintmax_t */
# endif
# ifndef PARAMS
# if defined PROTOTYPES || (defined __STDC__ && __STDC__)
# define PARAMS(Args) Args
# else
# define PARAMS(Args) ()
# endif
# endif
# ifndef _STRTOL_ERROR
enum strtol_error
{
LONGINT_OK, LONGINT_INVALID, LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR, LONGINT_OVERFLOW
};
typedef enum strtol_error strtol_error;
# endif
# define _DECLARE_XSTRTOL(name, type) \
strtol_error \
name PARAMS ((const char *s, char **ptr, int base, \
type *val, const char *valid_suffixes));
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtol, long int)
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoul, unsigned long int)
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoimax, intmax_t)
_DECLARE_XSTRTOL (xstrtoumax, uintmax_t)
# define _STRTOL_ERROR(Exit_code, Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
do \
{ \
switch ((Err)) \
{ \
case LONGINT_OK: \
abort (); \
\
case LONGINT_INVALID: \
error ((Exit_code), 0, "invalid %s `%s'", \
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
break; \
\
case LONGINT_INVALID_SUFFIX_CHAR: \
error ((Exit_code), 0, "invalid character following %s in `%s'", \
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
break; \
\
case LONGINT_OVERFLOW: \
error ((Exit_code), 0, "%s `%s' too large", \
(Argument_type_string), (Str)); \
break; \
} \
} \
while (0)
# define STRTOL_FATAL_ERROR(Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
_STRTOL_ERROR (2, Str, Argument_type_string, Err)
# define STRTOL_FAIL_WARN(Str, Argument_type_string, Err) \
_STRTOL_ERROR (0, Str, Argument_type_string, Err)
#endif /* not XSTRTOL_H_ */

View File

@@ -1,110 +0,0 @@
*_gl.m4
Makefile
Makefile.in
alloca.m4
allocsa.m4
argp.m4
backupfile.m4
bison.m4
chown.m4
clock_time.m4
codeset.m4
d-ino.m4
dirname.m4
dos.m4
eealloc.m4
error.m4
exclude.m4
exitfail.m4
extensions.m4
fileblocks.m4
fnmatch.m4
ftruncate.m4
getcwd-path-max.m4
getcwd.m4
getdate.m4
getline.m4
getndelim2.m4
getopt.m4
getpagesize.m4
gettext.m4
gettime.m4
gettimeofday.m4
glibc21.m4
gnulib.m4
hash.m4
human.m4
iconv.m4
intdiv0.m4
intmax.m4
intmax_t.m4
inttypes-pri.m4
inttypes.m4
inttypes_h.m4
isc-posix.m4
lchown.m4
lcmessage.m4
lib-ld.m4
lib-link.m4
lib-prefix.m4
localcharset.m4
longdouble.m4
longlong.m4
mbrtowc.m4
mbstate_t.m4
mempcpy.m4
memset.m4
mktime.m4
modechange.m4
nls.m4
obstack.m4
onceonly.m4
po.m4
printf-posix.m4
progtest.m4
quote.m4
quotearg.m4
restrict.m4
rmdir.m4
rmt.m4
safe-read.m4
safe-write.m4
save-cwd.m4
savedir.m4
setenv.m4
signed.m4
size_max.m4
ssize_t.m4
st_mtim.m4
stdbool.m4
stdint_h.m4
stpcpy.m4
strcase.m4
strchrnul.m4
strerror_r.m4
strndup.m4
strnlen.m4
strtoimax.m4
strtol.m4
strtoll.m4
strtoul.m4
strtoull.m4
strtoumax.m4
sysexits.m4
time_r.m4
timespec.m4
tm_gmtoff.m4
uintmax_t.m4
ulonglong.m4
unlocked-io.m4
utimbuf.m4
utime.m4
utimes-null.m4
utimes.m4
wchar_t.m4
wint_t.m4
xalloc.m4
xgetcwd.m4
xsize.m4
xstrtol.m4
xstrtoumax.m4

View File

@@ -1,23 +0,0 @@
#serial 4
dnl From Paul Eggert.
AC_DEFUN([AC_C_BACKSLASH_A],
[
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether backslash-a works in strings], ac_cv_c_backslash_a,
[AC_TRY_COMPILE([],
[
#if '\a' == 'a'
syntax error;
#endif
char buf['\a' == 'a' ? -1 : 1];
buf[0] = '\a';
return buf[0] != "\a"[0];
],
ac_cv_c_backslash_a=yes,
ac_cv_c_backslash_a=no)])
if test $ac_cv_c_backslash_a = yes; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_C_BACKSLASH_A, 1,
[Define if backslash-a works in C strings.])
fi
])

View File

@@ -1,95 +0,0 @@
# The following is taken from automake 1.4,
# except that it prefers the compiler option -Ae to "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE"
# because only the former supports 64-bit integral types on HP-UX 10.20.
## ----------------------------------------- ##
## ANSIfy the C compiler whenever possible. ##
## From Franc,ois Pinard ##
## ----------------------------------------- ##
# serial 2
# @defmac AC_PROG_CC_STDC
# @maindex PROG_CC_STDC
# @ovindex CC
# If the C compiler in not in ANSI C mode by default, try to add an option
# to output variable @code{CC} to make it so. This macro tries various
# options that select ANSI C on some system or another. It considers the
# compiler to be in ANSI C mode if it handles function prototypes correctly.
#
# If you use this macro, you should check after calling it whether the C
# compiler has been set to accept ANSI C; if not, the shell variable
# @code{am_cv_prog_cc_stdc} is set to @samp{no}. If you wrote your source
# code in ANSI C, you can make an un-ANSIfied copy of it by using the
# program @code{ansi2knr}, which comes with Ghostscript.
# @end defmac
AC_DEFUN(AM_PROG_CC_STDC,
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])
AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_C_INLINE])
AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_C_CONST])
dnl Force this before AC_PROG_CPP. Some cpp's, eg on HPUX, require
dnl a magic option to avoid problems with ANSI preprocessor commands
dnl like #elif.
dnl FIXME: can't do this because then AC_AIX won't work due to a
dnl circular dependency.
dnl AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_PROG_CPP])
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for ${CC-cc} option to accept ANSI C)
AC_CACHE_VAL(am_cv_prog_cc_stdc,
[am_cv_prog_cc_stdc=no
ac_save_CC="$CC"
# Don't try gcc -ansi; that turns off useful extensions and
# breaks some systems' header files.
# AIX -qlanglvl=ansi
# Ultrix and OSF/1 -std1
# HP-UX -Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE
# SVR4 -Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__
for ac_arg in "" -qlanglvl=ansi -std1 -Ae "-Aa -D_HPUX_SOURCE" "-Xc -D__EXTENSIONS__"
do
CC="$ac_save_CC $ac_arg"
AC_TRY_COMPILE(
[#include <stdarg.h>
#include <stdio.h>
#include <sys/types.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
/* Most of the following tests are stolen from RCS 5.7's src/conf.sh. */
struct buf { int x; };
FILE * (*rcsopen) (struct buf *, struct stat *, int);
static char *e (p, i)
char **p;
int i;
{
return p[i];
}
static char *f (char * (*g) (char **, int), char **p, ...)
{
char *s;
va_list v;
va_start (v,p);
s = g (p, va_arg (v,int));
va_end (v);
return s;
}
int test (int i, double x);
struct s1 {int (*f) (int a);};
struct s2 {int (*f) (double a);};
int pairnames (int, char **, FILE *(*)(struct buf *, struct stat *, int), int, int);
int argc;
char **argv;
], [
return f (e, argv, 0) != argv[0] || f (e, argv, 1) != argv[1];
],
[am_cv_prog_cc_stdc="$ac_arg"; break])
done
CC="$ac_save_CC"
])
if test -z "$am_cv_prog_cc_stdc"; then
AC_MSG_RESULT([none needed])
else
AC_MSG_RESULT($am_cv_prog_cc_stdc)
fi
case "x$am_cv_prog_cc_stdc" in
x|xno) ;;
*) CC="$CC $am_cv_prog_cc_stdc" ;;
esac
])

View File

@@ -1,37 +0,0 @@
#serial 5
AC_DEFUN(jm_CHECK_DECLARATION,
[
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether $1 is declared])
AC_CACHE_VAL(jm_cv_func_decl_$1,
[AC_TRY_COMPILE($2,
[
#ifndef $1
char *(*pfn) = (char *(*)) $1
#endif
],
eval "jm_cv_func_decl_$1=yes",
eval "jm_cv_func_decl_$1=no")])
if eval "test \"`echo '$jm_cv_func_decl_'$1`\" = yes"; then
AC_MSG_RESULT(yes)
ifelse([$3], , :, [$3])
else
AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
ifelse([$4], , , [$4
])dnl
fi
])dnl
dnl jm_CHECK_DECLARATIONS(INCLUDES, FUNCTION... [, ACTION-IF-DECLARED
dnl [, ACTION-IF-NOT-DECLARED]])
AC_DEFUN(jm_CHECK_DECLARATIONS,
[
for jm_func in $2
do
jm_CHECK_DECLARATION($jm_func, $1,
[
jm_tr_func=HAVE_DECL_`echo $jm_func | tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ`
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED($jm_tr_func) $3], $4)dnl
done
])

View File

@@ -1,12 +0,0 @@
#serial 3
dnl FIXME: put these prerequisite-only *.m4 files in a separate
dnl directory -- otherwise, they'll conflict with existing files.
dnl These are the prerequisite macros for GNU's error.c file.
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_ERROR],
[
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(strerror strerror_r vprintf doprnt)
AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R
AC_HEADER_STDC
])

View File

@@ -1,24 +0,0 @@
dnl This is a copy of autoconf 2.13, except we also check that
dnl FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR works.
dnl
undefine([AC_FUNC_FNMATCH])
AC_DEFUN(AC_FUNC_FNMATCH,
[AC_CACHE_CHECK(for working GNU-style fnmatch, ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works,
# Some versions of Solaris, SCO, and the GNU C Library
# have a broken or incompatible fnmatch.
# So we run a test program. If we are cross-compiling, take no chance.
# Thanks to John Oleynick, Franc,ois Pinard, and Paul Eggert for this test.
[AC_TRY_RUN([#include <fnmatch.h>
main() {
exit (fnmatch ("a*", "abc", 0) != 0
|| fnmatch("d*/*1", "d/s/1", FNM_FILE_NAME) != FNM_NOMATCH
|| fnmatch("*", "x", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0
|| fnmatch("x*", "x/y/z", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0
|| fnmatch("*c*", "c/x", FNM_FILE_NAME | FNM_LEADING_DIR) != 0);
}],
ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=yes, ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=no,
ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works=no)])
if test $ac_cv_func_fnmatch_works = yes; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_FNMATCH)
fi
])

View File

@@ -1,53 +0,0 @@
# getcwd.m4 - check whether getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result
# Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
# GNU General Public License for more details.
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
# Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
# Written by Paul Eggert.
AC_DEFUN([AC_FUNC_GETCWD_NULL],
[AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h unistd.h)
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result],
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null],
[AC_TRY_RUN(
[
# ifdef HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
# endif
# ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
# include <unistd.h>
# endif
# ifndef getcwd
char *getcwd ();
# endif
int
main ()
{
if (chdir ("/") != 0)
exit (1);
else
{
char *f = getcwd (NULL, 0);
exit (! (f && f[0] == '/' && !f[1]));
}
}],
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=yes],
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=no],
[ac_cv_func_getcwd_null=no])])
if test $ac_cv_func_getcwd_null = yes; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETCWD_NULL, 1,
[Define if getcwd (NULL, 0) allocates memory for result.])
fi])

View File

@@ -1,368 +0,0 @@
# Macro to add for using GNU gettext.
# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
#
# This file can be copied and used freely without restrictions. It can
# be used in projects which are not available under the GNU General Public
# License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
# functionality.
# Please note that the actual code of GNU gettext is covered by the GNU
# General Public License and is *not* in the public domain.
# serial 10
dnl Usage: AM_WITH_NLS([TOOLSYMBOL], [NEEDSYMBOL], [LIBDIR]).
dnl If TOOLSYMBOL is specified and is 'use-libtool', then a libtool library
dnl $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.la will be created (shared and/or static,
dnl depending on --{enable,disable}-{shared,static} and on the presence of
dnl AM-DISABLE-SHARED). Otherwise, a static library
dnl $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.a will be created.
dnl If NEEDSYMBOL is specified and is 'need-ngettext', then GNU gettext
dnl implementations (in libc or libintl) without the ngettext() function
dnl will be ignored.
dnl LIBDIR is used to find the intl libraries. If empty,
dnl the value `$(top_builddir)/intl/' is used.
dnl
dnl The result of the configuration is one of three cases:
dnl 1) GNU gettext, as included in the intl subdirectory, will be compiled
dnl and used.
dnl Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
dnl Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
dnl 2) GNU gettext has been found in the system's C library.
dnl Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
dnl Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
dnl 3) No internationalization, always use English msgid.
dnl Catalog format: none
dnl Catalog extension: none
dnl The use of .gmo is historical (it was needed to avoid overwriting the
dnl GNU format catalogs when building on a platform with an X/Open gettext),
dnl but we keep it in order not to force irrelevant filename changes on the
dnl maintainers.
dnl
AC_DEFUN([AM_WITH_NLS],
[AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether NLS is requested])
dnl Default is enabled NLS
AC_ARG_ENABLE(nls,
[ --disable-nls do not use Native Language Support],
USE_NLS=$enableval, USE_NLS=yes)
AC_MSG_RESULT($USE_NLS)
AC_SUBST(USE_NLS)
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
INTLLIBS=
dnl If we use NLS figure out what method
if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
AC_DEFINE(ENABLE_NLS, 1,
[Define to 1 if translation of program messages to the user's native language
is requested.])
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether included gettext is requested])
AC_ARG_WITH(included-gettext,
[ --with-included-gettext use the GNU gettext library included here],
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=$withval,
nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=no)
AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext)
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext="$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext"
if test "$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext" != "yes"; then
dnl User does not insist on using GNU NLS library. Figure out what
dnl to use. If GNU gettext is available we use this. Else we have
dnl to fall back to GNU NLS library.
CATOBJEXT=NONE
dnl Add a version number to the cache macros.
define(gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc, [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, 2, 1)[_libc])
define(gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl, [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, 2, 1)[_libintl])
AC_CHECK_HEADER(libintl.h,
[AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libc], gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc,
[AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;],
[bindtextdomain ("", "");
return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=yes,
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=no)])
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" != "yes"; then
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libintl],
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl,
[gt_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
LIBS="$LIBS -lintl $LIBICONV"
AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;],
[bindtextdomain ("", "");
return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], need-ngettext, [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr],
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=yes,
gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=no)
LIBS="$gt_save_LIBS"])
fi
dnl If an already present or preinstalled GNU gettext() is found,
dnl use it. But if this macro is used in GNU gettext, and GNU
dnl gettext is already preinstalled in libintl, we update this
dnl libintl. (Cf. the install rule in intl/Makefile.in.)
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" = "yes" \
|| { test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes" \
&& test "$PACKAGE" != gettext; }; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETTEXT, 1,
[Define if the GNU gettext() function is already present or preinstalled.])
if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
dnl If iconv() is in a separate libiconv library, then anyone
dnl linking with libintl{.a,.so} also needs to link with
dnl libiconv.
INTLLIBS="-lintl $LIBICONV"
fi
gt_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
LIBS="$LIBS $INTLLIBS"
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(dcgettext)
LIBS="$gt_save_LIBS"
dnl Search for GNU msgfmt in the PATH.
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
dnl Search for GNU xgettext in the PATH.
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
fi
])
if test "$CATOBJEXT" = "NONE"; then
dnl GNU gettext is not found in the C library.
dnl Fall back on GNU gettext library.
nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext=yes
fi
fi
if test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
dnl Mark actions used to generate GNU NLS library.
INTLOBJS="\$(GETTOBJS)"
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
[$ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
AC_SUBST(MSGFMT)
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
CATOBJEXT=.gmo
INTLLIBS="ifelse([$3],[],\$(top_builddir)/intl,[$3])/libintl.ifelse([$1], use-libtool, [l], [])a $LIBICONV"
LIBS=`echo " $LIBS " | sed -e 's/ -lintl / /' -e 's/^ //' -e 's/ $//'`
fi
dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
dnl Test whether we really found GNU msgfmt.
if test "$GMSGFMT" != ":"; then
dnl If it is no GNU msgfmt we define it as : so that the
dnl Makefiles still can work.
if $GMSGFMT --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then
: ;
else
AC_MSG_RESULT(
[found msgfmt program is not GNU msgfmt; ignore it])
GMSGFMT=":"
fi
fi
dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
dnl Test whether we really found GNU xgettext.
if test "$XGETTEXT" != ":"; then
dnl If it is no GNU xgettext we define it as : so that the
dnl Makefiles still can work.
if $XGETTEXT --omit-header /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then
: ;
else
AC_MSG_RESULT(
[found xgettext program is not GNU xgettext; ignore it])
XGETTEXT=":"
fi
fi
dnl We need to process the po/ directory.
POSUB=po
fi
AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS(
[for ac_file in $CONFIG_FILES; do
# Support "outfile[:infile[:infile...]]"
case "$ac_file" in
*:*) ac_file=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%:.*%%'` ;;
esac
# PO directories have a Makefile.in generated from Makefile.in.in.
case "$ac_file" in */Makefile.in)
# Adjust a relative srcdir.
ac_dir=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
ac_dir_suffix="/`echo "$ac_dir"|sed 's%^\./%%'`"
ac_dots=`echo "$ac_dir_suffix"|sed 's%/[^/]*%../%g'`
# In autoconf-2.13 it is called $ac_given_srcdir.
# In autoconf-2.50 it is called $srcdir.
test -n "$ac_given_srcdir" || ac_given_srcdir="$srcdir"
case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
.) top_srcdir=`echo $ac_dots|sed 's%/$%%'` ;;
/*) top_srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
*) top_srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
esac
if test -f "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in"; then
rm -f "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/POTFILES" || echo "creating $ac_dir/POTFILES"
sed -e "/^#/d" -e "/^[ ]*\$/d" -e "s,.*, $top_srcdir/& \\\\," -e "\$s/\(.*\) \\\\/\1/" < "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in" > "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/Makefile" || echo "creating $ac_dir/Makefile"
sed -e "/POTFILES =/r $ac_dir/POTFILES" "$ac_dir/Makefile.in" > "$ac_dir/Makefile"
fi
;;
esac
done])
dnl If this is used in GNU gettext we have to set BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL
dnl to 'yes' because some of the testsuite requires it.
if test "$PACKAGE" = gettext; then
BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
fi
dnl intl/plural.c is generated from intl/plural.y. It requires bison,
dnl because plural.y uses bison specific features. It requires at least
dnl bison-1.26 because earlier versions generate a plural.c that doesn't
dnl compile.
dnl bison is only needed for the maintainer (who touches plural.y). But in
dnl order to avoid separate Makefiles or --enable-maintainer-mode, we put
dnl the rule in general Makefile. Now, some people carelessly touch the
dnl files or have a broken "make" program, hence the plural.c rule will
dnl sometimes fire. To avoid an error, defines BISON to ":" if it is not
dnl present or too old.
AC_CHECK_PROGS([INTLBISON], [bison])
if test -z "$INTLBISON"; then
ac_verc_fail=yes
else
dnl Found it, now check the version.
AC_MSG_CHECKING([version of bison])
changequote(<<,>>)dnl
ac_prog_version=`$INTLBISON --version 2>&1 | sed -n 's/^.*GNU Bison .* \([0-9]*\.[0-9.]*\).*$/\1/p'`
case $ac_prog_version in
'') ac_prog_version="v. ?.??, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
1.2[6-9]* | 1.[3-9][0-9]* | [2-9].*)
changequote([,])dnl
ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, ok"; ac_verc_fail=no;;
*) ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
esac
AC_MSG_RESULT([$ac_prog_version])
fi
if test $ac_verc_fail = yes; then
INTLBISON=:
fi
dnl These rules are solely for the distribution goal. While doing this
dnl we only have to keep exactly one list of the available catalogs
dnl in configure.in.
for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $lang.gmo"
POFILES="$POFILES $lang.po"
done
dnl Make all variables we use known to autoconf.
AC_SUBST(BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
AC_SUBST(USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
AC_SUBST(CATALOGS)
AC_SUBST(CATOBJEXT)
AC_SUBST(GMOFILES)
AC_SUBST(INTLLIBS)
AC_SUBST(INTLOBJS)
AC_SUBST(POFILES)
AC_SUBST(POSUB)
dnl For backward compatibility. Some configure.ins may be using this.
nls_cv_header_intl=
nls_cv_header_libgt=
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
DATADIRNAME=share
AC_SUBST(DATADIRNAME)
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
INSTOBJEXT=.mo
AC_SUBST(INSTOBJEXT)
dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
GENCAT=gencat
AC_SUBST(GENCAT)
])
dnl Usage: Just like AM_WITH_NLS, which see.
AC_DEFUN([AM_GNU_GETTEXT],
[AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_MAKE_SET])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_ISC_POSIX])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_HEADER_STDC])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_CONST])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_INLINE])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_OFF_T])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_SIZE_T])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_ALLOCA])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_MMAP])dnl
AC_REQUIRE([jm_GLIBC21])dnl
AC_CHECK_HEADERS([argz.h limits.h locale.h nl_types.h malloc.h stddef.h \
stdlib.h string.h unistd.h sys/param.h])
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([feof_unlocked fgets_unlocked getcwd getegid geteuid \
getgid getuid mempcpy munmap putenv setenv setlocale stpcpy strchr strcasecmp \
strdup strtoul tsearch __argz_count __argz_stringify __argz_next])
AM_ICONV
AM_LANGINFO_CODESET
AM_LC_MESSAGES
AM_WITH_NLS([$1],[$2],[$3])
if test "x$CATOBJEXT" != "x"; then
if test "x$ALL_LINGUAS" = "x"; then
LINGUAS=
else
AC_MSG_CHECKING(for catalogs to be installed)
NEW_LINGUAS=
for presentlang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
useit=no
for desiredlang in ${LINGUAS-$ALL_LINGUAS}; do
# Use the presentlang catalog if desiredlang is
# a. equal to presentlang, or
# b. a variant of presentlang (because in this case,
# presentlang can be used as a fallback for messages
# which are not translated in the desiredlang catalog).
case "$desiredlang" in
"$presentlang"*) useit=yes;;
esac
done
if test $useit = yes; then
NEW_LINGUAS="$NEW_LINGUAS $presentlang"
fi
done
LINGUAS=$NEW_LINGUAS
AC_MSG_RESULT($LINGUAS)
fi
dnl Construct list of names of catalog files to be constructed.
if test -n "$LINGUAS"; then
for lang in $LINGUAS; do CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang$CATOBJEXT"; done
fi
fi
dnl If the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR macro for autoconf is used we possibly
dnl find the mkinstalldirs script in another subdir but $(top_srcdir).
dnl Try to locate is.
MKINSTALLDIRS=
if test -n "$ac_aux_dir"; then
MKINSTALLDIRS="$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs"
fi
if test -z "$MKINSTALLDIRS"; then
MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs"
fi
AC_SUBST(MKINSTALLDIRS)
dnl Enable libtool support if the surrounding package wishes it.
INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX=ifelse([$1], use-libtool, [l], [])
AC_SUBST(INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX)
])

View File

@@ -1,32 +0,0 @@
#serial 6
dnl From Paul Eggert.
AC_PREREQ(2.52)
# Define intmax_t to long or long long if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T],
[
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
AC_CHECK_TYPE(intmax_t, ,
[test $ac_cv_type_long_long = yes \
&& ac_type='long long' \
|| ac_type='long'
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(intmax_t, $ac_type,
[Define to widest signed type if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.])])
])
# Define uintmax_t to unsigned long or unsigned long long
# if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T],
[
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
AC_CHECK_TYPE(uintmax_t, ,
[test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes \
&& ac_type='unsigned long long' \
|| ac_type='unsigned long'
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(uintmax_t, $ac_type,
[Define to widest unsigned type if <inttypes.h> doesn't define.])])
])

View File

@@ -1,19 +0,0 @@
#serial 1
dnl From Paul Eggert
AC_DEFUN(jm_FUNC_MBRTOWC,
[
AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether mbrtowc and mbstate_t are properly declared])
AC_CACHE_VAL(jm_cv_func_mbrtowc,
[AC_TRY_LINK(
[#include <wchar.h>],
[mbstate_t state; return ! (sizeof state && mbrtowc);],
[jm_cv_func_mbrtowc=yes],
[jm_cv_func_mbrtowc=no])])
if test $jm_cv_func_mbrtowc = yes; then
AC_MSG_RESULT(yes)
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_MBRTOWC, 1,
[Define to 1 if mbrtowc and mbstate_t are properly declared.])
fi
])

View File

@@ -1,29 +0,0 @@
# serial 9
# From Paul Eggert.
# BeOS 5 has <wchar.h> but does not define mbstate_t,
# so you can't declare an object of that type.
# Check for this incompatibility with Standard C.
# Include stdlib.h first, because otherwise this test would fail on Linux
# (at least glibc-2.1.3) because the "_XOPEN_SOURCE 500" definition elicits
# a syntax error in wchar.h due to the use of undefined __int32_t.
AC_DEFUN([AC_MBSTATE_T],
[
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h)
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for mbstate_t], ac_cv_type_mbstate_t,
[AC_TRY_COMPILE([
#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
# include <stdlib.h>
#endif
#include <wchar.h>],
[mbstate_t x; return sizeof x;],
ac_cv_type_mbstate_t=yes,
ac_cv_type_mbstate_t=no)])
if test $ac_cv_type_mbstate_t = no; then
AC_DEFINE(mbstate_t, int,
[Define to a type if <wchar.h> does not define.])
fi])

View File

@@ -1,141 +0,0 @@
#serial 21
dnl These are the prerequisite macros for files in the lib/
dnl directories of the fileutils, sh-utils, and textutils packages.
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ],
[
jm_PREREQ_ADDEXT
jm_PREREQ_CANON_HOST
jm_PREREQ_DIRNAME
jm_PREREQ_ERROR
jm_PREREQ_EXCLUDE
jm_PREREQ_GETPAGESIZE
jm_PREREQ_HASH
jm_PREREQ_HUMAN
jm_PREREQ_MBSWIDTH
jm_PREREQ_MEMCHR
jm_PREREQ_QUOTEARG
jm_PREREQ_READUTMP
jm_PREREQ_REGEX
jm_PREREQ_TEMPNAME # called by mkstemp
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_ADDEXT],
[
dnl For addext.c.
AC_SYS_LONG_FILE_NAMES
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(pathconf)
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h string.h unistd.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_CANON_HOST],
[
dnl Add any libraries as early as possible.
dnl In particular, inet_ntoa needs -lnsl at least on Solaris5.5.1,
dnl so we have to add -lnsl to LIBS before checking for that function.
AC_SEARCH_LIBS(gethostbyname, [inet nsl])
dnl These come from -lnsl on Solaris5.5.1.
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(gethostbyname gethostbyaddr inet_ntoa)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(gethostbyname gethostbyaddr inet_ntoa)
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(unistd.h string.h netdb.h sys/socket.h \
netinet/in.h arpa/inet.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_DIRNAME],
[
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_EXCLUDE],
[
jm_FUNC_FNMATCH
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdbool.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_GETPAGESIZE],
[
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(getpagesize)
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(OS.h unistd.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_HASH],
[
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdlib.h stdbool.h)
AC_REQUIRE([jm_CHECK_DECLS])
])
# If you use human.c, you need the following files:
# inttypes.m4 ulonglong.m4
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_HUMAN],
[
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h string.h)
AC_CHECK_DECLS([getenv])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_MEMCHR],
[
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h bp-sym.h)
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_QUOTEARG],
[
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(isascii iswprint)
jm_FUNC_MBRTOWC
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stddef.h stdlib.h string.h wchar.h wctype.h)
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_C_BACKSLASH_A
AC_MBSTATE_T
AM_C_PROTOTYPES
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_READUTMP],
[
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h utmp.h utmpx.h sys/param.h)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(utmpname)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(utmpxname)
AM_C_PROTOTYPES
if test $ac_cv_header_utmp_h = yes || test $ac_cv_header_utmpx_h = yes; then
utmp_includes="\
$ac_includes_default
#ifdef HAVE_UTMPX_H
# include <utmpx.h>
#endif
#ifdef HAVE_UTMP_H
# include <utmp.h>
#endif
"
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_user],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_user],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_name],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_name],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmpx.ut_type],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_CHECK_MEMBERS([struct utmp.ut_type],,,[$utmp_includes])
AC_LIBOBJ(readutmp)
fi
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_REGEX],
[
dnl FIXME: Maybe provide a btowc replacement someday: solaris-2.5.1 lacks it.
dnl FIXME: Check for wctype and iswctype, and and add -lw if necessary
dnl to get them.
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(bzero bcopy isascii btowc)
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(alloca.h libintl.h wctype.h wchar.h)
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_FUNC_ALLOCA
])
AC_DEFUN([jm_PREREQ_TEMPNAME],
[
AC_HEADER_STDC
AC_HEADER_STAT
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(fcntl.h sys/time.h stdint.h unistd.h)
AC_CHECK_FUNCS(__secure_getenv gettimeofday)
])

View File

@@ -1,66 +0,0 @@
#serial 1002
# Experimental replacement for the function in the latest CVS autoconf.
# If the compile-test says strerror_r doesn't work, then resort to a
# `run'-test that works on BeOS and segfaults on DEC Unix.
# Use with the error.c file in ../lib.
undefine([AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R])
# AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R
# ------------------
AC_DEFUN([AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R],
[AC_CHECK_DECLS([strerror_r])
AC_CHECK_FUNCS([strerror_r])
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r = yes; then
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(string.h)
AC_CACHE_CHECK([for working strerror_r],
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works,
[
AC_TRY_COMPILE(
[
# include <stdio.h>
# if HAVE_STRING_H
# include <string.h>
# endif
],
[
char buf[100];
char x = *strerror_r (0, buf, sizeof buf);
],
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=yes,
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no
)
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works = no; then
# strerror_r seems not to work, but now we have to choose between
# systems that have relatively inaccessible declarations for the
# function. BeOS and DEC UNIX 4.0 fall in this category, but the
# former has a strerror_r that returns char*, while the latter
# has a strerror_r that returns `int'.
# This test should segfault on the DEC system.
AC_TRY_RUN(
[
# include <stdio.h>
# include <string.h>
# include <ctype.h>
extern char *strerror_r ();
int
main ()
{
char buf[100];
char x = *strerror_r (0, buf, sizeof buf);
exit (!isalpha (x));
}
],
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=yes,
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no,
ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works=no)
fi
])
if test $ac_cv_func_strerror_r_works = yes; then
AC_DEFINE(HAVE_WORKING_STRERROR_R, 1,
[Define to 1 if `strerror_r' returns a string.])
fi
fi
])# AC_FUNC_STRERROR_R

View File

@@ -1,19 +0,0 @@
#serial 6
dnl From Paul Eggert.
AC_PREREQ(2.50)
# Define uintmax_t to `unsigned long' or `unsigned long long'
# if <inttypes.h> does not exist.
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T],
[
AC_CHECK_TYPE(uintmax_t, ,
[AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes \
&& ac_type='unsigned long long' \
|| ac_type='unsigned long'
AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(uintmax_t, $ac_type,
[Define to the widest unsigned type if standard headers do not declare.])])
])

View File

@@ -1,41 +0,0 @@
#serial 2
dnl Cloned from xstrtoumax.m4. Keep these files in sync.
# autoconf tests required for use of xstrtoimax.c
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_PREREQ_XSTRTOIMAX],
[
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
AC_CHECK_DECLS([strtol, strtoul, strtoll, strtoimax, strtoumax])
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h inttypes.h)
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether <inttypes.h> defines strtoimax as a macro],
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro,
AC_EGREP_CPP([inttypes_h_defines_strtoimax], [#include <inttypes.h>
#ifdef strtoimax
inttypes_h_defines_strtoimax
#endif],
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro=yes,
jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro=no))
if test "$jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro" != yes; then
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoimax)
fi
dnl Only the replacement strtoimax invokes strtol and strtoll,
dnl so we need the replacements only if strtoimax does not exist.
case "$jm_cv_func_strtoimax_macro,$ac_cv_func_strtoimax" in
no,no)
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtol)
dnl We don't need (and can't compile) the replacement strtoll
dnl unless the type `long long' exists.
if test "$ac_cv_type_long_long" = yes; then
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoll)
fi
;;
esac
])

View File

@@ -1,40 +0,0 @@
#serial 4
# autoconf tests required for use of xstrtoumax.c
AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_PREREQ_XSTRTOUMAX],
[
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_INTMAX_T])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])
AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
AC_CHECK_DECLS([strtol, strtoul, strtoull, strtoimax, strtoumax])
AC_CHECK_HEADERS(limits.h stdlib.h inttypes.h)
AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether <inttypes.h> defines strtoumax as a macro],
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro,
AC_EGREP_CPP([inttypes_h_defines_strtoumax], [#include <inttypes.h>
#ifdef strtoumax
inttypes_h_defines_strtoumax
#endif],
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro=yes,
jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro=no))
if test "$jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro" != yes; then
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoumax)
fi
dnl Only the replacement strtoumax invokes strtoul and strtoull,
dnl so we need the replacements only if strtoumax does not exist.
case "$jm_cv_func_strtoumax_macro,$ac_cv_func_strtoumax" in
no,no)
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoul)
dnl We don't need (and can't compile) the replacement strtoull
dnl unless the type `unsigned long long' exists.
if test "$ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long" = yes; then
AC_REPLACE_FUNCS(strtoull)
fi
;;
esac
])

View File

@@ -1,20 +1,22 @@
index.html
*.gmo
*.mo
*.po
.reference
LINGUAS
Makefile
Makefile.in
Makefile.in.in
Makevars
Makevars.template
POTFILES
Rules-quot
boldquot.sed
en@boldquot.header
en@quot.header
insert-header.sed
insert-header.sin
quot.sed
remove-potcdate.sin
Makefile.in
POTFILES
Makefile
tar.pot
remove-potcdate.sed
*.gmo
*.mo
remove-potcdate.sin
stamp-po
tar.pot

View File

@@ -1,196 +0,0 @@
# Makefile for program source directory in GNU NLS utilities package.
# Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000, 2001 by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>
#
# This file can be copied and used freely without restrictions. It can
# be used in projects which are not available under the GNU Public License
# but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext functionality.
# Please note that the actual code is *not* freely available.
PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
VERSION = @VERSION@
# These two variables depend on the location of this directory.
subdir = po
top_builddir = ..
SHELL = /bin/sh
@SET_MAKE@
srcdir = @srcdir@
top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
VPATH = @srcdir@
prefix = @prefix@
exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
datadir = @datadir@
localedir = $(datadir)/locale
gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/po
INSTALL = @INSTALL@
INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) `case "$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" in /*) echo "$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" ;; *) echo "$(top_builddir)/$(MKINSTALLDIRS)" ;; esac`
CC = @CC@
GMSGFMT = @GMSGFMT@
MSGFMT = @MSGFMT@
XGETTEXT = @XGETTEXT@
MSGMERGE = msgmerge
DEFS = @DEFS@
CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
INCLUDES = -I.. -I$(top_srcdir)/intl
COMPILE = $(CC) -c $(DEFS) $(INCLUDES) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS)
POFILES = @POFILES@
GMOFILES = @GMOFILES@
DISTFILES = ChangeLog Makefile.in.in POTFILES.in $(PACKAGE).pot \
$(POFILES) $(GMOFILES)
POTFILES = \
CATALOGS = @CATALOGS@
.SUFFIXES:
.SUFFIXES: .c .o .po .pox .gmo .mo
.c.o:
$(COMPILE) $<
.po.pox:
$(MAKE) $(PACKAGE).pot
$(MSGMERGE) $< $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot -o $*.pox
.po.mo:
$(MSGFMT) -o $@ $<
.po.gmo:
file=$(srcdir)/`echo $* | sed 's,.*/,,'`.gmo \
&& rm -f $$file && $(GMSGFMT) --statistics -o $$file $<
all: all-@USE_NLS@
all-yes: $(CATALOGS)
all-no:
# Note: Target 'all' must not depend on target '$(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot',
# otherwise packages like GCC can not be built if only parts of the source
# have been downloaded.
$(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot: $(POTFILES) $(srcdir)/POTFILES.in
$(XGETTEXT) --default-domain=$(PACKAGE) --directory=$(top_srcdir) \
--add-comments --keyword=_ --keyword=N_ \
--files-from=$(srcdir)/POTFILES.in \
&& test ! -f $(PACKAGE).po \
|| ( rm -f $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot \
&& mv $(PACKAGE).po $(srcdir)/$(PACKAGE).pot )
install: install-exec install-data
install-exec:
install-data: install-data-@USE_NLS@
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then \
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
$(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/Makefile.in.in \
$(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/Makefile.in.in; \
else \
: ; \
fi
install-data-no: all
install-data-yes: all
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(datadir)
@catalogs='$(CATALOGS)'; \
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
dir=$(localedir)/$$lang/LC_MESSAGES; \
$(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$$dir; \
if test -r $$cat; then \
$(INSTALL_DATA) $$cat $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
echo "installing $$cat as $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo"; \
else \
$(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$cat $(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
echo "installing $(srcdir)/$$cat as" \
"$(DESTDIR)$$dir/$(PACKAGE).mo"; \
fi; \
done
# Define this as empty until I found a useful application.
installcheck:
uninstall:
catalogs='$(CATALOGS)'; \
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/$$lang/LC_MESSAGES/$(PACKAGE).mo; \
done
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then \
rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/Makefile.in.in; \
else \
: ; \
fi
check: all
dvi info tags TAGS ID:
mostlyclean:
rm -f core core.* *.pox $(PACKAGE).po *.new.po
rm -fr *.o
clean: mostlyclean
distclean: clean
rm -f Makefile Makefile.in POTFILES *.mo
maintainer-clean: distclean
@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
@echo "it deletes files that may require special tools to rebuild."
rm -f $(GMOFILES)
distdir = $(top_builddir)/$(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)/$(subdir)
dist distdir:
$(MAKE) update-po
@$(MAKE) dist2
# This is a separate target because 'update-po' must be executed before.
dist2: $(DISTFILES)
dists="$(DISTFILES)"; \
for file in $$dists; do \
if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
cp -p $$dir/$$file $(distdir); \
done
update-po: Makefile
$(MAKE) $(PACKAGE).pot
if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then PATH=`pwd`/../src:$$PATH; fi; \
cd $(srcdir); \
catalogs='$(GMOFILES)'; \
for cat in $$catalogs; do \
cat=`basename $$cat`; \
lang=`echo $$cat | sed 's/\.gmo$$//'`; \
echo "$$lang:"; \
if $(MSGMERGE) $$lang.po $(PACKAGE).pot -o $$lang.new.po; then \
mv -f $$lang.new.po $$lang.po; \
else \
echo "msgmerge for $$cat failed!"; \
rm -f $$lang.new.po; \
fi; \
done
$(MAKE) update-gmo
update-gmo: Makefile $(GMOFILES)
@:
Makefile: Makefile.in.in $(top_builddir)/config.status POTFILES.in
cd $(top_builddir) \
&& CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@.in CONFIG_HEADERS= \
$(SHELL) ./config.status
# Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make not to export all variables.
# Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
.NOEXPORT:

View File

@@ -1,41 +0,0 @@
# Makefile variables for PO directory in any package using GNU gettext.
# Usually the message domain is the same as the package name.
DOMAIN = $(PACKAGE)
# These two variables depend on the location of this directory.
subdir = po
top_builddir = ..
# These options get passed to xgettext.
XGETTEXT_OPTIONS = --keyword=_ --keyword=N_
# This is the copyright holder that gets inserted into the header of the
# $(DOMAIN).pot file. Set this to the copyright holder of the surrounding
# package. (Note that the msgstr strings, extracted from the package's
# sources, belong to the copyright holder of the package.) Translators are
# expected to transfer the copyright for their translations to this person
# or entity, or to disclaim their copyright. The empty string stands for
# the public domain; in this case the translators are expected to disclaim
# their copyright.
COPYRIGHT_HOLDER = Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# This is the email address or URL to which the translators shall report
# bugs in the untranslated strings:
# - Strings which are not entire sentences, see the maintainer guidelines
# in the GNU gettext documentation, section 'Preparing Strings'.
# - Strings which use unclear terms or require additional context to be
# understood.
# - Strings which make invalid assumptions about notation of date, time or
# money.
# - Pluralisation problems.
# - Incorrect English spelling.
# - Incorrect formatting.
# It can be your email address, or a mailing list address where translators
# can write to without being subscribed, or the URL of a web page through
# which the translators can contact you.
MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS = bug-tar@gnu.org
# This is the list of locale categories, beyond LC_MESSAGES, for which the
# message catalogs shall be used. It is usually empty.
EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES =

View File

@@ -1,10 +1,11 @@
# List of files which contain translatable strings.
# Copyright (C) 1996, 1999, 2000, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
# Copyright (C) 1996, 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2007 Free Software
# Foundation, Inc.
# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
# the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
# any later version.
# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
@@ -14,18 +15,32 @@
# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA
# 02111-1307, USA.
# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
# 02110-1301, USA.
# Library files
lib/argmatch.c
lib/error.c
lib/getopt.c
lib/human.c
lib/quotearg.c
lib/xmalloc.c
gnu/argmatch.c
gnu/argp-help.c
gnu/argp-parse.c
gnu/closeout.c
gnu/error.c
gnu/getopt.c
gnu/obstack.c
gnu/human.c
gnu/obstack.c
gnu/openat-die.c
gnu/quotearg.c
gnu/rpmatch.c
gnu/xalloc-die.c
gnu/xmalloc.c
gnu/version-etc.c
gnu/xalloc-die.c
lib/paxerror.c
lib/paxexit.c
lib/paxnames.c
lib/rtapelib.c
lib/argp-help.c
rmt/rmt.c
# Package source files
@@ -37,9 +52,12 @@ src/delete.c
src/extract.c
src/incremen.c
src/list.c
src/mangle.c
src/misc.c
src/names.c
src/tar.c
src/update.c
src/xheader.c
src/checkpoint.c
# Testsuite
tests/genfile.c

View File

@@ -1,6 +0,0 @@
Makefile.in
Makefile
backup.sh
backup
restore
dump-remind

Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More